The X Keyboard Extension:

Library Specification

Amber J. Benson

Gary Aitken

Erik Fortune

   Silicon Graphics, Inc

Donna Converse

   X Consortium, Inc

George Sachs

   Hewlett-Packard Company

Will Walker

   Digital Equipment Corporation

   X Version 11, Release 7.7

   Copyright  1995, 1996 X Consortium Inc., Silicon Graphics
   Inc., Hewlett-Packard Company, Digital Equipment Corporation

   Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person
   obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation
   files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without
   restriction, including without limitation the rights to use,
   copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or
   sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the
   Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following
   conditions:

   The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be
   included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.

   THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
   EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
   OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
   NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE X CONSORTIUM BE LIABLE
   FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION
   OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
   CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
   THE SOFTWARE.

   Except as contained in this notice, the names of the X
   Consortium, Silicon Graphics Inc., Hewlett-Packard Company, and
   Digital Equipment Corporation shall not be used in advertising
   or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this
   Software without prior written authorization.
     __________________________________________________________

   Table of Contents

   Acknowledgement
   1. Overview

        Core X Protocol Support for Keyboards
        Xkb Keyboard Extension Support for Keyboards
        Xkb Extension Components

              Groups and Shift Levels
              Radio Groups

        Client Types
        Compatibility With the Core Protocol
        Additional Protocol Errors
        Extension Library Functions

              Error Indications

   2. Initialization and General Programming Information

        Extension Header Files
        Extension Name
        Determining Library Compatibility
        Initializing the Keyboard Extension
        Disabling the Keyboard Extension
        Protocol Errors
        Display and Device Specifications in Function Calls

   3. Data Structures

        Allocating Xkb Data Structures
        Adding Data and Editing Data Structures
        Making Changes to the Server's Keyboard Description
        Tracking Keyboard Changes in the Server
        Freeing Data Structures

   4. Xkb Events

        Xkb Event Types
        Xkb Event Data Structures
        Selecting Xkb Events

              Event Masks

        Unified Xkb Event Type

   5. Keyboard State

        Keyboard State Description
        Changing the Keyboard State

              Changing Modifiers
              Changing Groups

        Determining Keyboard State
        Tracking Keyboard State

   6. Complete Keyboard Description

        The XkbDescRec Structure
        Obtaining a Keyboard Description from the Server
        Tracking Changes to the Keyboard Description in the Server
        Allocating and Freeing a Keyboard Description

   7. Virtual Modifiers

        Virtual Modifier Names and Masks
        Modifier Definitions
        Binding Virtual Modifiers to Real Modifiers
        Virtual Modifier Key Mapping

              Inactive Modifier Sets

        Conventions
        Example

   8. Indicators

        Indicator Names
        Indicator Data Structures

              XkbIndicatorRec
              XkbIndicatorMapRec

        Getting Information About Indicators

              Getting Indicator State
              Getting Indicator Information by Index
              Getting Indicator Information by Name

        Changing Indicator Maps and State

              Effects of Explicit Changes on Indicators
              Changing Indicator Maps by Index
              Changing Indicator Maps by Name
              The XkbIndicatorChangesRec Structure

        Tracking Changes to Indicator State or Map
        Allocating and Freeing Indicator Maps

   9. Bells

        Bell Names
        Audible Bells
        Bell Functions

              Generating Named Bells
              Generating Named Bell Events
              Forcing a Server-Generated Bell

        Detecting Bells

   10. Keyboard Controls

        Controls that Enable and Disable Other Controls

              The EnabledControls Control
              The AutoReset Control

        Control for Bell Behavior

              The AudibleBell Control

        Controls for Repeat Key Behavior

              The PerKeyRepeat Control
              The RepeatKeys Control
              The DetectableAutorepeat Control

        Controls for Keyboard Overlays (Overlay1 and Overlay2
                Controls)

        Controls for Using the Mouse from the Keyboard

              The MouseKeys Control
              The MouseKeysAccel Control

        Controls for Better Keyboard Access by Physically Impaired
                Persons

              The AccessXKeys Control
              The AccessXTimeout Control
              The AccessXFeedback Control
              AccessXNotify Events
              StickyKeys, RepeatKeys, and MouseKeys Events
              The SlowKeys Control
              The BounceKeys Control
              The StickyKeys Control

        Controls for General Keyboard Mapping

              The GroupsWrap Control
              The IgnoreLockMods Control
              The IgnoreGroupLock Control
              The InternalMods Control

        The XkbControlsRec Structure

        Querying Controls
        Changing Controls

              The XkbControlsChangesRec Structure

        Tracking Changes to Keyboard Controls
        Allocating and Freeing an XkbControlsRec
        The Miscellaneous Per-client Controls

   11. X Library Controls

        Controls Affecting Keycode-to-String Translation

              ForceLatin1Lookup
              ConsumeLookupMods
              AlwaysConsumeShiftAndLock

        Controls Affecting Compose Processing

              ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail
              ComposeLED
              BeepOnComposeFail

        Controls Effecting Event Delivery

              IgnoreNewKeyboards

        Manipulating the Library Controls

              Determining Which Library Controls are Implemented
              Determining the State of the Library Controls
              Changing the State of the Library Controls

   12. Interpreting Key Events

        Effects of Xkb on the Core X Library

              Effects of Xkb on Event State
              Effects of Xkb on MappingNotify Events
              X Library Functions Affected by Xkb

        Xkb Event and Keymap Functions

   13. Keyboard Geometry

        Shapes and Outlines
        Sections
        Rows and Keys
        Doodads
        Overlay Rows and Overlay Keys
        Drawing a Keyboard Representation
        Geometry Data Structures

              DoodadRec Structures

        Getting Keyboard Geometry From the Server
        Using Keyboard Geometry
        Adding Elements to a Keyboard Geometry
        Allocating and Freeing Geometry Components

   14. Xkb Keyboard Mapping

        Notation and Terminology

              Core Implementation
              Xkb Implementation

        Getting Map Components from the Server
        Changing Map Components in the Server

              The XkbMapChangesRec Structure

        Tracking Changes to Map Components
        Allocating and Freeing Client and Server Maps

              Allocating an Empty Client Map
              Freeing a Client Map
              Allocating an Empty Server Map
              Freeing a Server Map

   15. Xkb Client Keyboard Mapping

        The XkbClientMapRec Structure
        Key Types

              The Canonical Key Types
              Getting Key Types from the Server
              Changing the Number of Levels in a Key Type
              Copying Key Types

        Key Symbol Map

              Per-Key Key Type Indices
              Per-Key Group Information
              Key Width
              Offset in to the Symbol Map
              Getting the Symbol Map for Keys from the Server
              Changing the Number of Groups and Types Bound to a
                      Key

              Changing the Number of Symbols Bound to a Key

        The Per-Key Modifier Map

              Getting the Per-Key Modifier Map from the Server

   16. Xkb Server Keyboard Mapping

        Key Actions

              The XkbAction Structure
              The XkbAnyAction Structure
              Actions for Changing Modifiers' State
              Actions for Changing Group State
              Actions for Moving the Pointer
              Actions for Simulating Pointer Button Press and
                      Release

              Actions for Changing the Pointer Button Simulated
              Actions for Locking Modifiers and Group
              Actions for Changing the Active Screen
              Actions for Changing Boolean Controls State
              Actions for Generating Messages
              Actions for Generating a Different Keycode
              Actions for Generating DeviceButtonPress and
                      DeviceButtonRelease

              Actions for Simulating Events from Device Valuators
              Obtaining Key Actions for Keys from the Server
              Changing the Number of Actions Bound to a Key

        Key Behavior

              Radio Groups
              The XkbBehavior Structure
              Obtaining Key Behaviors for Keys from the Server

        Explicit Components--Avoiding Automatic Remapping by the
                Server

              Obtaining Explicit Components for Keys from the
                      Server

        Virtual Modifier Mapping

              Obtaining Virtual Modifier Bindings from the Server
              Obtaining Per-Key Virtual Modifier Mappings from the
                      Server

   17. The Xkb Compatibility Map

        The XkbCompatMap Structure

              Xkb State to Core Protocol State Transformation
              Core Keyboard Mapping to Xkb Keyboard Mapping
                      Transformation

              Xkb Keyboard Mapping to Core Keyboard Mapping
                      Transformations

        Getting Compatibility Map Components From the Server
        Using the Compatibility Map
        Changing the Server's Compatibility Map
        Tracking Changes to the Compatibility Map
        Allocating and Freeing the Compatibility Map

   18. Symbolic Names

        The XkbNamesRec Structure
        Symbolic Names Masks
        Getting Symbolic Names From the Server
        Changing Symbolic Names on the Server

        Tracking Name Changes
        Allocating and Freeing Symbolic Names

   19. Replacing a Keyboard "On the Fly"
   20. Server Database of Keyboard Components

        Component Names
        Listing the Known Keyboard Components
        Component Hints
        Building a Keyboard Description Using the Server Database

   21. Attaching Xkb Actions to X Input Extension Devices

        XkbDeviceInfoRec
        Querying Xkb Features for Non-KeyClass Input Extension
                Devices

        Allocating, Initializing, and Freeing the XkbDeviceInfoRec
                Structure

        Setting Xkb Features for Non-KeyClass Input Extension
                Devices

        XkbExtensionDeviceNotify Event
        Tracking Changes to Extension Devices

   22. Debugging Aids
   Glossary

   List of Tables

   1.1. Function Error Returns Due to Extension Problems
   2.1. Xkb Protocol Errors
   2.2. BadKeyboard Protocol Error resource_id Values
   4.1. Xkb Event Types
   4.2. XkbSelectEvents Mask Constants
   5.1. Real Modifier Masks
   5.2. Symbolic Group Names
   5.3. XkbStateNotify Event Detail Masks
   6.1. XkbDescRec Component References
   6.2. Mask Bits for XkbDescRec
   8.1. XkbIndicatorMapRec flags Field
   8.2. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_groups and groups, Keyboard
          Drives Indicator

   8.3. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_groups and groups, Indicator
          Drives Keyboard

   8.4. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_mods and mods, Keyboard Drives
          Indicator

   8.5. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_mods and mods, Indicator Drives
          Keyboard

   9.1. Predefined Bells
   9.2. Bell Sounding and Bell Event Generating
   10.1. Xkb Keyboard Controls
   10.2. MouseKeysAccel Fields
   10.3. AccessXFeedback Masks
   10.4. AccessXNotify Events
   10.5. AccessXNotify Event Details
   10.6. Xkb Controls
   10.7. Controls Mask Bits
   10.8. GroupsWrap options (groups_wrap field)
   10.9. Access X Enable/Disable Bits (ax_options field)
   11.1. Library Control Masks
   13.1. Doodad Types
   14.1. Xkb Mapping Component Masks and Convenience Functions
   14.2. XkbMapChangesRec Masks
   14.3. XkbAllocClientMap Masks
   14.4. XkbAllocServerMap Masks
   15.1. Example Key Type
   15.2. group_info Range Normalization
   15.3. Group Index Constants
   16.1. Action Types
   16.2. Modifier Action Types
   16.3. Modifier Action Flags
   16.4. Group Action Types
   16.5. Group Action Flags
   16.6. Pointer Action Types
   16.7. Pointer Button Action Types
   16.8. Pointer Button Action Flags
   16.9. Pointer Default Flags
   16.10. ISO Action Flags when XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup is Set
   16.11. ISO Action Flags when XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup is Not Set
   16.12. ISO Action Affect Field Values
   16.13. Switch Screen Action Flags
   16.14. Controls Action Types
   16.15. Control Action Flags
   16.16. Message Action Flags
   16.17. Device Button Action Types
   16.18. Device Button Action Flags
   16.19. Device Valuator v<n>_what High Bits Values
   16.20. Key Behaviors
   16.21. Explicit Component Masks
   17.1. Symbol Interpretation Match Criteria
   17.2. Compatibility Map Component Masks
   18.1. Symbolic Names Masks
   18.2. XkbNameChanges Fields
   19.1. XkbNewKeyboardNotifyEvent Details
   20.1. Server Database Keyboard Components
   20.2. XkbComponentNameRec Flags Bits
   20.3. Want and Need Mask Bits and Required Names Components
   20.4. XkbDescRec Components Returned for Values of Want & Needs
   21.1. XkbDeviceInfoRec Mask Bits
   22.1. Debug Control Masks

Acknowledgement

   This document is the result of a great deal of hard work by a
   great many people. Without Erik Fortune's work as Architect of
   the X Keyboard Extension and the longtime support of Silicon
   Graphics Inc. there would not be a keyboard extension.

   We gratefully thank Will Walker and George Sachs for their help
   and expertise in providing some of the content for this
   document, and Digital Equipment Corporation and Hewlett-Packard
   for allowing them to participate in this project, and we are
   deeply indebted to IBM for providing the funding to complete
   this library specification.

   Most of all, we thank Gary Aitken and Amber J. Benson for their
   long hours and late nights as ultimate authors of this
   specification, and for serving as authors, document editors,
   and XKB protocol and implementation reviewers. Their commitment
   to accuracy and completeness, their attention to detail, their
   keen insight, and their good natures when working under
   tremendous pressure are in some measure responsible not only
   for the quality of this document, but for the quality of the
   Keyboard extension itself.

   Matt Landau
   Manager, X Window System
   X Consortium Inc.

X Version 11, Release 7 addendum

   This document is made available to you in modern formats such
   as HTML and PDF thanks to the efforts of Matt Dew, who
   converted the original troff sources to DocBook/XML and edited
   them into shape; Fernando Carrijo, who converted the images to
   SVG format; and Gaetan Nadon, who set up the formatting
   machinery in the libX11 builds and performed further editing of
   the DocBook markup.

Chapter 1. Overview

   Table of Contents

   Core X Protocol Support for Keyboards
   Xkb Keyboard Extension Support for Keyboards
   Xkb Extension Components

        Groups and Shift Levels
        Radio Groups

   Client Types
   Compatibility With the Core Protocol
   Additional Protocol Errors
   Extension Library Functions

        Error Indications

   The X Keyboard Extension provides capabilities that are lacking
   or are cumbersome in the core X protocol.

Core X Protocol Support for Keyboards

   The core X protocol specifies the ways that the Shift, Control,
   and Lock modifiers and the modifiers bound to the Mode_switch
   or Num_Lock keysyms interact to generate keysyms and
   characters. The core protocol also allows users to specify that
   a key affects one or more modifiers. This behavior is simple
   and fairly flexible, but it has a number of limitations that
   make it difficult or impossible to properly support many common
   varieties of keyboard behavior. The limitations of core
   protocol support for keyboards include:
     * Use of a single, uniform, four-symbol mapping for all
       keyboard keys makes it difficult to properly support
       keyboard overlays, PC-style break keys, or keyboards that
       comply with ISO9995, or a host of other national and
       international standards.
     * A second keyboard group may be specified using a modifier,
       but this has side effects that wreak havoc with client
       grabs and X toolkit translations. Furthermore, this
       approach limits the number of keyboard groups to two.
     * Poorly specified locking key behavior requires X servers to
       look for a few "magic" keysyms to determine that keys
       should lock when pressed. This leads to incompatibilities
       between X servers with no way for clients to detect
       implementation differences.
     * Poorly specified capitalization and control behavior
       requires modifications to X library source code to support
       new character sets or locales and can lead to
       incompatibilities between system wide and X library
       capitalization behavior.
     * Limited interactions between modifiers specified by the
       core protocol make many common keyboard behaviors difficult
       or impossible to implement. For example, there is no
       reliable way to indicate whether or not the shift modifier
       should "cancel" the lock modifier.
     * The lack of any explicit descriptions for indicators, most
       modifiers, and other aspects of the keyboard appearance
       requires clients that wish to clearly describe the keyboard
       to a user to resort to a mish-mash of prior knowledge and
       heuristics.

Xkb Keyboard Extension Support for Keyboards

   The X Keyboard Extension makes it possible to clearly and
   explicitly specify most aspects of keyboard behavior on a
   per-key basis. It adds the notion of a keyboard group to the
   global keyboard state and provides mechanisms to more closely
   track the logical and physical state of the keyboard. For
   keyboard-control clients, Xkb provides descriptions and
   symbolic names for many aspects of keyboard appearance and
   behavior.

   In addition, the X Keyboard Extension includes additional
   keyboard controls designed to make keyboards more accessible to
   people with movement impairments.

Xkb Extension Components

   The Xkb extension is composed of two parts: a server extension,
   and a client-side X library extension. These consist of a
   loadable module that may be activated when an X server is
   started and a modified version of Xlib. Both server and Xlib
   versions must be at least X11 R6.

   Figure 1.1 shows the overall structure of the Xkb extension:
   Overall Xkb Structure

   The server portion of the Xkb extension encompasses a database
   of named keyboard components, in unspecified format, that may
   be used to configure a keyboard. Internally, the server
   maintains a keyboard description that includes the keyboard
   state and configuration (mapping). By "keyboard" we mean the
   logical keyboard device, which includes not only the physical
   keys, but also potentially a set of up to 32 indicators
   (usually LEDs) and bells.

   The keyboard description is a composite of several different
   data structures, each of which may be manipulated separately.
   When manipulating the server components, the design allows
   partial components to be transmitted between the server and a
   client. The individual components are shown in Figure 1.1.

   Client Map

   The key mapping information needed to convert arbitrary
   keycodes to symbols.

   Server Map

   The key mapping information categorizing keys by functionality
   (which keys are modifiers, how keys behave, and so on).

   Controls

   Client configurable quantities effecting how the keyboard
   behaves, such as repeat behavior and modifications for people
   with movement impairments.

   Indicators

   The mapping of behavior to indicators.

   Geometry

   A complete description of the physical keyboard layout,
   sufficient to draw a representation of the keyboard.

   Names

   A mapping of names to various aspects of the keyboard such as
   individual virtual modifiers, indicators, and bells.

   Compatibility Map

   The definition of how to map core protocol keyboard state to
   Xkb keyboard state.

   A client application interrogates and manipulates the keyboard
   by reading and writing portions of the server description for
   the keyboard. In a typical sequence a client would fetch the
   current information it is interested in, modify it, and write
   it back. If a client wishes to track some portion of the
   keyboard state, it typically maintains a local copy of the
   portion of the server keyboard description dealing with the
   items of interest and updates this local copy from events
   describing state transitions that are sent by the server.

   A client may request the server to reconfigure the keyboard
   either by sending explicit reconfiguration instructions to it,
   or by telling it to load a new configuration from its database
   of named components. Partial reconfiguration and incremental
   reconfiguration are both supported.

Groups and Shift Levels

   The graphic characters or control functions that may be
   accessed by one key are logically arranged in groups and
   levels. See section 14.1for a complete description of groups
   and levels.

Radio Groups

   A radio group is a set of keys whose behavior simulates a set
   of radio buttons. Once a key in a radio group is pressed, it
   stays logically depressed until another key in the group is
   pressed, at which point the previously depressed key is
   logically released. Consequently, at most one key in a radio
   group can be logically depressed at one time. A radio group is
   defined by a radio group index, an optional name, and by
   assigning each key in the radio group XkbKB_RadioGroup behavior
   and the radio group index.

Client Types

   This specification differentiates between three different
   classes of client applications:
     * Xkb-aware applications
       These applications make specific use of Xkb functionality
       and APIs not present in the core protocol.
     * Xkb-capable applications
       These applications make no use of Xkb extended
       functionality and Application Programming Interfaces (APIs)
       directly. However, they are linked with a version of Xlib
       that includes Xkb and indirectly benefit from some of Xkb's
       features.
     * Xkb-unaware applications
       These applications make no use of Xkb extended
       functionality or APIs and require Xkb's functionality to be
       mapped to core Xlib functionality to operate properly.

Compatibility With the Core Protocol

   Because the Xkb extension allows a keyboard to be configured in
   ways not foreseen by the core protocol, and because Xkb-unaware
   clients are allowed to connect to a server using the Xkb
   extension, there must be a means of converting between the Xkb
   domain and the core protocol. The Xkb server extension
   maintains a compatibility map as part of its keyboard
   description; this map controls the conversion of Xkb generated
   events to core protocol events and the results of core protocol
   requests to appropriate Xkb state and configuration.

Additional Protocol Errors

   The Xkb extension adds a single protocol error, BadKeyboard ,
   to the core protocol error set. See section 2.6 for a
   discussion of the BadKeyboard protocol error.

Extension Library Functions

   The X Keyboard Extension replaces the core protocol definition
   of a keyboard with a more comprehensive one. The X Keyboard
   Extension library interfaces are included in Xlib.^[1]

   Xlib detects the presence of the X Keyboard server extension
   and uses Xkb protocol to replace some standard X library
   functions related to the keyboard. If an application uses only
   standard X library functions to examine the keyboard or process
   key events, it should not need to be modified when linked with
   an X library containing the X keyboard extension. All of the
   keyboard-related X library functions have been modified to
   automatically use Xkb protocol when the server extension is
   present.

   The Xkb extension adds library interfaces to allow a client
   application to directly manipulate the new capabilities.

Error Indications

   Xkb functions that communicate with the X server check to be
   sure the Xkb extension has been properly initialized prior to
   doing any other operations. If the extension has not been
   properly initialized or the application, library, and server
   versions are incompatible, these functions return an error
   indication as shown in Table 1.1. Because of this test,
   BadAccess and BadMatch (due to incompatible versions) protocol
   errors should normally not be generated.

   Table 1.1. Function Error Returns Due to Extension Problems
   Functions return type  Return value
   pointer to a structure NULL
   Bool                   False
   Status                 BadAccess

   Many Xkb functions do not actually communicate with the X
   server; they only require processing in the client-side portion
   of the library. Furthermore, some applications may never
   actually need to communicate with the server; they simply use
   the Xkb library capabilities. The functions that do not
   communicate with the server return either a pointer to a
   structure, a Bool, or a Status. These functions check that the
   application has queried the Xkb library version and return the
   values shown in Table 1.1 if it has not.
   __________________________________________________________

   ^[1] X11R6.1 is the first release by the X Consortium,
   Inc.,that includes the X Keyboard Extension in Xlib. X11R6
   included work in progress on this extension as nonstandard
   additions to the library.

Chapter 2. Initialization and General Programming Information

   Table of Contents

   Extension Header Files
   Extension Name
   Determining Library Compatibility
   Initializing the Keyboard Extension
   Disabling the Keyboard Extension
   Protocol Errors
   Display and Device Specifications in Function Calls

Extension Header Files

   The following include files are part of the Xkb standard:
     * <X11/XKBlib.h>
       XKBlib.h is the main header file for Xkb; it declares
       constants, types, and functions.
     * <X11/extensions/XKBstr.h>
       XKBstr.h declares types and constants for Xkb. It is
       included automatically from <X11/XKBlib.h> ; you should
       never need to reference it directly in your application
       code.
     * <X11/extensions/XKB.h>
       XKB.h defines constants for Xkb. It is included
       automatically from <X11/XKBstr.h> ; you should never need
       to reference it directly in your application code.
     * <X11/extensions/XKBgeom.h>
       XKBgeom.h declares types, symbolic constants, and functions
       for manipulating keyboard geometry descriptions.

Extension Name

   The name of the Xkb extension is given in
   <X11/extensions/Xkb.h>:

   #define XkbName "XKEYBOARD"

   Most extensions to the X protocol are initialized by calling
   XInitExtension and passing the extension name. However, as
   explained in section 2.4, Xkb requires a more complex
   initialization sequence, and a client program should not call
   XInitExtension directly.

Determining Library Compatibility

   If an application is dynamically linked, both the X server and
   the client-side X library must contain the Xkb extension in
   order for the client to use the Xkb extension capabilities.
   Therefore a dynamically linked application must check both the
   library and the server for compatibility before using Xkb
   function calls. A properly written program must check for
   compatibility between the version of the Xkb library that is
   dynamically loaded and the one used when the application was
   built. It must then check the server version for compatibility
   with the version of Xkb in the library.

   If your application is statically linked, you must still check
   for server compatibility and may check library compatibility.
   (It is possible to compile against one set of header files and
   link against a different, incompatible, version of the library,
   although this should not normally occur.)

   To determine the compatibility of a library at runtime, call
   XkbLibraryVersion.
   Bool XkbLibraryVersion ( lib_major_in_out , lib_minor_in_out )
   int * lib_major_in_out; /* specifies and returns the major Xkb
   library version. */
   int * lib_minor_in_out; /* specifies and returns the minor Xkb
   library version. */

   Pass the symbolic value XkbMajorVersion in lib_major_in_out and
   XkbMinorVersion in lib_minor_in_out . These arguments represent
   the version of the library used at compile time. The
   XkbLibraryVersion function backfills the major and minor
   version numbers of the library used at run time in
   lib_major_in_out and lib_minor_in_out . If the versions of the
   compile time and run time libraries are compatible,
   XkbLibraryVersion returns True , otherwise, it returns False.

   In addition, in order to use the Xkb extension, you must ensure
   that the extension is present in the server and that the server
   supports the version of the extension expected by the client.
   Use XkbQueryExtension to do this, as described in the next
   section.

Initializing the Keyboard Extension

   Call XkbQueryExtension to check for the presence and
   compatibility of the extension in the server and to initialize
   the extension. Because of potential version mismatches, you
   cannot use the generic extension mechanism functions (
   XQueryExtension and XInitExtension ) for checking for the
   presence of, and initializing the Xkb extension.

   You must call XkbQueryExtension or XkbOpenDisplay before using
   any other Xkb library interfaces, unless such usage is
   explicitly allowed in the interface description in this
   document. The exceptions are: XkbIgnoreExtension ,
   XkbLibraryVersion , and a handful of audible-bell functions.
   You should not use any other Xkb functions if the extension is
   not present or is uninitialized. In general, calls to Xkb
   library functions made prior to initializing the Xkb extension
   cause BadAccess protocol errors.

   XkbQueryExtension both determines whether a compatible Xkb
   extension is present in the X server and initializes the
   extension when it is present.
   Bool XkbQueryExtension ( dpy, opcode_rtrn, event_rtrn,
   error_rtrn, major_in_out, minor_in_out )
   Display * dpy; /* connection to the X server */
   int * opcode_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the major extension
   opcode */
   int * event_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the extension base event
   code */
   int * error_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the extension base error
   code */
   int * major_in_out ; /* compile time lib major version in,
   server major version out */
   int * minor_in_out; /* compile time lib min version in, server
   minor version out */

   The XkbQueryExtension function determines whether a compatible
   version of the X Keyboard Extension is present in the server.
   If a compatible extension is present, XkbQueryExtension returns
   True ; otherwise, it returns False .

   If a compatible version of Xkb is present, XkbQueryExtension
   initializes the extension. It backfills the major opcode for
   the keyboard extension in opcode_rtrn , the base event code in
   event_rtrn , the base error code in error_rtrn , and the major
   and minor version numbers of the extension in major_in_out and
   minor_in_out . The major opcode is reported in the req_major
   fields of some Xkb events. For a discussion of the base event
   code, see section 4.1.

   As a convenience, you can use the function XkbOpenDisplay to
   perform these three tasks at once: open a connection to an X
   server, check for a compatible version of the Xkb extension in
   both the library and the server, and initialize the extension
   for use.
   Display * XkbOpenDisplay ( display_name, event_rtrn,
   error_rtrn, major_in_out, minor_in_out, reason_rtrn)
   char * display_name ; /* hardware display name, which
   determines the display and communications domain to be used */
   int * event_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the extension base event
   code */
   int * error_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the extension base error
   code */
   int * major_in_out ; /* compile time lib major version in,
   server major version out */
   int * minor_in_out ; /* compile time lib minor version in,
   server minor version out */
   int * reason_rtrn ; /* backfilled with a status code */

   XkbOpenDisplay is a convenience function that opens an X
   display connection and initializes the X keyboard extension. In
   all cases, upon return reason_rtrn contains a status value
   indicating success or the type of failure. If major_in_out and
   minor_in_out are not NULL , XkbOpenDisplay first calls
   XkbLibraryVersion to determine whether the client library is
   compatible, passing it the values pointed to by major_in_out
   and minor_in_out . If the library is incompatible,
   XkbOpenDisplay backfills major_in_out and minor_in_out with the
   major and minor extension versions of the library being used
   and returns NULL . If the library is compatible, XkbOpenDisplay
   next calls XOpenDisplay with the display_name . If this fails,
   the function returns NULL . If successful, XkbOpenDisplay calls
   XkbQueryExtension and backfills the major and minor Xkb server
   extension version numbers in major_in_out and minor_in_out . If
   the server extension version is not compatible with the library
   extension version or if the server extension is not present,
   XkbOpenDisplay closes the display and returns NULL . When
   successful, the function returns the display connection .

   The possible values for reason_rtrn are:
     * XkbOD_BadLibraryVersion indicates XkbLibraryVersion
       returned False.
     * XkbOD_ConnectionRefused indicates the display could not be
       opened.
     * XkbOD_BadServerVersion indicates the library and the server
       have incompatible extension versions.
     * XkbOD_NonXkbServer indicates the extension is not present
       in the X server.
     * XkbOD_Success indicates that the function succeeded.

Disabling the Keyboard Extension

   If a server supports the Xkb extension, the X library normally
   implements preXkb keyboard functions using the Xkb keyboard
   description and state. The server Xkb keyboard state may differ
   from the preXkb keyboard state. This difference does not affect
   most clients, but there are exceptions. To allow these clients
   to work properly, you may instruct the extension not to use Xkb
   functionality.

   Call XkbIgnoreExtension to prevent core X library keyboard
   functions from using the X Keyboard Extension. You must call
   XkbIgnoreExtension before you open a server connection; Xkb
   does not provide a way to enable or disable use of the
   extension once a connection is established.
   Bool XkbIgnoreExtension ( ignore )
   Bool ignore ; /* True means ignore the extension */

   XkbIgnoreExtension tells the X library whether to use the X
   Keyboard Extension on any subsequently opened X display
   connections. If ignore is True , the library does not
   initialize the Xkb extension when it opens a new display. This
   forces the X server to use compatibility mode and communicate
   with the client using only core protocol requests and events.
   If ignore is False , the library treats subsequent calls to
   XOpenDisplay normally and uses Xkb extension requests, events,
   and state. Do not explicitly use Xkb on a connection for which
   it is disabled. XkbIgnoreExtension returns False if it was
   unable to apply the ignore request.

Protocol Errors

   Many of the Xkb extension library functions described in this
   document can cause the X server to report an error, referred to
   in this document as a BadXxx protocol error, where Xxx is some
   name. These errors are fielded in the normal manner, by the
   default Xlib error handler or one replacing it. Note that X
   protocol errors are not necessarily reported immediately
   because of the buffering of X protocol requests in Xlib and the
   server.

   Table 2.1 lists the protocol errors that can be generated, and
   their causes.

   Table 2.1. Xkb Protocol Errors
   Error             Cause
   BadAccess

   The Xkb extension has not been properly initialized
   BadKeyboard

   The device specified was not a valid core or input extension
   device
   BadImplementation

   Invalid reply from server
   BadAlloc

   Unable to allocate storage
   BadMatch

   A compatible version of Xkb was not available in the server or
   an argument has correct type and range, but is otherwise
   invalid
   BadValue

   An argument is out of range
   BadAtom

   A name is neither a valid Atom or None
   BadDevice

   Device, Feedback Class, or Feedback ID invalid

   The Xkb extension adds a single protocol error, BadKeyboard ,
   to the core protocol error set. This error code will be
   reported as the error_rtrn when XkbQueryExtension is called.
   When a BadKeyboard error is reported in an XErrorEvent ,
   additional information is reported in the resource_id field.
   The most significant byte of the resource_id is a further
   refinement of the error cause, as defined in Table 2.2. The
   least significant byte will contain the device, class, or
   feedback ID as indicated in the table.

   Table 2.2. BadKeyboard Protocol Error resource_id Values
   high-order byte  value meaning low-order byte
   XkbErr_BadDevice 0xff

   device not found
   device ID
   XkbErr_BadClass  0xfe

   device found, but it is of the wrong class
   class ID
   XkbErr_BadId     0xfd

   device found, class ok, but device does not contain a feedback
   with the indicated ID
   feedback ID

Display and Device Specifications in Function Calls

   Where a connection to the server is passed as an argument
   (Display*) and an XkbDescPtr is also passed as an argument, the
   Display* argument must match the dpy field of the XkbDescRec
   pointed to by the XkbDescPtr argument, or else the dpy field of
   the XkbDescRec must be NULL . If they don't match or the dpy
   field is not NULL , a BadMatch error is returned (either in the
   return value or a backfilled Status variable). Upon successful
   return, the dpy field of the XkbDescRec always contains the
   Display* value passed in.

   The Xkb extension can communicate with the X input extension if
   it is present. Consequently, there can potentially be more than
   one input device connected to the server. Most Xkb library
   calls that require communicating with the server involve both a
   server connection (Display * dpy ) and a device identifier
   (unsigned int device_spec ). In some cases, the device
   identifier is implicit and is taken as the device_spec field of
   an XkbDescRec structure passed as an argument.

   The device identifier can specify any X input extension device
   with a KeyClass component, or it can specify the constant,
   XkbUseCoreKbd . The use of XkbUseCoreKbd allows applications to
   indicate the core keyboard without having to determine its
   device identifier.

   Where an Xkb device identifier is passed as an argument and an
   XkbDescPtr is also passed as an argument, if either the
   argument or the XkbDescRec device_spec field is XkbUseCoreKbd ,
   and if the function returns successfully, the XkbDescPtr
   device_spec field will have been converted from XkbUseCoreKbd
   to a real Xkb device ID. If the function does not complete
   successfully, the device_spec field remains unchanged.
   Subsequently, the device id argument must match the device_spec
   field of the XkbDescPtr argument. If they don't match, a
   BadMatch error is returned (either in the return value or a
   backfilled Status variable).

   When the Xkb extension in the server hands an application a
   device identifier to use for the keyboard, that ID is the input
   extension identifier for the device if the server supports the
   X Input Extension. If the server does not support the input
   extension, the meaning of the identifier is undefined -- the
   only guarantee is that when you use XkbUseCoreKbd ,
   XkbUseCoreKbd will work and the identifier returned by the
   server will refer to the core keyboard device.

Chapter 3. Data Structures

   Table of Contents

   Allocating Xkb Data Structures
   Adding Data and Editing Data Structures
   Making Changes to the Server's Keyboard Description
   Tracking Keyboard Changes in the Server
   Freeing Data Structures

   An Xkb keyboard description consists of a variety of data
   structures, each of which describes some aspect of the
   keyboard. Although each data structure has its own
   peculiarities, there are a number of features common to nearly
   all Xkb structures. This chapter describes these common
   features and techniques for manipulating them.

   Many Xkb data structures are interdependent; changing a field
   in one might require changes to others. As an additional
   complication, some Xkb library functions allocate related
   components as a group to reduce fragmentation and allocator
   overhead. In these cases, simply allocating and freeing fields
   of Xkb structures might corrupt program memory. Creating and
   destroying such structures or keeping them properly
   synchronized during editing is complicated and error prone.

   Xkb provides functions and macros to allocate and free all
   major data structures. You should use them instead of
   allocating and freeing the structures yourself.

Allocating Xkb Data Structures

   Xkb provides functions, known as allocators, to create and
   initialize Xkb data structures. In most situations, the Xkb
   functions that read a keyboard description from the server call
   these allocators automatically. As a result, you will seldom
   have to directly allocate or initialize Xkb data structures.

   However, if you need to enlarge an existing structure or
   construct a keyboard definition from scratch, you may need to
   allocate and initialize Xkb data structures directly. Each
   major Xkb data structure has its own unique allocator. The
   allocator functions share common features: allocator functions
   for structures with optional components take as an input
   argument a mask of subcomponents to be allocated. Allocators
   for data structures containing variable-length data take an
   argument specifying the initial length of the data.

   You may call an allocator to change the size of the space
   allocated for variable-length data. When you call an allocator
   with an existing data structure as a parameter, the allocator
   does not change the data in any of the fields, with one
   exception: variable-length data might be moved. The allocator
   resizes the allocated memory if the current size is too small.
   This normally involves allocating new memory, copying existing
   data to the newly allocated memory, and freeing the original
   memory. This possible reallocation is important to note because
   local variables pointing into Xkb data structures might be
   invalidated by calls to allocator functions.

Adding Data and Editing Data Structures

   You should edit most data structures via the Xkb-supplied
   helper functions and macros, although a few data structures can
   be edited directly. The helper functions and macros make sure
   everything is initialized and interdependent values are
   properly updated for those Xkb structures that have
   interdependencies. As a general rule, if there is a helper
   function or macro to edit the data structure, use it. For
   example, increasing the width of a type requires you to resize
   every key that uses that type. This is complicated and ugly,
   which is why there's an XkbResizeKeyType function.

   Many Xkb data structures have arrays whose size is reported by
   two fields. The first field, whose name is usually prefixed by
   sz_ , represents the total number of elements that can be
   stored in the array. The second field, whose name is usually
   prefixed by num_ , specifies the number of elements currently
   stored there. These arrays typically represent data whose total
   size cannot always be determined when the array is created. In
   these instances, the usual way to allocate space and add data
   is as follows:
     * Call the allocator function with some arbitrary size, as a
       hint.
     * For those arrays that have an Xkb...Add... function, call
       it each time you want to add new data to the array. The
       function expands the array if necessary.

   For example, call:

   XkbAllocGeomShapes(geom,4)

   to say "I'll need space for four new shapes in this geometry."
   This makes sure that sz_shapes - num_shapes >= 4, and resizes
   the shapes array if it isn't. If this function succeeds, you
   are guaranteed to have space for the number of shapes you need.

   When you call an editing function for a structure, you do not
   need to check for space, because the function automatically
   checks the sz_ and num_ fields of the array, resizes the array
   if necessary, adds the entry to the array, and then updates the
   num_ field.

Making Changes to the Server's Keyboard Description

   In Xkb, as in the core protocol, the client and server have
   independent copies of the data structures that describe the
   keyboard. The recommended way to change some aspect of the
   keyboard mapping in the X server is to edit a local copy of the
   Xkb keyboard description and then send only the changes to the
   X server. This method helps eliminate the need to transfer the
   entire keyboard description or even an entire data structure
   for only minor changes.

   To help you keep track of the changes you make to a local copy
   of the keyboard description, Xkb provides separate special
   changes data structures for each major Xkb data structure.
   These data structures do not contain the actual changed values:
   they only indicate the changes that have been made to the
   structures that actually describe the keyboard.

   When you wish to change the keyboard description in the server,
   you first modify a local copy of the keyboard description and
   then flag the modifications in an appropriate changes data
   structure. When you finish editing the local copy of the
   keyboard description, you pass your modified version of the
   keyboard description and the modified changes data structure to
   an Xkb function. This function uses the modified keyboard
   description and changes structure to pass only the changed
   information to the server. Note that modifying the keyboard
   description but not setting the appropriate flags in the
   changes data structure causes indeterminate behavior.

Tracking Keyboard Changes in the Server

   The server reports all changes in its keyboard description to
   any interested clients via special Xkb events. Just as clients
   use special changes data structures to change the keyboard
   description in the server, the server uses special changes data
   structures to tell a client what changed in the server's
   keyboard description.

   Unlike clients, however, the server does not always pass the
   new values when it reports changes to its copy of the keyboard
   description. Instead, the server only passes a changes data
   structure when it reports changes to its keyboard description.
   This is done for efficiency reasons -- some clients do not
   always need to update their copy of the keyboard description
   with every report from the server.

   When your client application receives a report from the server
   indicating the keyboard description has changed, you can
   determine the set of changes by passing the event to an Xkb
   function that "notes" event information in the corresponding
   changes data structure. These "note changes" functions are
   defined for all major Xkb components, and their names have the
   form XkbNote{Component}Changes , where Component is the name of
   a major Xkb component such as Map or Names . When you want to
   copy these changes from the server into a local copy of the
   keyboard description, use the corresponding
   XkbGet{Component}Changes function , passing it the changes
   structure. The function then retrieves only the changed
   structures from the server and copies the modified pieces into
   the local keyboard description.

Freeing Data Structures

   For the same reasons you should not directly use malloc to
   allocate Xkb data structures, you should not free Xkb data
   structures or components directly using free or Xfree . Xkb
   provides functions to free the various data structures and
   their components. Always use the free functions supplied by
   Xkb. There is no guarantee that any particular field can be
   safely freed by free or Xfree .

Chapter 4. Xkb Events

   Table of Contents

   Xkb Event Types
   Xkb Event Data Structures
   Selecting Xkb Events

        Event Masks

   Unified Xkb Event Type

   The primary way the X server communicates with clients is by
   sending X events to them. Some events are sent to all clients,
   while others are sent only to clients that have requested them.
   Some of the events that can be requested are associated with a
   particular window and are only sent to those clients who have
   both requested the event and specified the window in which the
   event occurred.

   The Xkb extension uses events to communicate the keyboard
   status to interested clients. These events are not associated
   with a particular window. Instead, all Xkb keyboard status
   events are reported to all interested clients, regardless of
   which window currently has the keyboard focus and regardless of
   the grab state of the keyboard.^[2]

   The X server reports the events defined by the Xkb extension to
   your client application only if you have requested them. You
   may request Xkb events by calling either XkbSelectEvents or
   XkbSelectEventDetails . XkbSelectEvents requests Xkb events by
   their event type and causes them to be reported to your client
   application under all circumstances. You can specify a finer
   granularity for event reporting by using XkbSelectEventDetails
   ; in this case events are reported only when the specific
   detail conditions you specify have been met.

Xkb Event Types

   The Xkb Extension adds new event types to the X protocol
   definition. An Xkb event type is defined by two fields in the X
   event data structure. One is the type field, containing the
   base event code. This base event code is a value the X server
   assigns to each X extension at runtime and thatidentifies the
   extension that generated the event; thus, the event code in the
   type field identifies the event as an Xkb extension event,
   rather than an event from another extension or a core X
   protocol event. You can obtain the base event code via a call
   to XkbQueryExtension or XkbOpenDisplay . The second field is
   the Xkb event type, which contains a value uniquely identifying
   each different Xkb event type. Possible values are defined by
   constants declared in the header file <X11/extensions/Xkb.h>.

   Table 4.1 lists the categories of events defined by Xkb and
   their associated event types, as defined in Xkb.h . Each event
   is described in more detail in the section referenced for that
   event.

   Table 4.1. Xkb Event Types
   Event Type Conditions Generating Event Section Page

   XkbNewKeyboardNotify

   Keyboard geometry; keycode range change

   19

   187

   XkbMapNotify

   Keyboard mapping change

   14.4

   122

   XkbStateNotify

   Keyboard state change

   5.4

   25

   XkbControlsNotify

   Keyboard controls state change

   10.11

   79

   XkbIndicatorStateNotify

   Keyboard indicators state change

   8.5

   45

   XkbIndicatorMapNotify

   Keyboard indicators map change

   8.5

   45

   XkbNamesNotify

   Keyboard name change

   18.5

   185

   XkbCompatMapNotify

   Keyboard compatibility map change

   17.5

   178

   XkbBellNotify

   Keyboard bell generated

   9.4

   52

   XkbActionMessage

   Keyboard action message

   16.1.11

   155

   XkbAccessXNotify

   AccessX state change

   10.6.4

   65

   XkbExtensionDeviceNotify

   Extension device change

   21.6

   207

Xkb Event Data Structures

   Xkb reports each event it generates in a unique structure
   holding the data values needed to describe the conditions the
   event is reporting. However, all Xkb events have certain things
   in common. These common features are contained in the same
   fields at the beginning of all Xkb event structures and are
   described in the XkbAnyEvent structure:
typedef struct {
      int                type;        /* Xkb extension base event code *
/
      unsigned long      serial;      /* X server serial number for even
t */
      Bool               send_event;  /*  True => synthetically generate
d */
      Display *          display;     /* server connection where event
generated */
      Time               time;        /* server time when event generate
d */
      int                xkb_type;    /* Xkb minor event code */
      unsigned int       device;      /* Xkb device ID, will not be
                                         XkbUseCoreKbd */
} XkbAnyEvent
;

   For any Xkb event, the type field is set to the base event code
   for the Xkb extension, assigned by the server to all Xkb
   extension events. The serial , send_event , and display fields
   are as described for all X11 events. The time field is set to
   the time when the event was generated and is expressed in
   milliseconds. The xkb_type field contains the minor extension
   event code, which is the extension event type, and is one of
   the values listed in Table 4.1. The device field contains the
   keyboard device identifier associated with the event. This is
   never XkbUseCoreKbd , even if the request that generated the
   event specified a device of XkbUseCoreKbd . If the request that
   generated the event specified XkbUseCoreKbd , device contains a
   value assigned by the server to specify the core keyboard. If
   the request that generated the event specified an X input
   extension device, device contains that same identifier.

   Other data fields specific to individual Xkb events are
   described in subsequent chapters where the events are
   described.

Selecting Xkb Events

   Xkb events are selected using an event mask, much the same as
   normal core X events are selected. However, unlike selecting
   core X events, where you must specify the selection status (on
   or off) for all possible event types whenever you wish to
   change the selection criteria for any one event, Xkb allows you
   to restrict the specification to only the event types you wish
   to change. This means that you do not need to remember the
   event selection values for all possible types each time you
   want to change one of them.

   Many Xkb event types are generated under several different
   circumstances. When selecting to receive an Xkb event, you may
   specify either that you want it delivered under all
   circumstances, or that you want it delivered only for a subset
   of the possible circumstances.

   You can also deselect an event type that was previously
   selected for, using the same granularity.

   Xkb provides two functions to select and deselect delivery of
   Xkb events. XkbSelectEvents allows you to select or deselect
   delivery of more than one Xkb event type at once. Events
   selected using XkbSelectEvents are delivered to your program
   under all circumstances that generate the events. To restrict
   delivery of an event to a subset of the conditions under which
   it occurs, use XkbSelectEventDetails . XkbSelectEventDetails
   only allows you to change the selection conditions for a single
   event at a time, but it provides a means of fine-tuning the
   conditions under which the event is delivered.

   To select and / or deselect for delivery of one or more Xkb
   events and have them delivered under all conditions, use
   XkbSelectEvents .
   Bool XkbSelectEvents ( display, device_spec, bits_to_change,
   values_for_bits )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned long int bits_to_change; /* determines events to be
   selected / deselected */
   unsigned long int values_for_bits ; /* 1=>select, 0->deselect;
   for events in bits_to_change */

   This request changes the Xkb event selection mask for the
   keyboard specified by device_spec .

   Each Xkb event that can be selected is represented by a bit in
   the bits_to_change and values_for_bits masks. Only the event
   selection bits specified by the bits_to_change parameter are
   affected; any unspecified bits are left unchanged. To turn on
   event selection for an event, set the bit for the event in the
   bits_to_change parameter and set the corresponding bit in the
   values_for_bits parameter. To turn off event selection for an
   event, set the bit for the event in the bits_to_change
   parameter and do not set the corresponding bit in the
   values_for_bits parameter. The valid values for both of these
   parameters are an inclusive bitwise OR of the masks shown in
   Table 4.2. There is no interface to return your client's
   current event selection mask. Clients cannot set other clients'
   event selection masks.

   If a bit is not set in the bits_to_change parameter, but the
   corresponding bit is set in the values_for_bits parameter, a
   BadMatch protocol error results. If an undefined bit is set in
   either the bits_to_change or the values_for_bits parameter, a
   BadValue protocol error results.

   All event selection bits are initially zero for clients using
   the Xkb extension. Once you set some bits, they remain set for
   your client until you clear them via another call to
   XkbSelectEvents .

   XkbSelectEvents returns False if the Xkb extension has not been
   initilialized and True otherwise.

   To select or deselect for a specific Xkb event and optionally
   place conditions on when events of that type are reported to
   your client, use XkbSelectEventDetails . This allows you to
   exercise a finer granularity of control over delivery of Xkb
   events with XkbSelectEvents .
   Bool XkbSelectEventDetails ( display, device_spec, event_type,
   bits_to_change , values_for_bits )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int event_type ; /* Xkb event type of interest */
   unsigned long int bits_to_change ; /* event selection details
   */
   unsigned long int values_for_bits ; /* values for bits selected
   by bits_to_change */

   While XkbSelectEvents allows multiple events to be selected,
   XkbSelectEventDetails changes the selection criteria for a
   single type of Xkb event. The interpretation of the
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits masks depends on the event
   type in question.

   XkbSelectEventDetails changes the Xkb event selection mask for
   the keyboard specified by device_spec and the Xkb event
   specified by event_type . To turn on event selection for an
   event detail, set the bit for the detail in the bits_to_change
   parameter and set the corresponding bit in the values_for_bits
   parameter. To turn off event detail selection for a detail, set
   the bit for the detail in the bits_to_change parameter and do
   not set the corresponding bit in the values_for_bits parameter.

   If an invalid event type is specified, a BadValue protocol
   error results. If a bit is not set in the bits_to_change
   parameter, but the corresponding bit is set in the
   values_for_bits parameter, a BadMatch protocol error results.
   If an undefined bit is set in either the bits_to_change or the
   values_for_bits parameter, a BadValue protocol error results.

   For each type of Xkb event, the legal event details that you
   can specify in the XkbSelectEventDetails request are listed in
   the chapters that describe each event in detail.

Event Masks

   The X server reports the events defined by Xkb to your client
   application only if you have requested them via a call to
   XkbSelectEvents or XkbSelectEventDetails . Specify the event
   types in which you are interested in a mask, as described in
   section 4.3.

   Table 4.2 lists the event mask constants that can be specified
   with the XkbSelectEvents request and the circumstances in which
   the mask should be specified.

   Table 4.2. XkbSelectEvents Mask Constants
   Event Mask Value Notification Wanted
   XkbNewKeyboardNotifyMask (1L<<0) Keyboard geometry change
   XkbMapNotifyMask (1L<<1) Keyboard mapping change

   XkbStateNotifyMask
   (1L<<2)

   Keyboard state change

   XkbControlsNotifyMask
   (1L<<3) Keyboard control change
   XkbIndicatorStateNotifyMask (1L<<4) Keyboard indicator state
   change
   XkbIndicatorMapNotifyMask (1L<<5) Keyboard indicator map change
   XkbNamesNotifyMask (1L<<6) Keyboard name change
   XkbCompatMapNotifyMask (1L<<7) Keyboard compat map change
   XkbBellNotifyMask (1L<<8) Bell
   XkbActionMessageMask (1L<<9) Action message
   XkbAccessXNotifyMask (1L<<10) AccessX features
   XkbExtensionDeviceNotifyMask (1L<<11) Extension device
   XkbAllEventsMask (0xFFF) All Xkb events

Unified Xkb Event Type

   The XkbEvent structure is a union of the individual structures
   declared for each Xkb event type and for the core protocol
   XEvent type. Given an XkbEvent structure, you may use the type
   field to determine if the event is an Xkb event ( type equals
   the Xkb base event code; see section 2.4). If the event is an
   Xkb event, you may then use the any.xkb_type field to determine
   the type of Xkb event and thereafter access the event-dependent
   components using the union member corresponding to the
   particular Xkb event type.
typedef union _XkbEvent {
      int                            type;
      XkbAnyEvent                    any;
      XkbStateNotifyEvent            state;
      XkbMapNotifyEvent              map;
      XkbControlsNotifyEvent         ctrls;
      XkbIndicatorNotifyEvent        indicators;
      XkbBellNotifyEvent             bell;
      XkbAccessXNotifyEvent          accessx;
      XkbNamesNotifyEvent            names;
      XkbCompatMapNotifyEvent        compat;
      XkbActionMessageEvent          message;
      XkbExtensionDeviceNotifyEvent  device;
      XkbNewKeyboardNotifyEvent      new_kbd;
      XEvent                         core;
} XkbEvent;

   This unified Xkb event type includes a normal XEvent as used by
   the core protocol, so it is straightforward for applications
   that use Xkb events to call the X library event functions
   without having to cast every reference. For example, to get the
   next event, you can simply declare a variable of type XkbEvent
   and call:

   XNextEvent(dpy,&xkbev.core);
   __________________________________________________________

   ^[2] The one exception to this rule is the
   XkbExtensionDeviceNotify event report that is sent when a
   client attempts to use an unsupported feature of an X Input
   Extension device (see section 21.4).

Chapter 5. Keyboard State

   Table of Contents

   Keyboard State Description
   Changing the Keyboard State

        Changing Modifiers
        Changing Groups

   Determining Keyboard State
   Tracking Keyboard State

   Keyboard state encompasses all of the transitory information
   necessary to map a physical key press or release to an
   appropriate event. The Xkb keyboard state consists of primitive
   components and additional derived components that are
   maintained for efficiency reasons. Figure 5.1 shows the
   components of Xkb keyboard state and their relationships.
   Xkb State

Keyboard State Description

   The Xkb keyboard state is comprised of the state of all
   keyboard modifiers, the keyboard group, and the state of the
   pointer buttons. These are grouped into the following
   components:
     * The locked group and locked modifiers
     * The latched group and latched modifiers
     * The base group and base modifiers
     * The effective group and effective modifiers
     * The state of the core pointer buttons

   The modifiers are Shift , Lock , Control , and Mod1 - Mod5 , as
   defined by the core protocol. A modifier can be thought of as a
   toggle that is either set or unset. All modifiers are initially
   unset. When a modifier is locked, it is set and remains set for
   all future key events, until it is explicitly unset. A latched
   modifier is set, but automatically unsets after the next key
   event that does not change the keyboard state. Locked and
   latched modifier state can be changed by keyboard activity or
   via Xkb extension library functions.

   The Xkb extension provides support for keysym groups , as
   defined by ISO9995:

   Group

   A logical state of a keyboard providing access to a collection
   of characters. A group usually contains a set of characters
   that logically belong together and that may be arranged on
   several shift levels within that group.

   The Xkb extension supports up to four keysym groups. Groups are
   named beginning with one and indexed beginning with zero. All
   group states are indicated using the group index. At any point
   in time, there is zero or one locked group, zero or one latched
   group, and one base group. When a group is locked, it
   supersedes any previous locked group and remains the locked
   group for all future key events, until a new group is locked. A
   latched group applies only to the next key event that does not
   change the keyboard state. The locked and latched group can be
   changed by keyboard activity or via Xkb extension library
   functions.

   Changing to a different group changes the keyboard state to
   produce characters from a different group. Groups are typically
   used to switch between keysyms of different languages and
   locales.

   The pointer buttons are Button1 - Button5 , as defined by the
   core protocol.

   The base group and base modifiers represent keys that are
   physically or logically down. These and the pointer buttons can
   be changed by keyboard activity and not by Xkb requests. It is
   possible for a key to be logically down, but not physically
   down, and neither latched nor locked. ^[3]

   The effective modifiers are the bitwise union of the locked,
   latched, and the base modifiers.

   The effective group is the arithmetic sum of the group indices
   of the latched group, locked group, and base group, which is
   then normalized by some function. The result is a meaningful
   group index.
   n = number of keyboard groups, 1<= n <= 4
   0 <= any of locked, latched, or base group < n
   effective group = f(locked group + latched group + base group)

   The function f ensures that the effective group is within
   range. The precise function is specified for the keyboard and
   can be retrieved through the keyboard description. It may wrap
   around, clamp down, or default. Few applications will actually
   examine the effective group, and far fewer still will examine
   the locked, latched, and base groups.

   There are two circumstances under which groups are normalized:
    1. The global locked or effective group changes. In this case,
       the changed group is normalized into range according to the
       settings of the groups_wrap field of the XkbControlsRec
       structure for the keyboard (see section 10.7.1).
    2. The Xkb library is interpreting an event with an effective
       group that is legal for the keyboard as a whole, but not
       for the key in question. In this case, the group to use for
       this event only is determined using the group_info field of
       the key symbol mapping ( XkbSymMapRec ) for the event key.

   Each nonmodifier key on a keyboard has zero or more symbols, or
   keysyms, associated with it. These are the logical symbols that
   the key can generate when it is pressed. The set of all
   possible keysyms for a keyboard is divided into groups. Each
   key is associated with zero or more groups; each group contains
   one or more symbols. When a key is pressed, the determination
   of which symbol for the key is selected is based on the
   effective group and the shift level, which is determined by
   which modifiers are set.

   A client that does not explicitly call Xkb functions, but that
   otherwise makes use of an X library containing the Xkb
   extension, will have keyboard state represented in bits 0 - 14
   of the state field of events that report modifier and button
   state. Such a client is said to be Xkb-capable . A client that
   does explicitly call Xkb functions is an Xkb-aware client. The
   Xkb keyboard state includes information derived from the
   effective state and from two server parameters that can be set
   through the keyboard extension. The following components of
   keyboard state pertain to Xkb-capable and Xkb-aware clients:
     * lookup state: lookup group and lookup modifiers
     * grab state: grab group and grab modifiers

   The lookup modifiers and lookup group are represented in the
   state field of core X events. The modifier state and keycode of
   a key event are used to determine the symbols associated with
   the event. For KeyPress and KeyRelease events, the lookup
   modifiers are computed as:

      ((base | latched | locked) & ~ server_internal_modifiers)

   Otherwise the lookup modifiers are computed as:

   (((base | latched | (locked & ~ ignore_locks)) & ~ server_inter
   nal_modifiers)

   The lookup group is the same as the effective group.

   When an Xkb-capable or Xkb-aware client wishes to map a keycode
   to a keysym, it should use the lookup state -- the lookup group
   and the lookup modifiers.

   The grab state is the state used when matching events to
   passive grabs. If the event activates a grab, the grab
   modifiers and grab group are represented in the state field of
   core X events; otherwise, the lookup state is used. The grab
   modifiers are computed as:

   (((base | latched | (locked & ~ignore_locks)) & ~server_interna
   l_modifiers)

   If the server's IgnoreGroupLock control (see section 10.7.3) is
   not set, the grab group is the same as the effective group.
   Otherwise, the grab group is computed from the base group and
   latched group, ignoring the locked group.

   The final three components of Xkb state are applicable to
   clients that are not linked with an Xlib containing the X
   keyboard extension library and therefore are not aware of the
   keyboard extension ( Xkb-unaware clients):
     * The compatibility modifier state
     * The compatibility lookup modifier state
     * The compatibility grab modifier state

   The X11 protocol interpretation of modifiers does not include
   direct support for multiple groups. When an Xkb-extended X
   server connects to an Xkb-unaware client, the compatibility
   states remap the keyboard group into a core modifier whenever
   possible. The compatibility state corresponds to the effective
   modifier and effective group state, with the group remapped to
   a modifier. The compatibility lookup and grab states correspond
   to the lookup and grab states, respectively, with the group
   remapped to a modifier. The compatibility lookup state is
   reported in events that do not trigger passive grabs;
   otherwise, the compatibility grab state is reported.

Changing the Keyboard State

Changing Modifiers

   The functions in this section that change the use of modifiers
   use a mask in the parameter affect . It is a bitwise inclusive
   OR of the legal modifier masks:

   Table 5.1. Real Modifier Masks
   Mask
   ShiftMask
   LockMask
   ControlMask
   Mod1Mask
   Mod2Mask
   Mod3Mask
   Mod4Mask
   Mod5Mask

   To lock and unlock any of the eight real keyboard modifiers,
   use XkbLockModifiers:
   Bool XkbLockModifiers ( display, device_spec, affect, values )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int affect ; /* mask of real modifiers whose lock
   state is to change */
   unsigned int values ; /* 1 => lock, 0 => unlock; only for
   modifiers selected by affect */

   XkbLockModifiers sends a request to the server to lock the real
   modifiers selected by both affect and values and to unlock the
   real modifiers selected by affect but not selected by values .
   XkbLockModifiers does not wait for a reply from the server. It
   returns True if the request was sent, and False otherwise.

   To latch and unlatch any of the eight real keyboard modifiers,
   use XkbLatchModifiers:
   Bool XkbLatchModifiers (d isplay, device_spec, affect, values )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int affect ; /* mask of modifiers whose latch state is
   to change */
   unsigned int values; /* 1 => latch, 0 => unlatch; only for mods
   selected by affect */

   XkbLatchModifiers sends a request to the server to latch the
   real modifiers selected by both affect and values and to
   unlatch the real modifiers selected by affect but not selected
   by values . XkbLatchModifiers does not wait for a reply from
   the server. It returns True if the request was sent, and False
   otherwise.

Changing Groups

   Reference the keysym group indices with these symbolic
   constants:

   Table 5.2. Symbolic Group Names
   Symbolic Name  Value
   XkbGroup1Index 0
   XkbGroup2Index 1
   XkbGroup3Index 2
   XkbGroup4Index 3

   To lock the keysym group, use XkbLockGroup.
   Bool XkbLockGroup ( display, device_spec, group )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int group ; /* index of the keysym group to lock */

   XkbLockGroup sends a request to the server to lock the
   specified group and does not wait for a reply. It returns True
   if the request was sent and False otherwise.

   To latch the keysym group, use XkbLatchGroup.
   Bool XkbLatchGroup ( display, device_spec, group )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int group ; /* index of the keysym group to latch */

   XkbLatchGroup sends a request to the server to latch the
   specified group and does not wait for a reply. It returns True
   if the request was sent and False otherwise.

Determining Keyboard State

   Xkb keyboard state may be represented in an XkbStateRec
   structure:
typedef struct {
      unsigned char            group;                /* effective group
index */
      unsigned char            base_group;           /* base group index
 */
      unsigned char            latched_group;        /* latched group in
dex */
      unsigned char            locked_group;         /* locked group ind
ex */
      unsigned char            mods;                 /* effective modifi
ers */
      unsigned char            base_mods;            /* base modifiers *
/
      unsigned char            latched_mods;         /* latched modifier
s */
      unsigned char            locked_mods;          /* locked modifiers
 */
      unsigned char            compat_state;         /* effective group
=> modifiers */
      unsigned char            grab_mods;            /* modifiers used f
or grabs */
      unsigned char            compat_grab_mods;     /* mods used for co
mpatibility mode grabs */
      unsigned char            lookup_mods;          /* modifiers used t
o lookup symbols */
      unsigned char            compat_lookup_mods;   /* mods used for co
mpatibility lookup */
      unsigned short            ptr_buttons;         /* 1 bit => corresp
onding pointer btn is down */
}
XkbStateRec
,*XkbStatePtr;

   To obtain the keyboard state, use XkbGetState.
   Status XkbGetState ( display , device_spec , state_return )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   XkbStatePtr state_return ; /* backfilled with Xkb state */

   The XkbGetState function queries the server for the current
   keyboard state, waits for a reply, and then backfills
   state_return with the results.

   All group values are expressed as group indices in the range
   [0..3]. Modifiers and the compatibility modifier state values
   are expressed as the bitwise union of the core X11 modifier
   masks. The pointer button state is reported as in the core X11
   protocol.

Tracking Keyboard State

   The Xkb extension reports XkbStateNotify events to clients
   wanting notification whenever the Xkb state changes. The
   changes reported include changes to any aspect of the keyboard
   state: when a modifier is set or unset, when the current group
   changes, or when a pointer button is pressed or released. As
   with all Xkb events, XkbStateNotify events are reported to all
   interested clients without regard to the current keyboard input
   focus or grab state.

   There are many different types of Xkb state changes. Xkb
   defines an event detail mask corresponding to each type of
   change. The event detail masks are listed in Table 5.3.

   Table 5.3. XkbStateNotify Event Detail Masks
   Mask                      Value
   XkbModifierStateMask      (1L << 0)
   XkbModifierBaseMask       (1L << 1)
   XkbModifierLatchMask      (1L << 2)
   XkbModifierLockMask       (1L << 3)
   XkbGroupStateMask         (1L << 4)
   XkbGroupBaseMask          (1L << 5)
   XkbGroupLatchMask         (1L << 6)
   XkbGroupLockMask          (1L << 7)
   XkbCompatStateMask        (1L << 8)
   XkbGrabModsMask           (1L << 9)
   XkbCompatGrabModsMask     (1L << 10)
   XkbLookupModsMask         (1L << 11)
   XkbCompatLookupModsMask   (1L << 12)
   XkbPointerButtonMask      (1L << 13)
   XkbAllStateComponentsMask (0x3fff)

   To track changes in the keyboard state for a particular device,
   select to receive XkbStateNotify events by calling either
   XkbSelectEvents or XkbSelectEventDetails (see section 4.3).

   To receive XkbStateNotify events under all possible conditions,
   use XkbSelectEvents and pass XkbStateNotifyMask in both
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits .

   To receive XkbStateNotify events only under certain conditions,
   use XkbSelectEventDetails using XkbStateNotify as the
   event_type and specifying the desired state changes in
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits using mask bits from Table
   5.3.

   The structure for XkbStateNotify events is:
typedef struct {
      int            type;            /* Xkb extension base event code *
/
      unsigned long  serial;          /* X server serial number for even
t */
      Bool           send_event;      /*  True => synthetically generate
d */
      Display *      display;         /* server connection where event g
enerated */
      Time           time;            /* server time when event generate
d */
      int            xkb_type;        /*  XkbStateNotify */
      int            device;          /* Xkb device ID, will not be  Xkb
UseCoreKbd */
      unsigned int   changed;         /* bits indicating what has change
d */
      int            group;           /* group index of effective group
*/
      int            base_group;      /* group index of base group */
      int            latched_group;   /* group index of latched group */
      int            locked_group;    /* group index of locked group */
      unsigned int   mods;            /* effective modifiers */
      unsigned int   base_mods;       /* base modifiers */
      unsigned int   latched_mods;    /* latched modifiers */
      unsigned int   locked_mods;     /* locked modifiers */
      int            compat_state;    /* computed compatibility state */
      unsigned char  grab_mods;       /* modifiers used for grabs */
      unsigned char  compat_grab_mods;  /* modifiers used for compatibil
ity grabs */
      unsigned char  lookup_mods;     /* modifiers used to lookup symbol
s */
      unsigned char  compat_lookup_mods;                  /* mods used f
or compatibility look up */
      int            ptr_buttons;     /* core pointer buttons */
      KeyCode        keycode;         /* keycode causing event, 0 if pro
grammatic */
      char           event_type;      /* core event if  req_major or
                                          req_minor non zero */
      char           req_major;       /* major request code if program t
rigger, else 0 */
      char           req_minor;       /* minor request code if program t
rigger, else 0 */
} XkbStateNotifyEvent
;

   When you receive an XkbStateNotify event, the changed field
   indicates which elements of keyboard state have changed. This
   will be the bitwise inclusive OR of one or more of the
   XkbStateNotify event detail masks shown in Table 5.3. All
   fields reported in the event are valid, but only those
   indicated in changed have changed values.

   The group field is the group index of the effective keysym
   group. The base_group , latched_group , and locked_group fields
   are set to a group index value representing the base group, the
   latched group, and the locked group, respectively. The X server
   can set the modifier and compatibility state fields to a union
   of the core modifier mask bits; this union represents the
   corresponding modifier states. The ptr_button field gives the
   state of the core pointer buttons as a mask composed of an
   inclusive OR of zero or more of the core pointer button masks.

   Xkb state changes can occur either in response to keyboard
   activity or under application control. If a key event caused
   the state change, the keycode field gives the keycode of the
   key event, and the event_type field is set to either KeyPress
   or KeyRelease . If a pointer button event caused the state
   change, the keycode field is zero, and the event_type field is
   set to either ButtonPress or ButtonRelease . Otherwise, the
   major and minor codes of the request that caused the state
   change are given in the req_major and req_minor fields, and the
   keycode field is zero. The req_major value is the same as the
   major extension opcode.
   __________________________________________________________

   ^[3] Keys may be logically down when they are physically up
   because of their electrical properties or because of the
   keyboard extension in the X server having filtered the key
   release, for esoteric reasons.

Chapter 6. Complete Keyboard Description

   Table of Contents

   The XkbDescRec Structure
   Obtaining a Keyboard Description from the Server
   Tracking Changes to the Keyboard Description in the Server
   Allocating and Freeing a Keyboard Description

   The complete Xkb description for a keyboard device is accessed
   using a single structure containing pointers to major Xkb
   components. This chapter describes this single structure and
   provides references to other sections of this document that
   discuss the major Xkb components in detail.

The XkbDescRec Structure

   The complete description of an Xkb keyboard is given by an
   XkbDescRec . The component structures in the XkbDescRec
   represent the major Xkb components outlined in Figure 1.1.
typedef struct {
      struct _XDisplay *                  display;            /* connect
ion to
X server */
      unsigned short                  flags;            /* private to Xk
b, do
not modify */
      unsigned short                  device_spec;            /* device
of
interest */
      KeyCode                  min_key_code;            /* minimum keyco
de for
device */
      KeyCode                  max_key_code;            /* maximum keyco
de for
device */
      XkbControlsPtr                  ctrls;            /* controls */
      XkbServerMapPtr                  server;            /* server keym
ap */
      XkbClientMapPtr                  map;            /* client keymap
*/
      XkbIndicatorPtr                  indicators;            /* indicat
or map
*/
      XkbNamesPtr                  names;            /* names for all
components */
      XkbCompatMapPtr                  compat;            /* compatibili
ty map
*/
      XkbGeometryPtr                  geom;            /* physical geome
try of
keyboard */
}
XkbDescRec
, *XkbDescPtr;

   The display field points to an X display structure. The flags
   field is private to the library: modifying flags may yield
   unpredictable results. The device_spec field specifies the
   device identifier of the keyboard input device, or
   XkbUseCoreKeyboard , which specifies the core keyboard device.
   The min_key_code and max_key_code fields specify the least and
   greatest keycode that can be returned by the keyboard.

   The other fields specify structure components of the keyboard
   description and are described in detail in other sections of
   this document. Table 6.1 identifies the subsequent sections of
   this document that discuss the individual components of the
   XkbDescRec .

   Table 6.1. XkbDescRec Component References
   XkbDescRec Field For more info
   ctrls            Chapter 10
   server           Chapter 16
   map              Chapter 15
   indicators       Chapter 8
   names            Chapter 18
   compat           Chapter 17
   geom             Chapter 13

   Each structure component has a corresponding mask bit that is
   used in function calls to indicate that the structure should be
   manipulated in some manner, such as allocating it or freeing
   it. These masks and their relationships to the fields in the
   XkbDescRec are shown in Table 6.2.

   Table 6.2. Mask Bits for XkbDescRec
   Mask Bit             XkbDescRec Field Value
   XkbControlsMask      ctrls            (1L<<0)
   XkbServerMapMask     server           (1L<<1)
   XkbIClientMapMask    map              (1L<<2)
   XkbIndicatorMapMask  indicators       (1L<<3)
   XkbNamesMask         names            (1L<<4)
   XkbCompatMapMask     compat           (1L<<5)
   XkbGeometryMask      geom             (1L<<6)
   XkbAllComponentsMask All Fields       (0x7f)

Obtaining a Keyboard Description from the Server

   To retrieve one or more components of a keyboard device
   description, use XkbGetKeyboard (see also XkbGetKeyboardbyName
   ).
   XkbDescPtr XkbGetKeyboard ( display, which, device_spec )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask indicating components to return */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device for which to fetch
   description, or XkbUseCoreKbd */

   XkbGetKeyboard allocates and returns a pointer to a keyboard
   description. It queries the server for those components
   specified in the which parameter for device device_spec and
   copies the results to the XkbDescRec it allocated. The
   remaining fields in the keyboard description are set to NULL .
   The valid masks for which are those listed in Table 6.2.

   XkbGetKeyboard can generate BadAlloc protocol errors.

   To free the returned keyboard description, use XkbFreeKeyboard
   (see section 6.4).

Tracking Changes to the Keyboard Description in the Server

   The server can generate events whenever its copy of the
   keyboard description for a device changes. Refer to section
   14.4 for detailed information on tracking changes to the
   keyboard description.

Allocating and Freeing a Keyboard Description

   Applications seldom need to directly allocate a keyboard
   description; calling XkbGetKeyboard usually suffices. In the
   event you need to create a keyboard description from scratch,
   however, use XkbAllocKeyboard rather than directly calling
   malloc or Xmalloc .
   XkbDescRec * XkbAllocKeyboard (void)

   If XkbAllocKeyboard fails to allocate the keyboard description,
   it returns NULL . Otherwise, it returns a pointer to an empty
   keyboard description structure. The device_spec field will have
   been initialized to XkbUseCoreKbd . You may then either fill in
   the structure components or use Xkb functions to obtain values
   for the structure components from a keyboard device.

   To destroy either an entire an XkbDescRec or just some of its
   members, use XkbFreeKeyboard.
   void XkbFreeKeyboard (xkb, which, free_all )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description with components to
   free */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask selecting components to free */
   Bool free_all ; /* True => free all components and xkb */

   XkbFreeKeyboard frees the components of xkb specified by which
   and sets the corresponding values to NULL . If free_all is True
   , XkbFreeKeyboard frees every non- NULL component of xkb and
   then frees the xkb structure itself.

Chapter 7. Virtual Modifiers

   Table of Contents

   Virtual Modifier Names and Masks
   Modifier Definitions
   Binding Virtual Modifiers to Real Modifiers
   Virtual Modifier Key Mapping

        Inactive Modifier Sets

   Conventions
   Example

   The core protocol specifies that certain keysyms, when bound to
   modifiers, affect the rules of keycode to keysym interpretation
   for all keys; for example, when the Num_Lock keysym is bound to
   some modifier, that modifier is used to select between shifted
   and unshifted state for the numeric keypad keys. The core
   protocol does not provide a convenient way to determine the
   mapping of modifier bits (in particular Mod1 through Mod5 ) to
   keysyms such as Num_Lock and Mode_switch . Using the core
   protocol only, a client application must retrieve and search
   the modifier map to determine the keycodes bound to each
   modifier, and then retrieve and search the keyboard mapping to
   determine the keysyms bound to the keycodes. It must repeat
   this process for all modifiers whenever any part of the
   modifier mapping is changed.

   Xkb alleviates these problems by defining virtual modifiers. In
   addition to the eight core modifiers, referred to as the real
   modifiers , Xkb provides a set of sixteen named virtual
   modifiers . Each virtual modifier can be bound to any set of
   the real modifiers ( Shift , Lock , Control, and Mod1 - Mod5 ).

   The separation of function from physical modifier bindings
   makes it easier to specify more clearly the intent of a
   binding. X servers do not all assign modifiers the same way --
   for example, Num_Lock might be bound to Mod2 for one vendor and
   to Mod4 for another. This makes it cumbersome to automatically
   remap the keyboard to a desired configuration without some kind
   of prior knowledge about the keyboard layout and bindings. With
   XKB, applications can use virtual modifiers to specify the
   desired behavior, without regard for the actual physical
   bindings in effect.

Virtual Modifier Names and Masks

   Virtual modifiers are named by converting their string name to
   an X Atom and storing the Atom in the names.vmods array in an
   XkbDescRec structure (see section 6.1). The position of a name
   Atom in the names.vmods array defines the bit position used to
   represent the virtual modifier and also the index used when
   accessing virtual modifier information in arrays: the name in
   the i-th (0 relative) entry of names.vmods is the i-th virtual
   modifier, represented by the mask (1<<i). Throughout Xkb,
   various functions have a parameter that is a mask representing
   virtual modifier choices. In each case, the i-th bit (0
   relative) of the mask represents the i-th virtual modifier.

   To set the name of a virtual modifier, use XkbSetNames , using
   XkbVirtualModNamesMask in which and the name in the xkb
   argument; to retrieve indicator names, use XkbGetNames . These
   functions are discussed in Chapter 18.

Modifier Definitions

   An Xkb modifier definition enumerates a collection of real and
   virtual modifiers but does not in itself bind those modifiers
   to any particular key or to each other. Modifier definitions
   are included in a number of structures in the keyboard
   description to define the collection of modifiers that affect
   or are affected by some other entity. A modifier definition is
   relevant only in the context of some other entity such as an
   indicator map, a control, or a key type. (See sections 8.2.2,
   10.8, and 15.2.)
typedef struct _XkbMods {
      unsigned char            mask;            /* real_mods | vmods map
ped to
real modifiers */
      unsigned char            real_mods;            /* real modifier bi
ts */
      unsigned short             vmods;            /* virtual modifier b
its */
}
XkbModsRec
,*XkbModsPtr;

   An Xkb modifier definition consists of a set of bit masks
   corresponding to the eight real modifiers ( real_mods ); a
   similar set of bitmasks corresponding to the 16 named virtual
   modifiers ( vmods ); and an effective mask ( mask ). The
   effective mask represents the set of all real modifiers that
   can logically be set either by setting any of the real
   modifiers or by setting any of the virtual modifiers in the
   definition. mask is derived from the real and virtual modifiers
   and should never be explicitly changed -- it contains all of
   the real modifiers specified in the definition ( real_mods )
   plus any real modifiers that are bound to the virtual modifiers
   specified in the definition ( vmods ). The binding of the
   virtual modifiers to real modifiers is exterior to the modifier
   definition. Xkb automatically recomputes the mask field of
   modifier definitions as necessary. Whenever you access a
   modifier definition that has been retrieved using an Xkb
   library function, the mask field will be correct for the
   keyboard mapping of interest.

Binding Virtual Modifiers to Real Modifiers

   The binding of virtual modifiers to real modifiers is defined
   by the server.vmods array in an XkbDescRec structure. Each
   entry contains the real modifier bits that are bound to the
   virtual modifier corresponding to the entry. The overall
   relationship of fields dealing with virtual modifiers in the
   server keyboard description are shown in Figure 16.2.

Virtual Modifier Key Mapping

   Xkb maintains a virtual modifier mapping , which lists the
   virtual modifiers associated with, or bound to, each key. The
   real modifiers bound to a virtual modifier always include all
   of the modifiers bound to any of the keys that specify that
   virtual modifier in their virtual modifier mapping. The
   server.vmodmap array indicates which virtual modifiers are
   bound to each key; each entry is a bitmask for the virtual
   modifier bits. The server.vmodmap array is indexed by keycode.

   The vmodmap and vmods members of the server map are the
   "master" virtual modifier definitions. Xkb automatically
   propagates any changes to these fields to all other fields that
   use virtual modifier mappings (see section 16.4).

   For example, if Mod3 is bound to the Num_Lock key by the core
   protocol modifier mapping, and the NumLock virtual modifier is
   bound to they Num_Lock key by the virtual modifier mapping,
   Mod3 is added to the set of modifiers associated with NumLock .

   The virtual modifier mapping is normally updated whenever
   actions are automatically applied to symbols (see section 16.4
   for details), and few applications should need to change the
   virtual modifier mapping explicitly.

   Use XkbGetMap (see section 14.2) to get the virtual modifiers
   from the server or use XkbGetVirtualMods (see section 16.4.1)
   to update a local copy of the virtual modifiers bindings from
   the server. To set the binding of a virtual modifier to a real
   modifier, use XkbSetMap (see section 14.3 ).

   To determine the mapping of virtual modifiers to core X
   protocol modifiers, use XkbVirtualModsToReal .
   Bool XkbVirtualModsToReal ( xkb, virtual_mask, mask_rtrn )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description for input device */
   unsigned int virtual_mask ; /* virtual modifier mask to
   translate */
   unsigned int * mask_rtrn ; /* backfilled with real modifiers */

   If the keyboard description defined by xkb includes bindings
   for virtual modifiers, XkbVirtualModsToReal uses those bindings
   to determine the set of real modifiers that correspond to the
   set of virtual modifiers specified in virtual_mask . The
   virtual_mask parameter is a mask specifying the virtual
   modifiers to translate; the i-th bit (0 relative) of the mask
   represents the i-th virtual modifier. If mask_rtrn is non- NULL
   , XkbVirtualModsToReal backfills it with the resulting real
   modifier mask. If the keyboard description in xkb does not
   include virtual modifier bindings, XkbVirtualModsToReal returns
   False ; otherwise, it returns True .

Note

   It is possible for a local (client-side) keyboard description
   (the xkb parameter) to not contain any virtual modifier
   information (simply because the client has not requested it)
   while the server's corresponding definition may contain virtual
   modifier information.

Inactive Modifier Sets

   An unbound virtual modifier is one that is not bound to any
   real modifier ( server -> vmods [virtual_modifier_index] is
   zero).

   Some Xkb operations ignore modifier definitions in which the
   virtual modifiers are unbound. Consider this example:

   if (state matches {Shift}) Do OneThing;
   if (state matches {Shift+NumLock}) Do Another;

   If the NumLock virtual modifier is not bound to any real
   modifiers, the effective masks for these two cases are
   identical (that is, contain only Shift ). When it is essential
   to distinguish between OneThing and Another, Xkb considers only
   those modifier definitions for which all virtual modifiers are
   bound.

Conventions

   The Xkb extension does not require any specific virtual
   modifier names. However, everyone benefits if the same names
   are used for common modifiers. The following names are
   suggested:

     NumLock
     ScrollLock
     Alt
     Meta
     AltGr
     LevelThree

Example

   If the second (0-relative) entry in names.vmods contains the
   Atom for "NumLock", then 0x4 (1<<2) is the virtual modifier bit
   for the NumLock virtual modifier. If server.vmods [2] contains
   Mod3Mask , then the NumLock virtual modifier is bound to the
   Mod3 real modifier.

   A virtual modifier definition for this example would have:
     real_mods = 0
     vmods = 0x4 (NumLock named virtual modifier)
     mask = 0x20 (Mod3Mask)

   Continuing the example, if the keyboard has a Num_Lock keysym
   bound to the key with keycode 14, and the NumLock virtual
   modifier is bound to this key, server.vmodmap [14] contains
   0x4.

   Finally, if the keyboard also used the real Mod1 modifier for
   numeric lock operations, the modifier definition below would
   represent the situation where either the key bound to Mod1 or
   the NumLock virtual modifier could be used for this purpose:
     real_mods = 0x8 (Mod1Mask)
     vmods = 0x4 (NumLock named virtual modifier)
     mask = 0x28 (Mod1Mask | Mod3Mask)

Chapter 8. Indicators

   Table of Contents

   Indicator Names
   Indicator Data Structures

        XkbIndicatorRec
        XkbIndicatorMapRec

   Getting Information About Indicators

        Getting Indicator State
        Getting Indicator Information by Index
        Getting Indicator Information by Name

   Changing Indicator Maps and State

        Effects of Explicit Changes on Indicators
        Changing Indicator Maps by Index
        Changing Indicator Maps by Name
        The XkbIndicatorChangesRec Structure

   Tracking Changes to Indicator State or Map
   Allocating and Freeing Indicator Maps

   Although the core X implementation supports up to 32 LEDs on an
   input device, it does not provide any linkage between the state
   of the LEDs and the logical state of the input device. For
   example, most keyboards have a CapsLock LED, but X does not
   provide a mechanism to make the LED automatically follow the
   logical state of the CapsLock key.

   Furthermore, the core X implementation does not provide clients
   with the ability to determine what bits in the led_mask field
   of the XKeyboardState map to the particular LEDs on the
   keyboard. For example, X does not provide a method for a client
   to determine what bit to set in the led_mask field to turn on
   the Scroll Lock LED or whether the keyboard even has a Scroll
   Lock LED.

   Xkb provides indicator names and programmable indicators to
   help solve these problems. Using Xkb, clients can determine the
   names of the various indicators, determine and control the way
   that the individual indicators should be updated to reflect
   keyboard changes, and determine which of the 32 keyboard
   indicators reported by the protocol are actually present on the
   keyboard. Clients may also request immediate notification of
   changes to the state of any subset of the keyboard indicators,
   which makes it straightforward to provide an on-screen
   "virtual" LED panel. This chapter describes Xkb indicators and
   the functions used for manipulating them.

Indicator Names

   Xkb provides the capability of symbolically naming indicators.
   Xkb itself doesn't use these symbolic names for anything; they
   are there only to help make the keyboard description
   comprehensible to humans. To set the names of specific
   indicators, use XkbSetNames as discussed in Chapter 18. Then
   set the map using XkbSetMap (see section 14.3) or
   XkbSetNamedIndicator (below). To retrieve indicator names, use
   XkbGetNames (Chapter 18).

Indicator Data Structures

   Use the indicator description record, XkbIndicatorRec , and its
   indicator map, XkbIndicatorMapRec , to inquire about and
   control most indicator properties and behaviors.

XkbIndicatorRec

   The description for all the Xkb indicators is held in the
   indicators field of the complete keyboard description (see
   Chapter 6), which is defined as follows:
#define      XkbNumIndicators      32

typedef struct {
      unsigned long                   phys_indicators;        /* LEDs ex
istence */
      XkbIndicatorMapRec              maps[XkbNumIndicators]; /* indicat
or maps */
} XkbIndicatorRec,*XkbIndicatorPtr;

   This structure contains the phys_indicators field, which
   relates some information about the correspondence between
   indicators and physical LEDs on the keyboard, and an array of
   indicator maps , one map per indicator.

   The phys_indicators field indicates which indicators are bound
   to physical LEDs on the keyboard; if a bit is set in
   phys_indicators , then the associated indicator has a physical
   LED associated with it. This field is necessary because some
   indicators may not have corresponding physical LEDs on the
   keyboard. For example, most keyboards have an LED for
   indicating the state of CapsLock , but most keyboards do not
   have an LED that indicates the current group. Because
   phys_indicators describes a physical characteristic of the
   keyboard, you cannot directly change it under program control.
   However, if a client program loads a completely new keyboard
   description via XkbGetKeyboardByName , or if a new keyboard is
   attached and the X implementation notices, phys_indicators
   changes if the indicators for the new keyboard are different.

XkbIndicatorMapRec

   Each indicator has its own set of attributes that specify
   whether clients can explicitly set its state and whether it
   tracks the keyboard state. The attributes of each indicator are
   held in the maps array, which is an array of XkbIndicatorRec
   structures:
typedef struct {
      unsigned char    flags;         /* how the indicator can be change
d */
      unsigned char    which_groups;  /* match criteria for groups */
      unsigned char    groups;        /* which keyboard groups the indic
ator watches */
      unsigned char    which_mods;    /* match criteria for modifiers */
      XkbModsRec       mods;          /* which modifiers the indicator w
atches */
      unsigned int     ctrls;         /* which controls the indicator wa
tches */
} XkbIndicatorMapRec, *XkbIndicatorMapPtr;

   This indicator map specifies for each indicator:
     * The conditions under which the keyboard modifier state
       affects the indicator
     * The conditions under which the keyboard group state affects
       the indicator
     * The conditions under which the state of the boolean
       controls affects the indicator
     * The effect (if any) of attempts to explicitly change the
       state of the indicator using the functions XkbSetControls
       or XChangeKeyboardControl

   For more information on the effects of explicit changes to
   indicators and the relationship to the indicator map, see
   section 8.4.1.

XkbIndicatorMapRec flags field

   The flags field specifies the conditions under which the
   indicator can be changed and the effects of changing the
   indicator. The valid values for flags and their effects are
   shown in Table 8.1.

   Table 8.1. XkbIndicatorMapRec flags Field
   Value   Effect
   XkbIM_NoExplicit (1L<<7) Client applications cannot change the
   state of the indicator.
   XkbIM_NoAutomatic (1L<<6) Xkb does not automatically change the
   value of the indicator based upon a change in the keyboard
   state, regardless of the values for the other fields of the
   indicator map.
   XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB (1L<<5) A client application changing the
   state of the indicator causes the state of the keyboard to
   change.

   Note that if XkbIM_NoAutomatic is not set, by default the
   indicator follows the keyboard state.

   If XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB is set and XkbIM_NoExplicit is not, and if
   you call a function which updates the server's image of the
   indicator map (such as XkbSetIndicatorMap or
   XkbSetNamedIndicator ), Xkb changes the keyboard state and
   controls to reflect the other fields of the indicator map, as
   described in the remainder of this section. If you attempt to
   explicitly change the value of an indicator for which
   XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB is absent or for which XkbIM_NoExplicit is
   present, keyboard state or controls are unaffected.

   For example, a keyboard designer may want to make the CapsLock
   LED controllable only by the server, but allow the Scroll Lock
   LED to be controlled by client applications. To do so, the
   keyboard designer could set the XkbIM_NoExplicit flag for the
   CapsLock LED, but not set it for the Scroll Lock LED. Or the
   keyboard designer may wish to allow the CapsLock LED to be
   controlled by both the server and client applications and also
   have the server to automatically change the CapsLock modifier
   state whenever a client application changes the CapsLock LED.
   To do so, the keyboard designer would not set the
   XkbIM_NoExplicit flag, but would instead set the
   XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB flag.

   The remaining fields in the indicator map specify the
   conditions under which Xkb automatically turns an indicator on
   or off (only if XkbIM_NoAutomatic is not set). If these
   conditions match the keyboard state, Xkb turns the indicator
   on. If the conditions do not match, Xkb turns the indicator
   off.

XkbIndicatorMapRec which_groups and groups fields

   The which_groups and the groups fields of an indicator map
   determine how the keyboard group state affects the
   corresponding indicator. The which_groups field controls the
   interpretation of groups and may contain any one of the
   following values:
#define XkbIM_UseNone             0
#define XkbIM_UseBase             (1L << 0)
#define XkbIM_UseLatched          (1L << 1)
#define XkbIM_UseLocked           (1L << 2)
#define XkbIM_UseEffective        (1L << 3)
#define XkbIM_UseAnyGroup         XkbIM_UseLatched | XkbIM_UseLocked |
                                  XkbIM_UseEffective

   The groups field specifies what keyboard groups an indicator
   watches and is the bitwise inclusive OR of the following valid
   values:
#define XkbGroup1Mask            (1<<0)
#define XkbGroup2Mask            (1<<1)
#define XkbGroup3Mask            (1<<2)
#define XkbGroup4Mask            (1<<3)
#define XkbAnyGroupMask          (1<<7)
#define XkbAllGroupsMask         (0xf)

   If XkbIM_NoAutomatic is not set (the keyboard drives the
   indicator), the effect of which_groups and groups is shown in
   Table 8.2.

   Table 8.2. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_groups and groups, Keyboard
   Drives Indicator
   which_groups Effect
   XkbIM_UseNone The groups field and the current keyboard group
   state are ignored.
   XkbIM_UseBase If groups is nonzero, the indicator is lit
   whenever the base keyboard group is nonzero. If groups is zero,
   the indicator is lit whenever the base keyboard group is zero.
   XkbIM_UseLatched If groups is nonzero, the indicator is lit
   whenever the latched keyboard group is nonzero. If groups is
   zero, the indicator is lit whenever the latched keyboard group
   is zero.
   XkbIM_UseLocked The groups field is interpreted as a mask. The
   indicator is lit when the current locked keyboard group matches
   one of the bits that are set in groups.
   XkbIM_UseEffective The groups field is interpreted as a mask.
   The indicator is lit when the current effective keyboard group
   matches one of the bits that are set in groups .

   The effect of which_groups and groups when you change an
   indicator for which XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB is set (the indicator
   drives the keyboard) is shown in Table 8.3. The "New State"
   column refers to the new state to which you set the indicator.

   Table 8.3. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_groups and groups,
   Indicator Drives Keyboard
   which_groups New State Effect on Keyboard Group State
   XkbIM_UseNone On or Off No effect
   XkbIM_UseBase On or Off No effect
   XkbIM_UseLatched On The groups field is treated as a group
   mask. The keyboard group latch is changed to the lowest
   numbered group specified in groups ; if groups is empty, the
   keyboard group latch is changed to zero.
   XkbIM_UseLatched Off The groups field is treated as a group
   mask. If the indicator is explicitly extinguished, keyboard
   group latch is changed to the lowest numbered group not
   specified in groups ; if groups is zero, the keyboard group
   latch is set to the index of the highest legal keyboard group.
   XkbIM_UseLocked or XkbIM_UseEffective On If the groups mask is
   empty, group is not changed; otherwise, the locked keyboard
   group is changed to the lowest numbered group specified in
   groups.
   XkbIM_UseLocked or XkbIM_UseEffective Off Locked keyboard group
   is changed to the lowest numbered group that is not specified
   in the groups mask, or to Group1 if the groups mask contains
   all keyboard groups.

XkbIndicatorMapRec which_mods and mods fields

   The mods field specifies what modifiers an indicator watches.
   The mods field is an Xkb modifier definition, XkbModsRec , as
   described in section 7.2, which can specify both real and
   virtual modifiers. The mods field takes effect even if some or
   all of the virtual indicators specified in mods are unbound. To
   specify the mods field, in general, assign the modifiers of
   interest to mods.real_mods and the virtual modifiers of
   interest to mods.vmods . You can disregard the mods.mask field
   unless your application needs to interpret the indicator map
   directly (that is, to simulate automatic indicator behavior on
   its own). Relatively few applications need to do so, but if you
   find it necessary, you can either read the indicator map back
   from the server after you update it (the server automatically
   updates the mask field whenever any of the real or virtual
   modifiers are changed in the modifier definition) or you can
   use XkbVirtualModsToReal to determine the proper contents for
   the mask field, assuming that the XkbDescRec contains the
   virtual modifier definitions.

   which_mods specifies what criteria Xkb uses to determine a
   match with the corresponding mods field by specifying one or
   more components of the Xkb keyboard state. If XkbIM_NoAutomatic
   is not set (the keyboard drives the indicator), the indicator
   is lit whenever any of the modifiers specified in the mask
   field of the mods modifier definition are also set in any of
   the current keyboard state components specified by which_mods .
   Remember that the mask field is comprised of all of the real
   modifiers specified in the definition plus any real modifiers
   that are bound to the virtual modifiers specified in the
   definition. (See Chapter 5 for more information on the keyboard
   state and Chapter 7 for more information on virtual modifiers.)
   Use a bitwise inclusive OR of the following values to compose a
   value for which_mods:
#define XkbIM_UseNone             0
#define XkbIM_UseBase             (1L << 0)
#define XkbIM_UseLatched          (1L << 1)
#define XkbIM_UseLocked           (1L << 2)
#define XkbIM_UseEffective        (1L << 3)
#define XkbIM_UseCompat           (1L << 4)
#define XkbIM_UseAnyMods          XkbIM_UseBase | XkbIM_UseLatched |
                                  XkbIM_UseLocked | XkbIM_UseEffective |
                                  XkbIM_UseCompat

   If XkbIM_NoAutomatic is not set (the keyboard drives the
   indicator), the effect of which_mods and mods is shown in Table
   8.4

   Table 8.4. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_mods and mods, Keyboard
   Drives Indicator
   which_mods Effect on Keyboard Modifiers
   XkbIM_UseNone The mods field and the current keyboard modifier
   state are ignored.
   XkbIM_UseBase The indicator is lit when any of the modifiers
   specified in the mask field of mods are on in the keyboard base
   state. If both mods.real_mods and mods.vmods are zero, the
   indicator is lit when the base keyboard state contains no
   modifiers.
   XkbIM_UseLatched The indicator is lit when any of the modifiers
   specified in the mask field of mods are latched. If both
   mods.real_mods and mods.vmods are zero, the indicator is lit
   when none of the modifier keys are latched.
   XkbIM_UseLocked The indicator is lit when any of the modifiers
   specified in the mask field of mods are locked. If both
   mods.real_mods and mods.vmods are zero, the indicator is lit
   when none of the modifier keys are locked.
   XkbIM_UseEffective The indicator is lit when any of the
   modifiers specified in the mask field of mods are in the
   effective keyboard state. If both mods.real_mods and mods.vmods
   are zero, the indicator is lit when the effective keyboard
   state contains no modifiers.
   XkbIM_UseCompat The indicator is lit when any of the modifiers
   specified in the mask field of mods are in the keyboard
   compatibility state. If both mods.real_mods and mods.vmods are
   zero, the indicator is lit when the keyboard compatibility
   state contains no modifiers.

   The effect on the keyboard modifiers of which_mods and mods
   when you change an indicator for which XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB is set
   (the indicator drives the keyboard) is shown in Table 8.5. The
   "New State" column refers to the new state to which you set the
   indicator.

   Table 8.5. XkbIndicatorMapRec which_mods and mods, Indicator
   Drives Keyboard
   which_mods New State Effect on Keyboard Modifiers
   XkbIM_UseNone or XkbIM_UseBase On or Off No Effect
   XkbIM_UseLatched On Any modifiers specified in the mask field
   of mods are added to the latched modifiers.
   XkbIM_UseLatched Off Any modifiers specified in the mask field
   of mods are removed from the latched modifiers.
   XkbIM_UseLocked, XkbIM_UseCompat, or XkbIM_UseEffective On Any
   modifiers specified in the mask field of mods are added to the
   locked modifiers.
   XkbIM_UseLocked Off Any modifiers specified in the mask field
   of mods are removed from the locked modifiers.
   XkbIM_UseCompat or XkbIM_UseEffective Off Any modifiers
   specified in the mask field of mods are removed from both the
   locked and latched modifiers.

XkbIndicatorMapRec ctrls field

   The ctrls field specifies what controls (see Chapter 10) the
   indicator watches and is composed using the bitwise inclusive
   OR of the following values:
#define XkbRepeatKeysMask           (1L << 0)
#define XkbSlowKeysMask             (1L << 1)
#define XkbBounceKeysMask           (1L << 2)
#define XkbStickyKeysMask           (1L << 3)
#define XkbMouseKeysMask            (1L << 4)
#define XkbMouseKeysAccelMask       (1L << 5)
#define XkbAccessXKeysMask          (1L << 6)
#define XkbAccessXTimeoutMask       (1L << 7)
#define XkbAccessXFeedbackMask      (1L << 8)
#define XkbAudibleBellMask          (1L << 9)
#define XkbOverlay1Mask             (1L << 10)
#define XkbOverlay2Mask             (1L << 11)
#define XkbAllBooleanCtrlsMask      (0x00001FFF)

   Xkb lights the indicator whenever any of the boolean controls
   specified in ctrls is enabled.

Getting Information About Indicators

   Xkb allows applications to obtain information about indicators
   using two different methods. The first method, which is similar
   to the core X implementation, uses a mask to specify the
   indicators. The second method, which is more suitable for
   applications concerned with interoperability, uses indicator
   names. The correspondence between the indicator name and the
   bit position in masks is as follows: one of the parameters
   returned from XkbGetNamedIndicators is an index that is the bit
   position to use in any function call that requires a mask of
   indicator bits, as well as the indicator's index into the
   XkbIndicatorRec array of indicator maps.

Getting Indicator State

   Because the state of the indicators is relatively volatile, the
   keyboard description does not hold the current state of the
   indicators. To obtain the current state of the keyboard
   indicators, use XkbGetIndicatorState.
   Status XkbGetIndicatorState ( display , device_spec ,
   state_return )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int * state_return ; /* backfilled with a mask of the
   indicator state */

   XkbGetIndicatorState queries the display for the state of the
   indicators on the device specified by the device_spec . For
   each indicator that is "turned on" on the device, the
   associated bit is set in state_return . If a compatible version
   of the Xkb extension is not available in the server,
   XkbGetIndicatorState returns a BadMatch error. Otherwise, it
   sends the request to the X server, places the state of the
   indicators into state_return, and returns Success . Thus the
   value reported by XkbGetIndicatorState is identical to the
   value reported by the core protocol.

Getting Indicator Information by Index

   To get the map for one or more indicators, using a mask to
   specify the indicators, use XkbGetIndicatorMap.
   Status XkbGetIndicatorMap ( dpy , which , desc )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of indicators for which maps
   should be returned */
   XkbDescPtr desc ; /* keyboard description to be updated */

   XkbGetIndicatorMap obtains the maps from the server for only
   those indicators specified by the which mask and copies the
   values into the keyboard description specified by desc . If the
   indicators field of the desc parameter is NULL ,
   XkbGetIndicatorMap allocates and initializes it.

   XkbGetIndicatorMap can generate BadAlloc , BadLength , BadMatch
   , and BadImplementation errors.

   To free the indicator maps, use XkbFreeIndicatorMaps (see
   section 8.6).

Getting Indicator Information by Name

   Xkb also allows applications to refer to indicators by name.
   Use XkbGetNames to get the indicator names (see Chapter 18).
   Using names eliminates the need for hard-coding bitmask values
   for particular keyboards. For example, instead of using
   vendor-specific constants such as WSKBLed_ScrollLock mask on
   Digital workstations or XLED_SCROLL_LOCK on Sun workstations,
   you can instead use XkbGetNamedIndicator to look up information
   on the indicator named "Scroll Lock."

   Use XkbGetNamedIndicator to look up the indicator map and other
   information for an indicator by name.
   Bool XkbGetNamedIndicator ( dpy , dev_spec , name , ndx_rtrn ,
   state_rtrn , map_rtrn , real_rtrn )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* keyboard device ID, or
   XkbUseCoreKbd */
   Atom name ; /* name of the indicator to be retrieved */
   int * ndx_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the index of the retrieved
   indicator */
   Bool * state_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the current state of the
   retrieved indicator */
   XkbIndicatorMapPtr map_rtrn ; /* backfilled with the mapping
   for the retrieved indicator */
   Bool * real_rtrn ; /* backfilled with True if the named
   indicator is real (physical) */

   If the device specified by device_spec has an indicator named
   name , XkbGetNamedIndicator returns True and populates the rest
   of the parameters with information about the indicator.
   Otherwise, XkbGetNamedIndicator returns False .

   The ndx_rtrn field returns the zero-based index of the named
   indicator. This index is the bit position to use in any
   function call that requires a mask of indicator bits, as well
   as the indicator's index into the XkbIndicatorRec array of
   indicator maps. state_rtrn returns the current state of the
   named indicator ( True = on, False = off). map_rtrn returns the
   indicator map for the named indicator. In addition, if the
   indicator is mapped to a physical LED, the real_rtrn parameter
   is set to True .

   Each of the " _rtrn " arguments is optional; you can pass NULL
   for any unneeded " _rtrn " arguments.

   XkbGetNamedIndicator can generate BadAtom and BadImplementation
   errors.

Changing Indicator Maps and State

   Just as you can get the indicator map using a mask or using an
   indicator name, so you can change it using a mask or a name.

Note

   You cannot change the phys_indicators field of the indicators
   structure. The only way to change the phys_indicators field is
   to change the keyboard map.

   There are two ways to make changes to indicator maps and state:
   either change a local copy of the indicator maps and use
   XkbSetIndicatorMap or XkbSetNamedIndicator , or, to reduce
   network traffic, use an XkbIndicatorChangesRec structure and
   use XkbChangeIndicators.

Effects of Explicit Changes on Indicators

   This section discusses the effects of explicitly changing
   indicators depending upon different settings in the indicator
   map. See Tables 8.3 and Table 8.5 for information on the
   effects of the indicator map fields when explicit changes are
   made.

   If XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB is set and XkbIM_NoExplicit is not, and if
   you call a function that updates the server's image of the
   indicator map (such as XkbSetIndicatorMap or
   XkbSetNamedIndicator ), Xkb changes the keyboard state and
   controls to reflect the other fields of the indicator map. If
   you attempt to explicitly change the value of an indicator for
   which XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB is absent or for which XkbIM_NoExplicit
   is present, keyboard state or controls are unaffected.

   If neither XkbIM_NoAutomatic nor XkbIM_NoExplicit is set in an
   indicator map, Xkb honors any request to change the state of
   the indicator, but the new state might be immediately
   superseded by automatic changes to the indicator state if the
   keyboard state or controls change.

   The effects of changing an indicator that drives the keyboard
   are cumulative; it is possible for a single change to affect
   keyboard group, modifiers, and controls simultaneously.

   If you change an indicator for which both the XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB
   and XkbIM_NoAutomatic flags are specified, Xkb applies the
   keyboard changes specified in the other indicator map fields
   and changes the indicator to reflect the state that was
   explicitly requested. The indicator remains in the new state
   until it is explicitly changed again.

   If the XkbIM_NoAutomatic flag is not set and XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB
   is set, Xkb applies the changes specified in the other
   indicator map fields and sets the state of the indicator to the
   values specified by the indicator map. Note that it is possible
   in this case for the indicator to end up in a different state
   than the one that was explicitly requested. For example, Xkb
   does not extinguish an indicator with which_mods of
   XkbIM_UseBase and mods of Shift if, at the time Xkb processes
   the request to extinguish the indicator, one of the Shift keys
   is physically depressed.

   If you explicitly light an indicator for which
   XkbIM_LEDDrivesKB is set, Xkb enables all of the boolean
   controls specified in the ctrls field of its indicator map.
   Explicitly extinguishing such an indicator causes Xkb to
   disable all of the boolean controls specified in ctrls .

Changing Indicator Maps by Index

   To update the maps for one or more indicators, first modify a
   local copy of the keyboard description, then use
   XkbSetIndicatorMap to download the changes to the server:
   Bool XkbSetIndicatorMap ( dpy , which , desc )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of indicators to change */
   XkbDescPtr desc ; /* keyboard description from which the maps
   are taken */

   For each bit set in the which parameter, XkbSetIndicatorMap
   sends the corresponding indicator map from the desc parameter
   to the server.

Changing Indicator Maps by Name

   XkbSetNamedIndicator can do several related things:
     * Name an indicator if it is not already named
     * Toggle the state of the indicator
     * Set the indicator to a specified state
     * Set the indicator map for the indicator

   Bool XkbSetNamedIndicator ( dpy , device_spec , name ,
   change_state, state , create_new , map )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   Atom name ; /* name of the indicator to change */
   Bool change_state ; /* whether to change the indicator state or
   not */
   Bool state ; /* desired new state for the indicator */
   Bool create_new ; /* whether a new indicator with the specified
   name should be created when necessary */
   XkbIndicatorMapPtr map ; /* new map for the indicator */

   If a compatible version of the Xkb extension is not available
   in the server, XkbSetNamedIndicator returns False . Otherwise,
   it sends a request to the X server to change the indicator
   specified by name and returns True.

   If change_state is True , and the optional parameter, state ,
   is not NULL , XkbSetNamedIndicator tells the server to change
   the state of the named indicator to the value specified by
   state.

   If an indicator with the name specified by name does not
   already exist, the create_new parameter tells the server
   whether it should create a new named indicator. If create_new
   is True , the server finds the first indicator that doesn't
   have a name and gives it the name specified by name.

   If the optional parameter, map , is not NULL ,
   XkbSetNamedIndicator tells the server to change the indicator's
   map to the values specified in map.

   XkbSetNamedIndicator can generate BadAtom and BadImplementation
   errors. In addition, it can also generate
   XkbIndicatorStateNotify (see section 8.5),
   XkbIndicatorMapNotify , and XkbNamesNotify events (see section
   18.5).

The XkbIndicatorChangesRec Structure

   The XkbIndicatorChangesRec identifies small modifications to
   the indicator map. Use it with the function XkbChangeIndicators
   to reduce the amount of traffic sent to the server.
typedef struct _XkbIndicatorChanges {
      unsigned int             state_changes;
      unsigned int             map_changes;
}
XkbIndicatorChangesRec,*XkbIndicatorChangesPtr;

   The state_changes field is a mask that specifies the indicators
   that have changed state, and map_changes is a mask that
   specifies the indicators whose maps have changed.

   To change indicator maps or state without passing the entire
   keyboard description, use XkbChangeIndicators .
   Bool XkbChangeIndicators ( dpy, xkb, changes, state )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description from which names are
   to be
   taken. */
   XkbIndicatorChangesPtr changes ; /* indicators to be updated on
   the server */
   unsigned int state ; /* new state of indicators listed in
   changes -> state_changes */

   XkbChangeIndicators copies any maps specified by changes from
   the keyboard description, xkb , to the server specified by dpy
   . If any bits are set in the state_changes field of changes ,
   XkbChangeIndicators also sets the state of those indicators to
   the values specified in the state mask. A 1 bit in state turns
   the corresponding indicator on, a 0 bit turns it off.

   XkbChangeIndicator s can generate BadAtom and BadImplementation
   errors. In addition, it can also generate
   XkbIndicatorStateNotify and XkbIndicatorMapNotify events (see
   section 8.5).

Tracking Changes to Indicator State or Map

   Whenever an indicator changes state, the server sends
   XkbIndicatorStateNotify events to all interested clients.
   Similarly, whenever an indicator's map changes, the server
   sends XkbIndicatorMapNotify events to all interested clients.

   To receive XkbIndicatorStateNotify events, use XkbSelectEvents
   (see section 4.3) with both the bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits parameters containing
   XkbIndicatorStateNotifyMask . To receive XkbIndicatorMapNotify
   events, use XkbSelectEvents with XkbIndicatorMapNotifyMask .

   To receive events for only specific indicators, use
   XkbSelectEventDetails . Set the event_type parameter to
   XkbIndicatorStateNotify or XkbIndicatorMapNotify , and set both
   the bits_to_change and values_for_bits detail parameters to a
   mask where each bit specifies one indicator, turning on those
   bits that specify the indicators for which you want to receive
   events.

   Both types of indicator events use the same structure:
typedef struct _XkbIndicatorNotify {
      int            type;        /* Xkb extension base event code */
      unsigned long  serial;      /* X server serial number for event */
      Bool           send_event;  /*  True => synthetically generated */
      Display *      display;     /* server connection where event gener
ated */
      Time           time;        /* server time when event generated */
      int            xkb_type;    /* specifies state or map notify */
      int            device;      /* Xkb device ID, will not be  XkbUseC
oreKbd */
      unsigned int   changed;     /* mask of indicators with new state o
r map */
      unsigned int   state;       /* current state of all indicators */
} XkbIndicatorNotifyEvent;

   xkb_type is either XkbIndicatorStateNotify or
   XkbIndicatorMapNotify , depending on whether the event is a
   kbIndicatorStateNotify event or kbIndicatorMapNotify event.

   The changed parameter is a mask that is the bitwise inclusive
   OR of the indicators that have changed. If the event is of type
   XkbIndicatorMapNotify , changed reports the maps that changed.
   If the event is of type XkbIndicatorStateNotify , changed
   reports the indicators that have changed state. state is a mask
   that specifies the current state of all indicators, whether
   they have changed or not, for both XkbIndicatorStateNotify and
   IndicatorMapNotify events.

   When your client application receives either a
   XkbIndicatorStateNotify event or XkbIndicatorMapNotify event,
   you can note the changes in a changes structure by calling
   XkbNoteIndicatorChanges.
   void XkbNoteIndicatorChanges ( old , new , wanted )
   XkbIndicatorChangesPtr old ; /* XkbIndicatorChanges structure
   to be updated */
   XkbIndicatorNotifyEvent * new ; /* event from which changes are
   to be copied */
   unsigned int wanted ; /* which changes are to be noted */

   The wanted parameter is the bitwise inclusive OR of
   XkbIndicatorMapMask and XkbIndicatorStateMask .
   XkbNoteIndicatorChanges copies any changes reported in new and
   specified in wanted into the changes record specified by old.

   To update a local copy of the keyboard description with the
   actual values, pass the results of one or more calls to
   XkbNoteIndicatorChanges to XkbGetIndicatorChanges:
   Status XkbGetIndicatorChanges ( dpy , xkb , changes , state )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to hold the new values
   */
   XkbIndicatorChangesPtr changes ; /* indicator maps/state to be
   obtained from the server */
   unsigned int * state ; /* backfilled with the state of the
   indicators */

   XkbGetIndicatorChanges examines the changes parameter, pulls
   over the necessary information from the server, and copies the
   results into the xkb keyboard description. If any bits are set
   in the state_changes field of changes , XkbGetIndicatorChanges
   also places the state of those indicators in state . If the
   indicators field of xkb is NULL , XkbGetIndicatorChanges
   allocates and initializes it. To free the indicators field, use
   XkbFreeIndicators (see section 8.6).

   XkbGetIndicatorChanges can generate BadAlloc ,
   BadImplementation, and BadMatch errors.

Allocating and Freeing Indicator Maps

   Most applications do not need to directly allocate the
   indicators member of the keyboard description record (the
   keyboard description record is described in Chapter 6). If the
   need arises, however, use XkbAllocIndicatorMaps.
   Status XkbAllocIndicatorMaps ( xkb )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description structure */

   The xkb parameter must point to a valid keyboard description.
   If it doesn't, XkbAllocIndicatorMaps returns a BadMatch error.
   Otherwise, XkbAllocIndicatorMaps allocates and initializes the
   indicators member of the keyboard description record and
   returns Success . If XkbAllocIndicatorMaps was unable to
   allocate the indicators record, it reports a Bad Alloc error.

   To free memory used by the indicators member of an XkbDescRec
   structure, use XkbFreeIndicatorMaps.
   void XkbFreeIndicatorMaps ( xkb )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description structure */

   If the indicators member of the keyboard description record
   pointed to by xkb is not NULL , XkbFreeIndicatorMaps frees the
   memory associated with the indicators member of xkb.

Chapter 9. Bells

   Table of Contents

   Bell Names
   Audible Bells
   Bell Functions

        Generating Named Bells
        Generating Named Bell Events
        Forcing a Server-Generated Bell

   Detecting Bells

   The core X protocol allows only applications to explicitly
   sound the system bell with a given duration, pitch, and volume.
   Xkb extends this capability by allowing clients to attach
   symbolic names to bells, disable audible bells, and receive an
   event whenever the keyboard bell is rung. For the purposes of
   this document, the audible bell is defined to be the system
   bell, or the default keyboard bell, as opposed to any other
   audible sound generated elsewhere in the system.

   You can ask to receive XkbBellNotify events (see section 9.4)
   when any client rings any one of the following:
     * The default bell
     * Any bell on an input device that can be specified by a
       bell_class and bell_id pair
     * Any bell specified only by an arbitrary name. (This is,
       from the server's point of view, merely a name, and not
       connected with any physical sound-generating device. Some
       client application must generate the sound, or visual
       feedback, if any, that is associated with the name.)

   You can also ask to receive XkbBellNotify events when the
   server rings the default bell or if any client has requested
   events only (without the bell sounding) for any of the bell
   types previously listed.

   You can disable audible bells on a global basis (to set the
   AudibleBell control, see Chapter 10). For example, a client
   that replaces the keyboard bell with some other audible cue
   might want to turn off the AudibleBell control to prevent the
   server from also generating a sound and avoid cacophony. If you
   disable audible bells and request to receive XkbBellNotify
   events, you can generate feedback different from the default
   bell.

   You can, however, override the AudibleBell control by calling
   one of the functions that force the ringing of a bell in spite
   of the setting of the AudibleBell control -- XkbForceDeviceBell
   or XkbForceBell (see section 9.3.3). In this case the server
   does not generate a bell event.

   Just as some keyboards can produce keyclicks to indicate when a
   key is pressed or repeating, Xkb can provide feedback for the
   controls by using special beep codes. The AccessXFeedback
   control is used to configure the specific types of operations
   that generate feedback. See section 10.6.3 for a discussion on
   AccessXFeedback control.

   This chapter describes bell names, the functions used to
   generate named bells, and the events the server generates for
   bells.

Bell Names

   You can associate a name to an act of ringing a bell by
   converting the name to an Atom and then using this name when
   you call the functions listed in this chapter. If an event is
   generated as a result, the name is then passed to all other
   clients interested in receiving XkbBellNotify events. Note that
   these are arbitrary names and that there is no binding to any
   sounds. Any sounds or other effects (such as visual bells on
   the screen) must be generated by a client application upon
   receipt of the bell event containing the name. There is no
   default name for the default keyboard bell. The server does
   generate some predefined bells for the AccessX controls (see
   section 10.6.3). These named bells are shown in Table 9.1; the
   name is included in any bell event sent to clients that have
   requested to receive XkbBellNotify events.

   Table 9.1. Predefined Bells
 Action                                               Named Bell
 Indicator turned on                                  AX_IndicatorOn
 Indicator turned off                                 AX_IndicatorOff
 More than one indicator changed state                AX_IndicatorChange
 Control turned on                                    AX_FeatureOn
 Control turned off                                   AX_FeatureOff
 More than one control changed state                  AX_FeatureChange
 SlowKeys and BounceKeys about to be turned on or off
   AX_SlowKeysWarning
 SlowKeys key pressed                                 AX_SlowKeyPress
 SlowKeys key accepted                                AX_SlowKeyAccept
 SlowKeys key rejected                                AX_SlowKeyReject
 Accepted SlowKeys key released                       AX_SlowKeyRelease
 BounceKeys key rejected                              AX_BounceKeyReject
 StickyKeys key latched                               AX_StickyLatch
 StickyKeys key locked                                AX_StickyLock
 StickyKeys key unlocked                              AX_StickyUnlock

Audible Bells

   Using Xkb you can generate bell events that do not necessarily
   ring the system bell. This is useful if you need to use an
   audio server instead of the system beep. For example, when an
   audio client starts, it could disable the audible bell (the
   system bell) and then listen for XkbBellNotify events (see
   section 9.4). When it receives a XkbBellNotify event, the audio
   client could then send a request to an audio server to play a
   sound.

   You can control the audible bells feature by passing the
   XkbAudibleBellMask to XkbChangeEnabledControls (see section
   10.1.1). If you set XkbAudibleBellMask on, the server rings the
   system bell when a bell event occurs. This is the default. If
   you set XkbAudibleBellMask off and a bell event occurs, the
   server does not ring the system bell unless you call
   XkbForceDeviceBell or XkbForceBell (see section 9.3.3).

   Audible bells are also part of the per-client auto-reset
   controls. For more information on auto-reset controls, see
   section 10.1.2.

Bell Functions

   Use the functions described in this section to ring bells and
   to generate bell events.

   The input extension has two types of feedbacks that can
   generate bells -- bell feedback and keyboard feedback. Some of
   the functions in this section have bell_class and bell_id
   parameters; set them as follows: Set bell_class to
   BellFeedbackClass or KbdFeedbackClass . A device can have more
   than one feedback of each type; set bell_id to the particular
   bell feedback of bell_class type.

   Table 9.2 shows the conditions that cause a bell to sound or an
   XkbBellNotifyEvent to be generated when a bell function is
   called.

   Table 9.2. Bell Sounding and Bell Event Generating
   Function called AudibleBell Server sounds a bell Server sends
   an XkbBellNotifyEvent
   XkbDeviceBell On Yes Yes
   XkbDeviceBell Off No Yes
   XkbBell On Yes Yes
   XkbBell Off No Yes
   XkbDeviceBellEvent On or Off No Yes
   XkbBellEvent On or Off No Yes
   XkbDeviceForceBell On or Off Yes No
   XkbForceBell On or Off Yes No

Generating Named Bells

   To ring the bell on an X input extension device or the default
   keyboard, use XkbDeviceBell.
   Bool XkbDeviceBell ( display, window, device_id, bell_class,
   bell_id, percent, name )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   Window window ; /* window for which the bell is generated, or
   None */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int bell_class ; /* X input extension bell class of
   the bell to be rung */
   unsigned int bell_id ; /* X input extension bell ID of the bell
   to be rung */
   int percent ; /* bell volume, from -100 to 100 inclusive */
   Atom name ; /* a name for the bell, or NULL */

   Set percent to be the volume relative to the base volume for
   the keyboard as described for XBell.

   Note that bell_class and bell_id indicate the bell to
   physically ring. name is simply an arbitrary moniker for the
   client application's use.

   To determine the current feedback settings of an extension
   input device, use XGetFeedbackControl . See the X input
   extension documentation for more information on
   XGetFeedbackControl and related data structures.

   If a compatible keyboard extension is not present in the X
   server, XkbDeviceBell immediately returns False . Otherwise,
   XkbDeviceBell rings the bell as specified for the display and
   keyboard device and returns True . If you have disabled the
   audible bell, the server does not ring the system bell,
   although it does generate a XkbBellNotify event.

   You can call XkbDeviceBell without first initializing the
   keyboard extension.

   As a convenience function, Xkb provides a function to ring the
   bell on the default keyboard: XkbBell.
   Bool XkbBell ( display, window, percent, name )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   Window window ; /* event window, or None*/
   int percent ; /* relative volume, which can range from -100 to
   100 inclusive */
   Atom name ; /* a bell name, or NULL */

   If a compatible keyboard extension isn't present in the X
   server, XkbBell calls XBell with the specified display and
   percent , and returns False . Otherwise, XkbBell calls
   XkbDeviceBell with the specified display, window, percent, and
   name , a device_spec of XkbUseCoreKbd , a bell_class of
   XkbDfltXIClass , and a bell_id of XkbDfltXIId, and returns
   True.

   If you have disabled the audible bell, the server does not ring
   the system bell, although it does generate a XkbBellNotify
   event.

   You can call XkbBell without first initializing the keyboard
   extension.

Generating Named Bell Events

   Using Xkb, you can also generate a named bell event that does
   not ring any bell. This allows you to do things such as
   generate events when your application starts.

   For example, if an audio client listens for these types of
   bells, it can produce a "whoosh" sound when it receives a named
   bell event to indicate a client just started. In this manner,
   applications can generate start-up feedback and not worry about
   producing annoying beeps if an audio server is not running.

   To cause a bell event for an X input extension device or for
   the keyboard, without ringing the corresponding bell, use
   XkbDeviceBellEvent.
   Bool XkbDeviceBellEvent ( display, window, device_spec,
   bell_class, bell_id, percent, name )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   Window window ; /* event window, or None*/
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int bell_class; /* input extension bell class for the
   event */
   unsigned int bell_id ; /* input extension bell ID for the event
   */
   int percent ; /* volume for the bell, which can range from -100
   to 100 inclusive */
   Atom name ; /* a bell name, or NULL */

   If a compatible keyboard extension isn't present in the X
   server, XkbDeviceBellEvent immediately returns False .
   Otherwise, XkbDeviceBellEvent causes an XkbBellNotify event to
   be sent to all interested clients and returns True . Set
   percent to be the volume relative to the base volume for the
   keyboard as described for XBell.

   In addition, XkbDeviceBellEvent may generate Atom protocol
   errors as well as XkbBellNotify events. You can call XkbBell
   without first initializing the keyboard extension.

   As a convenience function, Xkb provides a function to cause a
   bell event for the keyboard without ringing the bell:
   XkbBellEvent.
   Bool XkbBellEvent ( display, window, percent, name )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   Window window ; /* the event window, or None */
   int percent ; /* relative volume, which can range from -100 to
   100 inclusive */
   Atom name ; /* a bell name, or NULL */

   If a compatible keyboard extension isn't present in the X
   server, XkbBellEvent immediately returns False . Otherwise,
   XkbBellEvent calls XkbDeviceBellEvent with the specified
   display, window, percent, and name , a device_spec of
   XkbUseCoreKbd , a bell_class of XkbDfltXIClass , and a bell_id
   of XkbDfltXIId, and returns what XkbDeviceBellEvent returns.

   XkbBellEvent generates a XkbBellNotify event.

   You can call XkbBellEvent without first initializing the
   keyboard extension.

Forcing a Server-Generated Bell

   To ring the bell on any keyboard, overriding user preference
   settings for audible bells, use XkbForceDeviceBell.
   Bool XkbForceDeviceBell ( display, window, device_spec,
   bell_class, bell_id, percent )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   Window window ; /* event window, or None */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int bell_class ; /* input extension class of the bell
   to be rung */
   unsigned int bell_id ; /* input extension ID of the bell to be
   rung */
   int percent ; /* relative volume, which can range from -100 to
   100 inclusive */

   If a compatible keyboard extension isn't present in the X
   server, XkbForceDeviceBell immediately returns False .
   Otherwise, XkbForceDeviceBell rings the bell as specified for
   the display and keyboard device and returns True . Set percent
   to be the volume relative to the base volume for the keyboard
   as described for XBell . There is no name parameter because
   XkbForceDeviceBell does not cause an XkbBellNotify event.

   You can call XkbBell without first initializing the keyboard
   extension.

   To ring the bell on the default keyboard, overriding user
   preference settings for audible bells, use XkbForceBell.
   Bool XkbForceBell ( display, percent)
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   int percent ; /* volume for the bell, which can range from -100
   to 100 inclusive */

   If a compatible keyboard extension isn't present in the X
   server, XkbForceBell calls XBell with the specified display and
   percent and returns False . Otherwise, XkbForceBell calls
   XkbForceDeviceBell with the specified display and percent ,
   device_spec = XkbUseCoreKbd , bell_class = XkbDfltXIClass ,
   bell_id = XkbDfltXIId, window = None, and name = NULL , and
   returns what XkbForceDeviceBell returns.

   XkbForceBell does not cause an XkbBellNotify event.

   You can call XkbBell without first initializing the keyboard
   extension.

Detecting Bells

   Xkb generates XkbBellNotify events for all bells except for
   those resulting from calls to XkbForceDeviceBell and
   XkbForceBell . To receive XkbBellNotify events under all
   possible conditions, pass XkbBellNotifyMask in both the
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits parameters to
   XkbSelectEvents (see section 4.3).

   The XkbBellNotify event has no event details. It is either
   selected or it is not. However, you can call
   XkbSelectEventDetails using XkbBellNotify as the event_type and
   specifying XkbAllBellNotifyMask in bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits. This has the same effect as a call to
   XkbSelectEvents.

   The structure for the XkbBellNotify event type contains:
typedef struct _XkbBellNotify {
      int             type;        /* Xkb extension base event code */
      unsigned long   serial;      /* X server serial number for event *
/
      Bool            send_event;  /*  True => synthetically generated *
/
      Display *       display;     /* server connection where event gene
rated */
      Time            time;        /* server time when event generated *
/
      int             xkb_type;    /*  XkbBellNotify */
      unsigned int    device;      /* Xkb device ID, will not be  XkbUse
CoreKbd */
      int             percent;     /* requested volume as % of max */
      int             pitch;       /* requested pitch in Hz */
      int             duration;    /* requested duration in microseconds
 */
      unsigned int    bell_class;  /* X input extension feedback class *
/
      unsigned int    bell_id;     /* X input extension feedback ID */
      Atom            name;        /* "name" of requested bell */
      Window          window;      /* window associated with event */
      Bool            event_only;  /*  False -> the server did not produ
ce a beep */
} XkbBellNotifyEvent;

   If your application needs to generate visual bell feedback on
   the screen when it receives a bell event, use the window ID in
   the XkbBellNotifyEvent , if present.

Chapter 10. Keyboard Controls

   Table of Contents

   Controls that Enable and Disable Other Controls

        The EnabledControls Control
        The AutoReset Control

   Control for Bell Behavior

        The AudibleBell Control

   Controls for Repeat Key Behavior

        The PerKeyRepeat Control
        The RepeatKeys Control
        The DetectableAutorepeat Control

   Controls for Keyboard Overlays (Overlay1 and Overlay2 Controls)
   Controls for Using the Mouse from the Keyboard

        The MouseKeys Control
        The MouseKeysAccel Control

   Controls for Better Keyboard Access by Physically Impaired
          Persons

        The AccessXKeys Control
        The AccessXTimeout Control
        The AccessXFeedback Control
        AccessXNotify Events
        StickyKeys, RepeatKeys, and MouseKeys Events
        The SlowKeys Control
        The BounceKeys Control
        The StickyKeys Control

   Controls for General Keyboard Mapping

        The GroupsWrap Control
        The IgnoreLockMods Control
        The IgnoreGroupLock Control
        The InternalMods Control

   The XkbControlsRec Structure

   Querying Controls
   Changing Controls

        The XkbControlsChangesRec Structure

   Tracking Changes to Keyboard Controls
   Allocating and Freeing an XkbControlsRec
   The Miscellaneous Per-client Controls

   The Xkb extension is composed of two parts: a server extension,
   and a client-side X library extension. This chapter discusses
   functions used to modify controls effecting the behavior of the
   server portion of the Xkb extension. Chapter 11 discusses
   functions used to modify controls that affect only the behavior
   of the client portion of the extension; those controls are
   known as Library Controls.

   Xkb contains control features that affect the entire keyboard,
   known as global keyboard controls. Some of the controls may be
   selectively enabled and disabled; these controls are known as
   the Boolean Controls . Boolean Controls can be turned on or off
   under program control and can also be automatically set to an
   on or off condition when a client program exits. The remaining
   controls, known as the Non-Boolean Controls , are always
   active. The XkbControlsRec structure describes the current
   state of most of the global controls and the attributes
   effecting the behavior of each of these Xkb features. This
   chapter describes the Xkb controls and how to manipulate them.

   There are two possible components for each of the Boolean
   Controls: attributes describing how the control should work,
   and a state describing whether the behavior as a whole is
   enabled or disabled. The attributes and state for most of these
   controls are held in the XkbControlsRec structure (see section
   10.8).

   You can manipulate the Xkb controls individually, via
   convenience functions, or as a whole. To treat them as a group,
   modify an XkbControlsRec structure to describe all of the
   changes to be made, and then pass that structure and
   appropriate flags to an Xkb library function, or use a
   XkbControlsChangesRec (see section 10.10.1) to reduce network
   traffic. When using a convenience function to manipulate one
   control individually, you do not use an XkbControlsRec
   structure directly.

   The Xkb controls are grouped as shown in Table 10.1.

   Table 10.1. Xkb Keyboard Controls
   Type of Control Control Name Boolean Control?
   Controls for enabling and disabling other controls
   EnabledControls No
     AutoReset No
   Control for bell behavior AudibleBell Boolean
   Controls for repeat key behavior PerKeyRepeat No
     RepeatKeys Boolean
     DetectableAutorepeat Boolean
   Controls for keyboard overlays Overlay1 Boolean
     Overlay2 Boolean
   Controls for using the mouse from the keyboard MouseKeys
   Boolean
     MouseKeysAccel Boolean
   Controls for better keyboard access by AccessXFeedback Boolean
   physically impaired persons AccessXKeys Boolean
     AccessXTimeout Boolean
     BounceKeys Boolean
     SlowKeys Boolean
     StickyKeys Boolean
   Controls for general keyboard mapping GroupsWrap No
     IgnoreGroupLock Boolean
     IgnoreLockMods No
     InternalMods No
   Miscellaneous per-client controls GrabsUseXKBState Boolean
     LookupStateWhenGrabbed Boolean
     SendEventUsesXKBState Boolean

   The individual categories and controls are described first,
   together with functions for manipulating them. A description of
   the XkbControlsRec structure and the general functions for
   dealing with all of the controls at once follow at the end of
   the chapter.

Controls that Enable and Disable Other Controls

   Enable and disable the boolean controls under program control
   by using the EnabledControls control; enable and disable them
   upon program exit by configuring the AutoReset control.

The EnabledControls Control

   The EnabledControls control is a bit mask where each bit that
   is turned on means the corresponding control is enabled, and
   when turned off, disabled. It corresponds to the enabled_ctrls
   field of an XkbControlsRec structure (see section 10.8). The
   bits describing which controls are turned on or off are defined
   in Table 10.7.

   Use XkbChangeEnabledControls to manipulate the EnabledControls
   control.
   Bool XkbChangeEnabledControls ( dpy , device_spec , mask ,
   values )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* keyboard device to modify */
   unsigned int mask ; /* 1 bit -> controls to enable / disable */
   unsigned int values ; /* 1 bit => enable, 0 bit => disable */

   The mask parameter specifies the boolean controls to be enabled
   or disabled, and the values mask specifies the new state for
   those controls. Valid values for both of these masks are
   composed of a bitwise inclusive OR of bits taken from the set
   of mask bits in Table 10.7, using only those masks with "ok" in
   the enabled_ctrls column.

   If the X server does not support a compatible version of Xkb or
   the Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbChangeEnabledControls returns False ; otherwise, it sends
   the request to the X server and returns True .

   Note that the EnabledControls control only enables and disables
   controls; it does not configure them. Some controls, such as
   the AudibleBell control, have no configuration attributes and
   are therefore manipulated solely by enabling and disabling
   them. Others, however, have additional attributes to configure
   their behavior. For example, the RepeatControl control uses
   repeat_delay and repeat_interval fields to describe the timing
   behavior of keys that repeat. The RepeatControl behavior is
   turned on or off depending on the value of the
   XkbRepeatKeysMask bit, but you must use other means, as
   described in this chapter, to configure its behavior in detail.

The AutoReset Control

   You can configure the boolean controls to automatically be
   enabled or disabled when a program exits. This capability is
   controlled via two masks maintained in the X server on a
   per-client basis. There is no client-side Xkb data structure
   corresponding to these masks. Whenever the client exits for any
   reason, any boolean controls specified in the auto-reset mask
   are set to the corresponding value from the auto-reset values
   mask. This makes it possible for clients to "clean up after
   themselves" automatically, even if abnormally terminated. The
   bits used in the masks correspond to the EnabledControls
   control bits.

   For example, a client that replaces the keyboard bell with some
   other audible cue might want to turn off the AudibleBell
   control to prevent the server from also generating a sound and
   avoid cacophony. If the client were to exit without resetting
   the AudibleBell control, the user would be left without any
   feedback at all. Setting AudibleBell in both the auto-reset
   mask and auto-reset values guarantees that the audible bell
   will be turned back on when the client exits.

   To get the current values of the auto-reset controls, use
   XkbGetAutoResetControls .
   Bool XkbGetAutoResetControls ( dpy , auto_ctrls , auto_values )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int * auto_ctrls ; /* specifies which bits in
   auto_values are relevant */
   unsigned int * auto_values ; /* 1 bit => corresponding control
   has auto-reset on */

   XkbGetAutoResetControls backfills auto_ctrls and auto_values
   with the AutoReset control attributes for this particular
   client. It returns True if successful, and False otherwise.

   To change the current values of the AutoReset control
   attributes, use XkbSetAutoResetControls.
   Bool XkbSetAutoResetControls ( dpy , changes , auto_ctrls ,
   auto_values )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int changes ; /* controls for which to change
   auto-reset values */
   unsigned int * auto_ctrls ; /* controls from changes that
   should auto reset */
   unsigned int * auto_values ; /* 1 bit => auto-reset on */

   XkbSetAutoResetControls changes the auto-reset status and
   associated auto-reset values for the controls selected by
   changes . For any control selected by changes , if the
   corresponding bit is set in auto_ctrls , the control is
   configured to auto-reset when the client exits. If the
   corresponding bit in auto_values is on, the control is turned
   on when the client exits; if zero, the control is turned off
   when the client exits. For any control selected by changes , if
   the corresponding bit is not set in auto_ctrls , the control is
   configured to not reset when the client exits. For example:

   To leave the auto-reset controls for StickyKeys the way they
   are:
ok = XkbSetAutoResetControls(dpy, 0, 0, 0);

   To change the auto-reset controls so that StickyKeys are
   unaffected when the client exits:
ok = XkbSetAutoResetControls(dpy, XkbStickyKeysMask, 0, 0);

   To change the auto-reset controls so that StickyKeys are turned
   off when the client exits:
ok = XkbSetAutoResetControls(dpy, XkbStickyKeysMask, XkbStickyKeysMask,
0);

   To change the auto-reset controls so that StickyKeys are turned
   on when the client exits:
ok = XkbSetAutoResetControls(dpy, XkbStickyKeysMask, XkbStickyKeysMask,
XkbStickyKeysMask);

   XkbSetAutoResetControls backfills auto_ctrls and auto_values
   with the auto-reset controls for this particular client. Note
   that all of the bits are valid in the returned values, not just
   the ones selected in the changes mask.

Control for Bell Behavior

   The X server's generation of sounds is controlled by the
   AudibleBell control. Configuration of different bell sounds is
   discussed in Chapter 9.

The AudibleBell Control

   The AudibleBell control is a boolean control that has no
   attributes. As such, you may enable and disable it using either
   the EnabledControls control or the AutoReset control discussed
   in section 10.1.1. When enabled, protocol requests to generate
   a sound result in the X server actually producing a real sound;
   when disabled, requests to the server to generate a sound are
   ignored unless the sound is forced. See section 9.2.

Controls for Repeat Key Behavior

   The repeating behavior of keyboard keys is governed by three
   controls, the PerKeyRepeat control, which is always active, and
   the RepeatKeys and DetectableAutorepeat controls, which are
   boolean controls that may be enabled and disabled. PerKeyRepeat
   determines which keys are allowed to repeat. RepeatKeys governs
   the behavior of an individual key when it is repeating.
   DetectableAutorepeat allows a client to detect when a key is
   repeating as a result of being held down.

The PerKeyRepeat Control

   The PerKeyRepeat control is a bitmask long enough to contain a
   bit for each key on the device; it determines which individual
   keys are allowed to repeat. The Xkb PerKeyRepeat control
   provides no functionality different from that available via the
   core X protocol. There are no convenience functions in Xkb for
   manipulating this control. The PerKeyRepeat control settings
   are carried in the per_key_repeat field of an XkbControlsRec
   structure, discussed in section 10.8.

The RepeatKeys Control

   The core protocol allows only control over whether or not the
   entire keyboard or individual keys should auto-repeat when held
   down. RepeatKeys is a boolean control that extends this
   capability by adding control over the delay until a key begins
   to repeat and the rate at which it repeats. RepeatKeys is
   coupled with the core auto-repeat control: when RepeatKeys is
   enabled or disabled, the core auto-repeat is enabled or
   disabled and vice versa.

   Auto-repeating keys are controlled by two attributes. The
   first, timeout , is the delay after the initial press of an
   auto-repeating key and the first generated repeat event. The
   second, interval , is the delay between all subsequent
   generated repeat events. As with all boolean controls,
   configuring the attributes that determine how the control
   operates does not automatically enable the control as a whole;
   see section 10.1.

   To get the current attributes of the RepeatKeys control for a
   keyboard device, use XkbGetAutoRepeatRate .
   Bool XkbGetAutoRepeatRate ( display, device_spec, timeout_rtrn,
   interval_rtrn )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* desired device ID, or
   XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int * timeout_rtrn ; /* backfilled with initial repeat
   delay, ms */
   unsigned int * interval_rtrn ; /* backfilled with subsequent
   repeat delay, ms */

   XkbGetAutoRepeatRate queries the server for the current values
   of the RepeatControls control attributes, backfills
   timeout_rtrn and interval_rtrn with them, and returns True . If
   a compatible version of the Xkb extension is not available in
   the server XkbGetAutoRepeatRate returns False .

   To set the attributes of the RepeatKeys control for a keyboard
   device, use XkbSetAutoRepeatRate .
   Bool XkbSetAutoRepeatRate ( display, device_spec, timeout,
   interval )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device to configure, or
   XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int timeout ; /* initial delay, ms */
   unsigned int interval ; /* delay between repeats, ms */

   XkbSetAutoRepeatRate sends a request to the X server to
   configure the AutoRepeat control attributes to the values
   specified in timeout and interval .

   XkbSetAutoRepeatRate does not wait for a reply; it normally
   returns True . Specifying a zero value for either timeout or
   interval causes the server to generate a BadValue protocol
   error. If a compatible version of the Xkb extension is not
   available in the server, XkbSetAutoRepeatRate returns False .

The DetectableAutorepeat Control

   Auto-repeat is the generation of multiple key events by a
   keyboard when the user presses a key and holds it down.
   Keyboard hardware and device-dependent X server software often
   implement auto-repeat by generating multiple KeyPress events
   with no intervening KeyRelease event. The standard behavior of
   the X server is to generate a KeyRelease event for every
   KeyPress event. If the keyboard hardware and device-dependent
   software of the X server implement auto-repeat by generating
   multiple KeyPress events, the device-independent part of the X
   server by default synthetically generates a KeyRelease event
   after each KeyPress event. This provides predictable behavior
   for X clients, but does not allow those clients to detect the
   fact that a key is auto-repeating.

   Xkb allows clients to request detectable auto-repeat . If a
   client requests and the server supports DetectableAutorepeat ,
   Xkb generates KeyRelease events only when the key is physically
   released. If DetectableAutorepeat is not supported or has not
   been requested, the server synthesizes a KeyRelease event for
   each repeating KeyPress event it generates.

   DetectableAutorepeat , unlike the other controls in this
   chapter, is not contained in the XkbControlsRec structure, nor
   can it be enabled or disabled via the EnabledControls control.
   Instead, query and set DetectableAutorepeat using
   XkbGetDetectableAutorepeat and XkbSetDetectableAutorepeat .

   DetectableAutorepeat is a condition that applies to all
   keyboard devices for a client's connection to a given X server;
   it cannot be selectively set for some devices and not for
   others. For this reason, none of the Xkb library functions
   involving DetectableAutorepeat involve a device specifier.

   To determine whether or not the server supports
   DetectableAutorepeat , use XkbGetDetectableAutorepeat .
   Bool XkbGetDetectableAutorepeat ( display, supported_rtrn )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   Bool * supported_rtrn ; /* backfilled True if
   DetectableAutorepeat supported */

   XkbGetDetectableAutorepeat queries the server for the current
   state of DetectableAutorepeat and waits for a reply. If
   supported_rtrn is not NULL , it backfills supported_rtrn with
   True if the server supports DetectableAutorepeat , and False
   otherwise. XkbGetDetectableAutorepeat returns the current state
   of DetectableAutorepeat for the requesting client: True if
   DetectableAutorepeat is set, and False otherwise.

   To set DetectableAutorepeat , use XkbSetDetectableAutorepeat .
   This request affects all keyboard activity for the requesting
   client only; other clients still see the expected nondetectable
   auto-repeat behavior, unless they have requested otherwise.
   Bool XkbSetDetectableAutorepeat ( display, detectable,
   supported_rtrn )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   Bool detectable ; /* True => set DetectableAutorepeat */
   Bool * supported_rtrn ; /* backfilled True if
   DetectableAutorepeat supported */

   XkbSetDetectableAutorepeat sends a request to the server to set
   DetectableAutorepeat on for the current client if detectable is
   True , and off it detectable is False ; it then waits for a
   reply. If supported_rtrn is not NULL ,
   XkbSetDetectableAutorepeat backfills supported_rtrn with True
   if the server supports DetectableAutorepeat , and False if it
   does not. XkbSetDetectableAutorepeat returns the current state
   of DetectableAutorepeat for the requesting client: True if
   DetectableAutorepeat is set, and False otherwise.

Controls for Keyboard Overlays (Overlay1 and Overlay2 Controls)

   A keyboard overlay allows some subset of the keyboard to report
   alternate keycodes when the overlay is enabled. For example, a
   keyboard overlay can be used to simulate a numeric or editing
   keypad on a keyboard that does not actually have one by reusing
   some portion of the keyboard as an overlay. This technique is
   very common on portable computers and embedded systems with
   small keyboards.

   Xkb includes direct support for two keyboard overlays, using
   the Overlay1 and Overlay2 controls. When Overlay1 is enabled,
   all of the keys that are members of the first keyboard overlay
   generate an alternate keycode. When Overlay2 is enabled, all of
   the keys that are members of the second keyboard overlay
   generate an alternate keycode. The two overlays are mutually
   exclusive; any particular key may be in at most one overlay.
   Overlay1 and Overlay2 are boolean controls. As such, you may
   enable and disable them using either the EnabledControls
   control or the AutoReset control discussed in section 10.1.1.

   To specify the overlay to which a key belongs and the alternate
   keycode it should generate when that overlay is enabled, assign
   it either the XkbKB_Overlay1 or XkbKB_Overlay2 key behaviors,
   as described in section 16.2.

Controls for Using the Mouse from the Keyboard

   Using Xkb, it is possible to configure the keyboard to allow
   simulation of the X pointer device. This simulation includes
   both movement of the pointer itself and press and release
   events associated with the buttons on the pointer. Two controls
   affect this behavior: the MouseKeys control determines whether
   or not simulation of the pointer device is active, as well as
   configuring the default button; the MouseKeysAccel control
   determines the movement characteristics of the pointer when
   simulated via the keyboard. Both of them are boolean controls;
   as such, you may enable and disable them using either the
   EnabledControls control or the AutoReset control discussed in
   section 10.1.1. The individual keys that simulate different
   aspects of the pointer device are determined by the keyboard
   mapping, discussed in Chapter 16.

The MouseKeys Control

   The MouseKeys control allows a user to control all the mouse
   functions from the keyboard. When MouseKeys are enabled, all
   keys with MouseKeys actions bound to them generate core pointer
   events instead of normal KeyPress and KeyRelease events.

   The MouseKeys control has a single attribute, mk_dflt_btn that
   specifies the core button number to be used by mouse keys
   actions that do not explicitly specify a button. There is no
   convenience function for getting or setting the attribute;
   instead use XkbGetControls and XkbSetControls (see sections
   10.9 and 10.10).

Note

   MouseKeys can also be turned on and off by pressing the key
   combination necessary to produce an XK_Pointer_EnableKeys
   keysym. The de facto default standard for this is
   Shift+Alt+NumLock , but this may vary depending on the keymap.

The MouseKeysAccel Control

   When the MouseKeysAccel control is enabled, the effect of a
   key-activated pointer motion action changes as a key is held
   down. If the control is disabled, pressing a mouse-pointer key
   yields one mouse event. When MouseKeysAccel is enabled, mouse
   movement is defined by an initial distance specified in the
   XkbSA_MovePtr action and the following fields in the
   XkbControlsRec structure (see section 10.8).

   Table 10.2. MouseKeysAccel Fields
   Field Function
   mk_delay Time (ms) between the initial key press and the first
   repeated motion event
   mk_interval Time (ms) between repeated motion events
   mk_time_to_max Number of events (count) before the pointer
   reaches maximum speed
   mk_max_speed The maximum speed (in pixels per event) the
   pointer reaches
   mk_curve The ramp used to reach maximum pointer speed

   There are no convenience functions to query or change the
   attributes of the MouseKeysAccel control; instead use
   XkbGetControls and XkbSetControls (see sections 10.9 and
   10.10).

   The effects of the attributes of the MouseKeysAccel control
   depend on whether the XkbSA_MovePtr action (see section 16.1)
   specifies relative or absolute pointer motion.

Absolute Pointer Motion

   If an XkbSA_MovePtr action specifies an absolute position for
   one of the coordinates but still allows acceleration, all
   repeated events contain any absolute coordinates specified in
   the action. For example, if the XkbSA_MovePtr action specifies
   an absolute position for the X direction, but a relative motion
   for the Y direction, the pointer accelerates in the Y
   direction, but stays at the same X position.

Relative Pointer Motion

   If the XkbSA_MovePtr action specifies relative motion, the
   initial event always moves the cursor the distance specified in
   the action. After mk_delay milliseconds, a second motion event
   is generated, and another occurs every mk_interval milliseconds
   until the user releases the key.

   Between the time of the second motion event and mk_time_to_max
   intervals, the change in pointer distance per interval
   increases with each interval. After mk_time_to_max intervals
   have elapsed, the change in pointer distance per interval
   remains the same and is calculated by multiplying the original
   distance specified in the action by mk_max_speed .

   For example, if the XkbSA_MovePtr action specifies a relative
   motion in the X direction of 5, mk_delay =160, mk_interval =40,
   mk_time_to_max =30, and mk_max_speed =30, the following happens
   when the user presses the key:
     * The pointer immediately moves 5 pixels in the X direction
       when the key is pressed.
     * After 160 milliseconds ( mk_delay ), and every 40
       milliseconds thereafter ( mk_interval ), the pointer moves
       in the X direction.
     * The distance in the X direction increases with each
       interval until 30 intervals ( mk_time_to_max ) have
       elapsed.
     * After 30 intervals, the pointer stops accelerating, and
       moves 150 pixels ( mk_max_speed * the original distance)
       every interval thereafter, until the key is released.

   The increase in pointer difference for each interval is a
   function of mk_curve. Events after the first but before maximum
   acceleration has been achieved are accelerated according to the
   formula:

   Where action_delta is the relative motion specified by the
   XkbSA_MovePtr action, mk_max_speed and mk_time_to_max are
   parameters to the MouseKeysAccel control, and the curveFactor
   is computed using the MouseKeysAccel mk_curve parameter as
   follows:

   With the result that a mk_curve of zero causes the distance
   moved to increase linearly from action_delta to

   . A negative mk_curve causes an initial sharp increase in
   acceleration that tapers off, and a positive curve yields a
   slower initial increase in acceleration followed by a sharp
   increase as the number of pointer events generated by the
   action approaches mk_time_to_max . The legal values for
   mk_curve are between -1000 and 1000.

   A distance vs. time graph of the pointer motion is shown in
   Figure 10.1.
   MouseKeys Acceleration

Controls for Better Keyboard Access by Physically Impaired Persons

   The Xkb extension includes several controls specifically aimed
   at making keyboard use more effective for physically impaired
   people. All of these controls are boolean controls and may be
   individually enabled and disabled, as well as configured to
   tune their specific behavior. The behavior of these controls is
   based on the AccessDOS package ^[4].

The AccessXKeys Control

   Enabling or disabling the keyboard controls through a graphical
   user interface may be impossible for people who need to use the
   controls. For example, a user who needs SlowKeys (see section
   10.6.6) may not even be able to start the graphical
   application, let alone use it, if SlowKeys is not enabled. To
   allow easier access to some of the controls, the AccessXKeys
   control provides a set of special key sequences similar to
   those available in AccessDOS.

   When the AccessXKeys control is enabled, the user can turn
   controls on or off from the keyboard by entering the following
   standard key sequences:
     * Holding down a shift key by itself for eight seconds
       toggles the SlowKeys control.
     * Pressing and releasing the left or right Shift key five
       times in a row, without any intervening key events and with
       less than 30 seconds delay between consecutive presses,
       toggles the state of the StickyKeys control.
     * Simultaneously operating two or more modifier keys
       deactivates the StickyKeys control.

   When the AccessXKeys control is disabled, Xkb does not look for
   the above special key sequences.

   Some of these key sequences optionally generate audible
   feedback of the change in state, as described in section
   10.6.3, or XkbControlsNotify events, described in section
   10.11.

The AccessXTimeout Control

   In environments where computers are shared, features such as
   SlowKeys present a problem: if SlowKeys is on, the keyboard can
   appear to be unresponsive because keys are not accepted until
   they are held for a certain period of time. To help solve this
   problem, Xkb provides an AccessXTimeout control to
   automatically change the enabled/disabled state of any boolean
   controls and to change the value of the AccessXKeys and
   AccessXFeedback control attributes if the keyboard is idle for
   a specified period of time.

   When a timeout as specified by AccessXTimeout occurs and a
   control is consequently modified, Xkb generates an
   XkbControlsNotify event. For more information on
   XkbControlsNotify events, refer to section 10.11.

   Use XkbGetAccessXTimeout to query the current AccessXTimeout
   options for a keyboard device.
   Bool XkbGetAccessXTimeout ( display , device_spec ,
   timeout_rtrn , ctrls_mask_rtrn , ctrls_values_rtrn ,
   options_mask_rtrn, options_values_rtrn )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device to query, or XkbUseCoreKbd
   */
   unsigned short * timeout_rtrn ; /* delay until AccessXTimeout,
   seconds */
   unsigned int * ctrls_mask_rtrn ; /* backfilled with controls to
   modify */
   unsigned int * ctrls_values_rtrn ; /* backfilled with on/off
   status for controls */
   unsigned short * opts_mask_rtrn ; /* backfilled with ax_options
   to modify */
   unsigned short * opts_values_rtrn ; /* backfilled with values
   for ax_options */

   XkbGetAccessXTimeout sends a request to the X server to obtain
   the current values for the AccessXTimeout attributes, waits for
   a reply, and backfills the values into the appropriate
   arguments. The parameters opts_mask_rtrn and opts_values_rtrn
   are backfilled with the options to modify and the values for
   ax_options , which is a field in the XkbControlsRec structure
   (see section 10.8). XkbGetAccessXTimeout returns True if
   successful; if a compatible version of the Xkb extension is not
   available in the server, XkbGetAccessXTimeout returns False .

   To configure the AccessXTimeout options for a keyboard device,
   use XkbSetAccessXTimeout .
   Bool XkbSetAccessXTimeout ( display , device_spec, timeout,
   ctrls_mask, ctrls_values, opts_mask, opts_values )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device to configure, or
   XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned short timeout ; /* seconds idle until AccessXTimeout
   occurs */
   unsigned int ctrls_mask ; /* boolean controls to modify */
   unsigned int ctrls_values ; /* new bits for controls selected
   by ctrls_mask */
   unsigned short opts_mask ; /* ax_options to change */
   unsigned short opts_values ; /* new bits for ax_options
   selected by opts_mask */

   timeout specifies the number of seconds the keyboard must be
   idle before the controls are modified. ctrls_mask specifies
   what controls are to be enabled or disabled, and ctrls_values
   specifies whether those controls are to be enabled or disabled.
   The bit values correspond to those for enabling and disabling
   boolean controls (see section 10.1.1). The opts_mask field
   specifies which attributes of the AccessXKeys and
   AccessXFeedback controls are to be changed, and opts_values
   specifies the new values for those options. The bit values
   correspond to those for the ax_options field of an XkbDescRec
   (see section 10.8).

   XkbSetAccessXTimeout sends a request to configure the
   AccessXTimeout control to the server. It does not wait for a
   reply, and normally returns True . If a compatible version of
   the Xkb extension is not available in the server,
   XkbSetAccessXTimeout returns False .

The AccessXFeedback Control

   Just as some keyboards can produce keyclicks to indicate when a
   key is pressed or repeating, Xkb can provide feedback for the
   controls by using special beep codes. Use the AccessXFeedback
   control to configure the specific types of operations that
   generate feedback.

   There is no convenience function for modifying the
   AccessXFeedback control, although the feedback as a whole can
   be enabled or disabled just as other boolean controls are (see
   section 10.1). Individual beep codes are turned on or off by
   modifying the following bits in the ax_options field of an
   XkbControlsRec structure and using XkbSetControls (see section
   10.10):

   Table 10.3. AccessXFeedback Masks
   Action Beep Code ax_options bit
   LED turned on High-pitched beep XkbAX_IndicatorFBMask
   LED turned off Low-pitched beep XkbAX_IndicatorFBMask
   More than one LED changed state Two high-pitched beeps
   XkbAX_IndicatorFBMask
   Control turned on Rising tone XkbAX_FeatureFBMask
   Control turned off Falling tone XkbAX_FeatureFBMask
   More than one control changed state Two high-pitched beeps
   XkbAX_FeatureFBMask
   SlowKeys and BounceKeys about to be turned on or off Three
   high-pitched beeps XkbAX_SlowWarnFBMask
   SlowKeys key pressed Medium-pitched beep XkbAX_SKPressFBMask
   SlowKeys key accepted Medium-pitched beep XkbAX_SKAcceptFBMask
   SlowKeys key rejected Low-pitched beep XkbAX_SKRejectFBMask
   Accepted SlowKeys key released Medium-pitched beep
   XkbAX_SKReleaseFBMask
   BounceKeys key rejected Low-pitched beep XkbAX_BKRejectFBMask
   StickyKeys key latched Low-pitched beep followed by
   high-pitched beep XkbAX_StickyKeysFBMask
   StickyKeys key locked High-pitched beep XkbAX_StickyKeysFBMask
   StickyKeys key unlocked Low-pitched beep XkbAX_StickyKeysFBMask

   Implementations that cannot generate continuous tones may
   generate multiple beeps instead of falling and rising tones;
   for example, they can generate a high-pitched beep followed by
   a low-pitched beep instead of a continuous falling tone. Other
   implementations can only ring the bell with one fixed pitch. In
   these cases, use the XkbAX_DumbBellFBMask bit of ax_options to
   indicate that the bell can only ring with a fixed pitch.

   When any of the above feedbacks occur, Xkb may generate a
   XkbBellNotify event (see section 9.4).

AccessXNotify Events

   The server can generate XkbAccessXNotify events for some of the
   global keyboard controls. The structure for the
   XkbAccessXNotify event type is as follows:
typedef struct {
      int             type;            /* Xkb extension base event code
*/
      unsigned long   serial;          /* X server serial number for eve
nt */
      Bool            send_event;      /*  True => synthetically generat
ed */
      Display *       display;         /* server connection where event
generated */
      Time            time;            /* server time when event generat
ed */
      int             xkb_type;        /*  XkbAccessXNotify */
      int             device;          /* Xkb device ID, will not be  Xk
bUseCoreKbd */
      int             detail;          /* XkbAXN_* */
      KeyCode         keycode;         /* key of event */
      int             slowKeysDelay;   /* current SlowKeys delay */
      int             debounceDelay;   /* current debounce delay */
} XkbAccessXNotifyEvent;

   The detail field describes what AccessX event just occurred and
   can be any of the values in Table 10.4.

   Table 10.4. AccessXNotify Events
   detail Reason
   XkbAXN_SKPress A key was pressed when SlowKeys was enabled.
   XkbAXN_SKAccept A key was accepted (held longer than the
   SlowKeys delay).
   XkbAXN_SKRelease An accepted SlowKeys key was released.
   XkbAXN_SKReject A key was rejected (released before the
   SlowKeys delay expired).
   XkbAXN_BKAccept A key was accepted by BounceKeys.
   XkbAXN_BKReject A key was rejected (pressed before the
   BounceKeys delay expired).
   XkbAXN_AXKWarning AccessXKeys is about to turn on/off
   StickyKeys or BounceKeys.

   The keycode field reports the keycode of the key for which the
   event occurred. If the action is related to SlowKeys , the
   slowKeysDelay field contains the current SlowKeys acceptance
   delay. If the action is related to BounceKeys , the
   debounceDelay field contains the current BounceKeys debounce
   delay.

Selecting for AccessX Events

   To receive XkbAccessXNotify events under all possible
   conditions, use XkbSelectEvents (see section 4.3) and pass
   XkbAccesXNotifyMask in both bits_to_change and values_for_bits
   .

   To receive XkbStateNotify events only under certain conditions,
   use XkbSelectEventDetails using XkbAccessXNotify as the
   event_type and specifying the desired state changes in
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits using mask bits from Table
   10.5.

   Table 10.5. AccessXNotify Event Details
   XkbAccessXNotify Event Details Value Circumstances
   XkbAXN_SKPressMask (1<<0) Slow key press notification wanted
   XkbAXN_SKAcceptMask (1<<1) Slow key accept notification wanted
   XkbAXN_SKRejectMask (1<<2) Slow key reject notification wanted
   XkbAXN_SKReleaseMask (1<<3) Slow key release notification
   wanted
   XkbAXN_BKAcceptMask (1<<4) Bounce key accept notification
   wanted
   XkbAXN_BKRejectMask (1<<5) Bounce key reject notification
   wanted
   XkbAXN_AXKWarningMask (1<<6) AccessX warning notification
   wanted
   XkbAXN_AllEventsMask (0x7f) All AccessX features notifications
   wanted

StickyKeys, RepeatKeys, and MouseKeys Events

   The StickyKeys , RepeatKeys , and MouseKeys controls do not
   generate specific events. Instead, the latching, unlatching,
   locking, or unlocking of modifiers using StickyKeys generates
   XkbStateNotify events as described in section 5.4. Repeating
   keys generate normal KeyPress and KeyRelease events, though the
   auto-repeat can be detected using DetectableAutorepeat (see
   section 10.3.3). Finally, MouseKeys generates pointer events
   identical to those of the core pointer device.

The SlowKeys Control

   Some users may accidentally bump keys while moving a hand or
   typing stick toward the key they want. Usually, the keys that
   are accidentally bumped are just hit for a very short period of
   time. The SlowKeys control helps filter these accidental bumps
   by telling the server to wait a specified period, called the
   SlowKeys acceptance delay , before delivering key events. If
   the key is released before this period elapses, no key events
   are generated. Users can then bump any number of keys on their
   way to the one they want without accidentally getting those
   characters. Once they have reached the key they want, they can
   then hold the desired key long enough for the computer to
   accept it. SlowKeys is a boolean control with one configurable
   attribute.

   When the SlowKeys control is active, the server reports the
   initial key press, subsequent acceptance or rejection, and
   release of any key to interested clients by sending an
   appropriate AccessXNotify event (see section 10.6.4).

   To get the SlowKeys acceptance delay for a keyboard device, use
   XkbGetSlowKeysDelay .
   Bool XkbGetSlowKeysDelay ( display , device_spec , delay_rtrn )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int * delay_rtrn ; /* backfilled with SlowKeys delay,
   ms */

   XkbGetSlowKeysDelay requests the attributes of the SlowKeys
   control from the server, waits for a reply and backfills
   delay_rtrn with the SlowKeys delay attribute.
   XkbGetSlowKeysDelay returns True if successful; if a compatible
   version of the Xkb extension is not available in the server,
   XkbGetSlowKeysDelay returns False .

   To set the SlowKeys acceptance delay for a keyboard device, use
   XkbSetSlowKeysDelay .
   Bool XkbSetSlowKeysDelay ( display , device_spec , delay )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device to configure, or
   XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int delay ; /* SlowKeys delay, ms */

   XkbSetSlowKeysDelay sends a request to configure the SlowKeys
   control to the server. It does not wait for a reply, and
   normally returns True . Specifying a value of 0 for the delay
   parameter causes XkbSetSlowKeys to generate a BadValue protocol
   error. If a compatible version of the Xkb extension is not
   available in the server XkbSetSlowKeysDelay returns False .

The BounceKeys Control

   Some users may accidentally "bounce" on a key when they release
   it. They press it once, then accidentally press it again after
   they release it. The BounceKeys control temporarily disables a
   key after it has been pressed, effectively "debouncing" the
   keyboard. The period of time the key is disabled after it is
   released is known as the BounceKeys delay . BounceKeys is a
   boolean control.

   When the BounceKeys control is active, the server reports
   acceptance or rejection of any key to interested clients by
   sending an appropriate AccessXNotify event (see section
   10.6.4).

   Use XkbGetBounceKeysDelay to query the current BounceKeys delay
   for a keyboard device.
   Bool XkbGetBounceKeysDelay ( display , device_spec , delay_rtrn
   )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int * delay_rtrn ; /* backfilled with bounce keys
   delay, ms */

   XkbGetBounceKeysDelay requests the attributes of the BounceKeys
   control from the server, waits for a reply, and backfills
   delay_rtrn with the BounceKeys delay attribute.
   XkbGetBounceKeysDelay returns True if successful; if a
   compatible version of the Xkb extension is not available in the
   server XkbGetSlowKeysDelay returns False .

   To set the BounceKeys delay for a keyboard device, use
   XkbSetBounceKeysDelay .
   Bool XkbSetBounceKeysDelay ( display , device_spec , delay )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device to configure, or
   XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int delay ; /* bounce keys delay, ms */

   XkbSetBounceKeysDelay sends a request to configure the
   BounceKeys control to the server. It does not wait for a reply
   and normally returns True . Specifying a value of zero for the
   delay parameter causes XkbSetBounceKeysDelay to generate a
   BadValue protocol error. If a compatible version of the Xkb
   extension is not available in the server, XkbSetBounceKeysDelay
   returns False .

The StickyKeys Control

   Some people find it difficult or even impossible to press two
   keys at once. For example, a one-fingered typist or someone
   using a mouth stick cannot press the Shift and 1 keys at the
   same time. The StickyKeys control solves this problem by
   changing the behavior of the modifier keys. With StickyKeys ,
   the user can first press a modifier, release it, then press
   another key. For example, to get an exclamation point on a
   PC-style keyboard, the user can press the Shift key, release
   it, and then press the 1 key.

   StickyKeys also allows users to lock modifier keys without
   requiring special locking keys. When StickyKeys is enabled, a
   modifier is latched when the user presses it just once. The
   user can press a modifier twice in a row to lock it, and then
   unlock it by pressing it one more time.

   When a modifier is latched, it becomes unlatched when the user
   presses a nonmodifier key or a pointer button. For instance, to
   enter the sequence Shift + Control + Z the user could press and
   release the Shift key to latch it, then press and release the
   Control key to latch it, and finally press and release the Z
   key. Because the Control key is a modifier key, pressing it
   does not unlatch the Shift key. Thus, after the user presses
   the Control key, both the Shift and Control modifiers are
   latched. When the user presses the Z key, the effect is as
   though the user had pressed Shift + Control + Z . In addition,
   because the Z key is not a modifier key, the Shift and Control
   modifiers are unlatched.

   Locking a modifier key means that the modifier affects any key
   or pointer button the user presses until the user unlocks it or
   it is unlocked programmatically. For example, to enter the
   sequence ("XKB") on a keyboard where `(' is a shifted `9', `)'
   is a shifted `0', and `"' is a shifted single quote, the user
   could press and release the Shift key twice to lock the Shift
   modifier. Then, when the user presses the 9 , ` , x , k , b , `
   , and 0 keys in sequence, it generates ("XKB"). To unlock the
   Shift modifier, the user can press and release the Shift key.

   StickyKeys is a boolean control with two separate attributes
   that may be individually configured: one to automatically
   disable it, and one to control the latching behavior of
   modifier keys.

StickyKeys Options

   The StickyKeys control has two options that can be accessed via
   the ax_options of an XkbControlsRec structure (see section
   10.8). The first option, TwoKeys , specifies whether StickyKeys
   should automatically turn off when two keys are pressed at the
   same time. This feature is useful for shared computers so
   people who do not want them do not need to turn StickyKeys off
   if a previous user left StickyKeys on. The second option,
   LatchToLock , specifies whether or not StickyKeys locks a
   modifier when pressed twice in a row.

   Use XkbGetStickyKeysOptions to query the current StickyKeys
   attributes for a keyboard device.
   Bool XkbGetStickyKeysOptions ( display , device_spec ,
   options_rtrn )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int * options_rtrn ; /* backfilled with StickyKeys
   option mask */

   XkbGetStickyKeysOptions requests the attributes of the
   StickyKeys control from the server, waits for a reply, and
   backfills options_rtrn with a mask indicating whether the
   individual StickyKeys options are on or off. Valid bits in
   options_rtrn are:

     XkbAX_TwoKeysMask
     XkbAX_LatchToLockMask

   XkbGetStickyKeysOptions returns True if successful; if a
   compatible version of the Xkb extension is not available in the
   server XkbGetStickyKeysOptions returns False .

   To set the StickyKeys attributes for a keyboard device, use
   XkbSetStickyKeysOptions .
   Bool XkbSetStickyKeysOptions ( display , device_spec, mask,
   values )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device to configure, or
   XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int mask ; /* selects StickyKeys attributes to modify
   */
   unsigned int values; /* values for selected attributes */

   XkbSetStickyKeysOptions sends a request to configure the
   StickyKeys control to the server. It does not wait for a reply
   and normally returns True . The valid bits to use for both the
   mask and values parameters are:

     XkbAX_TwoKeysMask
     XkbAX_LatchToLockMask

   If a compatible version of the Xkb extension is not available
   in the server, XkbSetStickyKeysOptions returns False .

Controls for General Keyboard Mapping

   There are several controls that apply to the keyboard mapping
   in general. They control handling of out-of-range group indices
   and how modifiers are processed and consumed in the server.
   These are:

     GroupsWrap
     IgnoreGroupLock
     IgnoreLockMods
     InternalMods

   IgnoreGroupLock is a boolean control; the rest are always
   active.

   Without the modifier processing options provided by Xkb,
   passive grabs set via translations in a client (for example,
   Alt<KeyPress>space ) do not trigger if any modifiers other than
   those specified by the translation are set. This results in
   problems in the user interface when either NumLock or a
   secondary keyboard group is active. The IgnoreLockMods and
   IgnoreGroupLock controls make it possible to avoid this
   behavior without exhaustively specifying a grab for every
   possible modifier combination.

The GroupsWrap Control

   The GroupsWrap control determines how illegal groups are
   handled on a global basis. There are a number of valid keyboard
   sequences that can cause the effective group number to go out
   of range. When this happens, the group must be normalized back
   to a valid number. The GroupsWrap control specifies how this is
   done.

   When dealing with group numbers, all computations are done
   using the group index, which is the group number minus one.
   There are three different algorithms; the GroupsWrap control
   specifies which one is used:
     * XkbRedirectIntoRange
       All invalid group numbers are converted to a valid group
       number by taking the last four bits of the GroupsWrap
       control and using them as the group index. If the result is
       still out of range, Group one is used.
     * XkbClampIntoRange
       All invalid group numbers are converted to the nearest
       valid group number. Group numbers larger than the highest
       supported group number are mapped to the highest supported
       group; those less than one are mapped to group one.
     * XkbWrapIntoRange
       All invalid group numbers are converted to a valid group
       number using integer modulus applied to the group index.

   There are no convenience functions for manipulating the
   GroupsWrap control. Manipulate the GroupsWrap control via the
   groups_wrap field in the XkbControlsRec structure, then use
   XkbSetControls and XkbGetControls (see section 10.9 and section
   10.10) to query and change this control.

Note

   See also section 15.3.2 or a discussion of the related field,
   group_info , which also normalizes a group under certain
   circumstances.

The IgnoreLockMods Control

   The core protocol does not provide a way to exclude specific
   modifiers from grab calculations, with the result that locking
   modifiers sometimes have unanticipated side effects.

   The IgnoreLockMods control specifies modifiers that should be
   excluded from grab calculations. These modifiers are also not
   reported in any core events except KeyPress and KeyRelease
   events that do not activate a passive grab and that do not
   occur while a grab is active.

   Manipulate the IgnoreLockMods control via the ignore_lock field
   in the XkbControlsRec structure, then use XkbSetControls and
   XkbGetControls (see sections 10.9 and 10.10) to query and
   change this control. Alternatively, use XkbSetIgnoreLockMods .

   To set the modifiers that, if locked, are not to be reported in
   matching events to passive grabs, use XkbSetIgnoreLockMods.
   Bool XkbSetIgnoreLockMods ( display, device_spec, affect_real,
   real_values, affect_virtual, virtual_values )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int affect_real ; /* mask of real modifiers affected
   by this call */
   unsigned int real_values ; /* values for affected real
   modifiers (1=>set, 0=>unset) */
   unsigned int affect_virtual ; /* mask of virtual modifiers
   affected by this call */
   unsigned int virtual_values ; /* values for affected virtual
   modifiers (1=>set, 0=>unset) */

   XkbSetIgnoreLockMods sends a request to the server to change
   the server's IgnoreLockMods control. affect_real and
   real_values are masks of real modifier bits indicating which
   real modifiers are to be added and removed from the server's
   IgnoreLockMods control. Modifiers selected by both affect_real
   and real_values are added to the server's IgnoreLockMods
   control; those selected by affect_real but not by real_values
   are removed from the server's IgnoreLockMods control. Valid
   values for affect_real and real_values consist of any
   combination of the eight core modifier bits: ShiftMask ,
   LockMask , ControlMask , Mod1Mask - Mod5Mask . affect_virtual
   and virtual_values are masks of virtual modifier bits
   indicating which virtual modifiers are to be added and removed
   from the server's IgnoreLockMods control. Modifiers selected by
   both affect_virtual and virtual_values are added to the
   server's IgnoreLockMods control; those selected by
   affect_virtual but not by virtual_values are removed from the
   server's IgnoreLockMods control. See section 7.1 for a
   discussion of virtual modifier masks to use in affect_virtual
   and virtual_values . XkbSetIgnoreLockMods does not wait for a
   reply from the server. It returns True if the request was sent,
   and False otherwise.

The IgnoreGroupLock Control

   The IgnoreGroupLock control is a boolean control with no
   attributes. If enabled, it specifies that the locked state of
   the keyboard group should not be considered when activating
   passive grabs.

   Because IgnoreGroupLock is a boolean control with no
   attributes, use the general boolean controls functions (see
   section 10.1) to change its state.

The InternalMods Control

   The core protocol does not provide any means to prevent a
   modifier from being reported in events sent to clients; Xkb,
   however makes this possible via the InternalMods control. It
   specifies modifiers that should be consumed by the server and
   not reported to clients. When a key is pressed and a modifier
   that has its bit set in the InternalMods control is reported to
   the server, the server uses the modifier when determining the
   actions to apply for the key. The server then clears the bit,
   so it is not actually reported to the client. In addition,
   modifiers specified in the InternalMods control are not used to
   determine grabs and are not used to calculate core protocol
   compatibility state.

   Manipulate the InternalMods control via the internal field in
   the XkbControlsRec structure, using XkbSetControls and
   XkbGetControls (see sections10.9 and 10.10). Alternatively, use
   XkbSetServerInternalMods .

   To set the modifiers that are consumed by the server before
   events are delivered to the client, use
   XkbSetServerInternalMods.
   Bool XkbSetServerInternalMods ( display, device_spec,
   affect_real, real_values, affect_virtual, virtual_values )
   Display * display ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ;` /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int affect_real ; /* mask of real modifiers affected
   by this call */
   unsigned int real_values ; /* values for affected real
   modifiers (1=>set, 0=>unset) */
   unsigned int affect_virtual ; /* mask of virtual modifiers
   affected by this call */
   unsigned int virtual_values ; /* values for affected virtual
   modifiers (1=>set, 0=>unset) */

   XkbSetServerInternalMods sends a request to the server to
   change the internal modifiers consumed by the server.
   affect_real and real_values are masks of real modifier bits
   indicating which real modifiers are to be added and removed
   from the server's internal modifiers control. Modifiers
   selected by both affect_real and real_values are added to the
   server's internal modifiers control; those selected by
   affect_real but not by real_values are removed from the
   server's internal modifiers mask. Valid values for affect_real
   and real_values consist of any combination of the eight core
   modifier bits: ShiftMask , LockMask , ControlMask , Mod1Mask -
   Mod5Mask . affect_virtual and virtual_values are masks of
   virtual modifier bits indicating which virtual modifiers are to
   be added and removed from the server's internal modifiers
   control. Modifiers selected by both affect_virtual and
   virtual_values are added to the server's internal modifiers
   control; those selected by affect_virtual but not by
   virtual_values are removed from the server's internal modifiers
   control. See section 7.1 for a discussion of virtual modifier
   masks to use in affect_virtual and virtual_values .
   XkbSetServerInternalMods does not wait for a reply from the
   server. It returns True if the request was sent and False
   otherwise.

The XkbControlsRec Structure

   Many of the individual controls described in sections 10.1
   through 10.7 may be manipulated via convenience functions
   discussed in those sections. Some of them, however, have no
   convenience functions. The XkbControlsRec structure allows the
   manipulation of one or more of the controls in a single
   operation and to track changes to any of them in conjunction
   with the XkbGetControls and XkbSetControls functions. This is
   the only way to manipulate those controls that have no
   convenience functions.

   The XkbControlsRec structure is defined as follows:

#define      XkbMaxLegalKeyCode       255
#define      XkbPerKeyBitArraySize    ((XkbMaxLegalKeyCode+1)/8)

typedef struct {
      unsigned char        mk_dflt_btn;       /* default button for keyb
oard driven mouse */
      unsigned char        num_groups;        /* number of keyboard grou
ps */
      unsigned char        groups_wrap;       /* how to wrap out-of-boun
ds groups */
      XkbModsRec           internal;          /* defines server internal
 modifiers */
      XkbModsRec           ignore_lock;       /* modifiers to ignore whe
n checking for grab */
      unsigned int         enabled_ctrls;     /* 1 bit => corresponding
boolean control enabled */
      unsigned short       repeat_delay;      /* ms delay until first re
peat */
      unsigned short       repeat_interval;   /* ms delay between repeat
s */
      unsigned short       slow_keys_delay;   /* ms minimum time key mus
t be down to be ok */
      unsigned short       debounce_delay;    /* ms delay before key rea
ctivated */
      unsigned short       mk_delay;          /* ms delay to second mous
e motion event */
      unsigned short       mk_interval;       /* ms delay between repeat
 mouse events */
      unsigned short       mk_time_to_max;    /* # intervals until const
ant mouse move */
      unsigned short       mk_max_speed;      /* multiplier for maximum
mouse speed */
      short                mk_curve;          /* determines mouse move c
urve type */
      unsigned short       ax_options;        /* 1 bit => Access X optio
n enabled */
      unsigned short       ax_timeout;        /* seconds until Access X
disabled */
      unsigned short       axt_opts_mask;     /* 1 bit => options to res
et on Access X timeout */
      unsigned short       axt_opts_values;   /* 1 bit => turn option on
, 0=> off */
      unsigned int         axt_ctrls_mask;    /* which bits in  enabled_
ctrls to modify */
      unsigned int         axt_ctrls_values;  /* values for new bits in
 enabled_ctrls */
      unsigned char        per_key_repeat[XkbPerKeyBitArraySize];
    /* per key auto repeat */
} XkbControlsRec, *XkbControlsPtr;

   The general-purpose functions that work with the XkbControlsRec
   structure use a mask to specify which controls are to be
   manipulated. Table 10.6 lists these controls, the masks used to
   select them in the general function calls ( which parameter),
   and the data fields in the XkbControlsRec structure that
   comprise each of the individual controls. Also listed are the
   bit used to turn boolean controls on and off and the section
   where each control is described in more detail.

   Table 10.6. Xkb Controls
   Control Control Selection Mask (which parameter) Relevant
   XkbControlsRec Data Fields Boolean Control enabled_ctrls bit
   Section
   AccessXFeedback XkbAccessXFeedbackMask ax_options:
   XkbAX_*FBMask XkbAccessXFeedbackMask 10.6.3
   AccessXKeys     XkbAccessXKeysMask 10.6.1
   AccessXTimeout XkbAccessXTimeoutMask

   ax_timeout

   axt_opts_mask

   axt_opts_values

   axt_ctrls_mask

   axt_ctrls_values
   XkbAccessXTimeoutMask 10.6.2
   AudibleBell     XkbAudibleBellMask 9.2
   AutoReset       10.1.2
   BounceKeys XkbBounceKeysMask debounce_delay XkbBounceKeysMask
   10.6.7
   Detectable-Autorepeat       10.3.3
   EnabledControls XkbControlsEnabledMask enabled_ctrls
   Non-Boolean Control 10.1.1
   GroupsWrap XkbGroupsWrapMask groups_wrap Non-Boolean Control
   10.7.1
   IgnoreGroupLock     XkbIgnoreGroupLockMask 10.7.3
   IgnoreLockMods XkbIgnoreLockModsMask ignore_lock Non-Boolean
   Control 5.1
   InternalMods XkbInternalModsMask internal Non-Boolean Control
   5.1
   MouseKeys XkbMouseKeysMask mk_dflt_btn XkbMouseKeysMask 10.5.1
   MouseKeysAccel XkbMouseKeysAccelMask

   mk_delay

   mk_interval

   mk_time_to_max

   mk_max_speed

   mk_curve
   XkbMouseKeysAccelMask 10.5.2
   Overlay1     XkbOverlay1Mask 10.4
   Overlay2     XkbOverlay2Mask 10.4
   PerKeyRepeat XkbPerKeyRepeatMask per_key_repeat Non-Boolean
   Control 10.3.1
   RepeatKeys XkbRepeatKeysMask

   repeat_delay

   repeat_interval
   XkbRepeatKeysMask 10.3
   SlowKeys XkbSlowKeysMask slow_keys_delay XkbSlowKeysMask 10.6.6
   StickyKeys XkbStickyKeysMask

   ax_options:

   XkbAX_TwoKeysMask

   XkbAX_LatchToLockMask
   XkbStickyKeysMask 10.6.8

   Table 10.7 shows the actual values for the individual mask bits
   used to select controls for modification and to enable and
   disable the control. Note that the same mask bit is used to
   specify general modifications to the parameters used to
   configure the control ( which ), and to enable and disable the
   control ( enabled_ctrls ). The anomalies in the table (no "ok"
   in column) are for controls that have no configurable
   attributes; and for controls that are not boolean controls and
   therefore cannot be enabled or disabled.

   Table 10.7. Controls Mask Bits
   Mask Bit which or changed_ctrls enabled_ctrls Value
   XkbRepeatKeysMask ok ok (1L<<0)
   XkbSlowKeysMask ok ok (1L<<1)
   XkbBounceKeysMask ok ok (1L<<2)
   XkbStickyKeysMask ok ok (1L<<3)
   XkbMouseKeysMask ok ok (1L<<4)
   XkbMouseKeysAccelMask ok ok (1L<<5)
   XkbAccessXKeysMask ok ok (1L<<6)
   XkbAccessXTimeoutMask ok ok (1L<<7)
   XkbAccessXFeedbackMask ok ok (1L<<8)
   XkbAudibleBellMask   ok (1L<<9)
   XkbOverlay1Mask   ok (1L<<10)
   XkbOverlay2Mask   ok (1L<<11)
   XkbIgnoreGroupLockMask   ok (1L<<12)
   XkbGroupsWrapMask ok   (1L<<27)
   XkbInternalModsMask ok   (1L<<28)
   XkbIgnoreLockModsMask ok   (1L<<29)
   XkbPerKeyRepeatMask ok   (1L<<30)
   XkbControlsEnabledMask ok   (1L<<31)
   XkbAccessXOptionsMask ok ok (XkbStickyKeysMask |
   XkbAccessXFeedbackMask)
   XkbAllBooleanCtrlsMask   ok (0x00001FFF)
   XkbAllControlsMask ok   (0xF8001FFF)

   The individual fields of the XkbControlsRec structure are
   defined as follows.

mk_dflt_btn

   mk_dflt_btn is an attribute of the MouseKeys control (see
   section 10.5 ). It specifies the mouse button number to use for
   keyboard simulated mouse button operations. Its value should be
   one of the core symbols Button1 - Button5 .

num_groups

   num_groups is not a part of any control, but is reported in the
   XkbControlsRec structure whenever any of its components are
   fetched from the server. It reports the number of groups the
   particular keyboard configuration uses and is computed
   automatically by the server whenever the keyboard mapping
   changes.

groups_wrap

   groups_wrap is an attribute of the GroupsWrap control (see
   section 10.7.1). It specifies the handling of illegal groups on
   a global basis. Valid values for groups_wrap are shown in Table
   10.8.

   Table 10.8. GroupsWrap options (groups_wrap field)
   groups_wrap symbolic name value
   XkbWrapIntoRange          (0x00)
   XkbClampIntoRange         (0x40)
   XkbRedirectIntoRange      (0x80)

   When groups_wrap is set to XkbRedirectIntoRange , its four
   low-order bits specify the index of the group to use.

internal

   internal is an attribute of the InternalMods control (see
   section 10.7.4). It specifies modifiers to be consumed in the
   server and not passed on to clients when events are reported.
   Valid values consist of any combination of the eight core
   modifier bits: ShiftMask , LockMask , ControlMask , Mod1Mask -
   Mod5Mask .

ignore_lock

   ignore_lock is an attribute of the IgnoreLockMods control (see
   section 10.7.2). It specifies modifiers to be ignored in grab
   calculations. Valid values consist of any combination of the
   eight core modifier bits: ShiftMask , LockMask , ControlMask ,
   Mod1Mask - Mod5Mask .

enabled_ctrls

   enabled_ctrls is an attribute of the EnabledControls control
   (see section 10.1.1). It contains one bit per boolean control.
   Each bit determines whether the corresponding control is
   enabled or disabled; a one bit means the control is enabled.
   The mask bits used to enable these controls are listed in Table
   10.7, using only those masks with "ok" in the enabled_ctrls
   column.

repeat_delay and repeat_interval

   repeat_delay and repeat_interval are attributes of the
   RepeatKeys control (see section 10.3.2). repeat_delay is the
   initial delay before a key begins repeating, in milliseconds;
   repeat_interval is the delay between subsequent key events, in
   milliseconds.

slow_keys_delay

   slow_keys_delay is an attribute of the SlowKeys control (see
   section 10.6.6). Its value specifies the SlowKeys acceptance
   delay period in milliseconds before a key press is accepted by
   the server.

debounce_delay

   debounce_delay is an attribute of the BounceKeys control (see
   section 10.6.7). Its value specifies the BounceKeys delay
   period in milliseconds for which the key is disabled after
   having been pressed before another press of the same key is
   accepted by the server.

mk_delay, mk_interval, mk_time_to_max, mk_max_speed, and mk_curve

   mk_delay , mk_interval , mk_time_to_max , mk_max_speed , and
   mk_curve are attributes of the MouseKeysAccel control. Refer to
   section 10.5.2 for a description of these fields and the units
   involved.

ax_options

   The ax_options field contains attributes used to configure two
   different controls, the StickyKeys control (see section 10.6.8)
   and the AccessXFeedback control (see section 10.6.3). The
   ax_options field is a bitmask and may include any combination
   of the bits defined in Table 10.9.

   Table 10.9. Access X Enable/Disable Bits (ax_options field)
   Access X Control ax_options bit         value
   AccessXFeedback  XkbAX_SKPressFBMask    (1L<<0)
                    XkbAX_SKAcceptFBMask   (1L << 1)
                    XkbAX_FeatureFBMask    (1L << 2)
                    XkbAX_SlowWarnFBMask   (1L << 3)
                    XkbAX_IndicatorFBMask  (1L << 4)
                    XkbAX_StickyKeysFBMask (1L << 5)
                    XkbAX_SKReleaseFBMask  (1L << 8)
                    XkbAX_SKRejectFBMask   (1L << 9)
                    XkbAX_BKRejectFBMask   (1L << 10)
                    XkbAX_DumbBellFBMask   (1L << 11)
   StickyKeys       XkbAX_TwoKeysMask      (1L << 6)
                    XkbAX_LatchToLockMask  (1L << 7)
                    XkbAX_AllOptionsMask   (0xFFF)

   The fields pertaining to each control are relevant only when
   the control is enabled ( XkbAccessXFeedbackMask or
   XkbStickyKeysMask bit is turned on in the enabled_cntrls
   field).

   Xkb provides a set of convenience macros for working with the
   ax_options field of an XkbControlsRec structure:
#define      XkbAX_NeedOption
(c,w)      ((c)->ax_options&(w))

   The XkbAX_NeedOption macro is useful for determining whether a
   particular AccessX option is enabled or not. It accepts a
   pointer to an XkbControlsRec structure and a valid mask bit
   from Table 10.9. If the specified mask bit in the ax_options
   field of the controls structure is set, the macro returns the
   mask bit. Otherwise, it returns zero. Thus,

   XkbAX_NeedOption(ctlrec, XkbAX_LatchToLockMask)

   is nonzero if the latch to lock transition for latching keys is
   enabled, and zero if it is disabled. Note that XkbAX_NeedOption
   only determines whether or not the particular capability is
   configured to operate; the XkbAccessXFeedbackMask bit must also
   be turned on in enabled_ctrls for the capability to actually be
   functioning.
#define      XkbAX_AnyFeedback
(c)      ((c)->enabled_ctrls&XkbAccessXFeedbackMask)

   The XkbAX_AnyFeeback macro accepts a pointer to an
   XkbControlsRec structure and tells whether the AccessXFeedback
   control is enabled or not. If the AccessXFeedback control is
   enabled, the macro returns XkbAccessXFeedbackMask . Otherwise,
   it returns zero.
#define      XkbAX_NeedFeedback
(c,w)      (XkbAX_AnyFeedback(c)&&XkbAX_NeedOption(c,w))

   The XkbAX_NeedFeedback macro is useful for determining if both
   the AccessXFeedback control and a particular AccessX feedback
   option are enabled. The macro accepts a pointer to an
   XkbControlsRec structure and a feedback option from the table
   above. If both the AccessXFeedback control and the specified
   feedback option are enabled, the macro returns True . Otherwise
   it returns False .

ax_timeout, axt_opts_mask, axt_opts_values, axt_ctrls_mask, and
axt_ctrls_values

   ax_timeout , act_opts_mask , axt_opts_values , axt_ctrls_mask ,
   and axt_ctrls_values are attributes of the AccessXTimeout
   control. Refer to section 10.6.2 for a description of these
   fields and the units involved.

per_key_repeat

   The per_key_repeat field mirrors the auto_repeats field of the
   core protocol XKeyboardState structure: changing the
   auto_repeats field automatically changes per_key_repeat and
   vice versa. It is provided for convenience and to reduce
   protocol traffic. For example, to obtain the individual repeat
   key behavior as well as the repeat delay and rate, use
   XkbGetControls . If the per_key_repeat were not in this
   structure, you would have to call both XGetKeyboardControl and
   XkbGetControls to get this information. The bits correspond to
   keycodes. The first seven keys (keycodes 1-7) are indicated in
   per_key_repeat [0], with bit position 0 (low order)
   corresponding to the fictitious keycode 0. Following array
   elements correspond to 8 keycodes per element. A 1 bit
   indicates that the key is a repeating key.

Querying Controls

   Use XkbGetControls to find the current state of Xkb server
   controls.
   Status XkbGetControls ( display, which, xkb)
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned long which ; /* mask of controls requested */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description for controls
   information*/

   XkbGetControls queries the server for the requested control
   information, waits for a reply, and then copies the server's
   values for the requested information into the ctrls structure
   of the xkb argument. Only those components specified by the
   which parameter are copied. Valid values for which are any
   combination of the masks listed in Table 10.7 that have "ok" in
   the which column.

   If xkb -> ctrls is NULL , XkbGetControls allocates and
   initializes it before obtaining the values specified by which .
   If xkb -> ctrls is not NULL , XkbGetControls modifies only
   those portions of xkb -> ctrls corresponding to the values
   specified by which .

   XkbGetControls returns Success if successful; otherwise, it
   returns BadAlloc if it cannot obtain sufficient storage,
   BadMatch if xkb is NULL or which is empty, or BadImplementation
   .

   To free the ctrls member of a keyboard description, use
   XkbFreeControls (see section 10.12)

   The num_groups field in the ctrls structure is always filled in
   by XkbGetControls , regardless of which bits are selected by
   which .

Changing Controls

   There are two ways to make changes to controls: either change a
   local copy keyboard description and call XkbSetControls , or,
   to reduce network traffic, use an XkbControlsChangesRec
   structure and call XkbChangeControls .

   To change the state of one or more controls, first modify the
   ctrls structure in a local copy of the keyboard description and
   then use XkbSetControls to copy those changes to the X server.
   Bool XkbSetControls ( display, which, xkb)
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned long which ; /* mask of controls to change */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* ctrls field contains new values to be set
   */

   For each bit that is set in the which parameter, XkbSetControls
   sends the corresponding values from the xkb -> ctrls field to
   the server. Valid values for which are any combination of the
   masks listed in Table 10.7 that have "ok" in the which column.

   If xkb -> ctrls is NULL , the server does not support a
   compatible version of Xkb, or the Xkb extension has not been
   properly initialized, XkbSetControls returns False . Otherwise,
   it sends the request to the X server and returns True .

   Note that changes to attributes of controls in the
   XkbControlsRec structure are apparent only when the associated
   control is enabled, although the corresponding values are still
   updated in the X server. For example, the repeat_delay and
   repeat_interval fields are ignored unless the RepeatKeys
   control is enabled (that is, the X server's equivalent of
   xkb->ctrls has XkbRepeatKeyMask set in enabled_ctrls ). It is
   permissible to modify the attributes of a control in one call
   to XkbSetControls and enable the control in a subsequent call.
   See section 10.1.1 for more information on enabling and
   disabling controls.

   Note that the enabled_ctrls field is itself a control -- the
   EnabledControls control. As such, to set a specific
   configuration of enabled and disabled boolean controls, you
   must set enabled_ctrls to the appropriate bits to enable only
   the controls you want and disable all others, then specify the
   XkbControlsEnabledMask in a call to XkbSetControls . Because
   this is somewhat awkward if all you want to do is enable and
   disable controls, and not modify any of their attributes, a
   convenience function is also provided for this purpose (
   XkbChangeEnabledControls , section 10.1.1).

The XkbControlsChangesRec Structure

   The XkbControlsChangesRec structure allows applications to
   track modifications to an XkbControlsRec structure and thereby
   reduce the amount of traffic sent to the server. The same
   XkbControlsChangesRec structure may be used in several
   successive modifications to the same XkbControlsRec structure,
   then subsequently used to cause all of the changes, and only
   the changes, to be propagated to the server. The
   XkbControlsChangesRec structure is defined as follows:
typedef struct _XkbControlsChanges {
      unsigned int changed_ctrls;          /* bits indicating changed co
ntrol data */
      unsigned int enabled_ctrls_changes;  /* bits indicating enabled/di
sabled controls */
      Bool         num_groups_changed;     /*  True if
                                              number of keyboard groups
changed */
} XkbControlsChangesRec,*XkbControlsChangesPtr;

   The changed_ctrls field is a mask specifying which logical sets
   of data in the controls structure have been modified. In this
   context, modified means set , that is, if a value is set to the
   same value it previously contained, it has still been modified,
   and is noted as changed. Valid values for changed_ctrls are any
   combination of the masks listed in Table 10.7 that have "ok" in
   the changed_ctrls column. Setting a bit implies the
   corresponding data fields from the "Relevant XkbControlsRec
   Data Fields" column in Table 10.6 have been modified. The
   enabled_ctrls_changes field specifies which bits in the
   enabled_ctrls field have changed. If the number of keyboard
   groups has changed, the num_groups_changed field is set to
   True.

   If you have an Xkb description with controls that have been
   modified and an XkbControlsChangesRec that describes the
   changes that have been made, the XkbChangeControls function
   provides a flexible method for updating the controls in a
   server to match those in the changed keyboard description.
   Bool XkbChangeControls ( dpy, xkb, changes )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description with changed
   xkb->ctrls */
   XkbControlsChangesPtr changes ; /* which parts of xkb->ctrls
   have changed */

   XkbChangeControls copies any controls fields specified by
   changes from the keyboard description controls structure, xkb
   -> ctrls , to the server specified by dpy .

Tracking Changes to Keyboard Controls

   Whenever a field in the controls structure changes in the
   server's keyboard description, the server sends an
   XkbControlsNotify event to all interested clients.To receive
   XkbControlsNotify events under all possible conditions, use
   XkbSelectEvents (see section 4.3) and pass
   XkbControlsNotifyMask in both bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits .

   To receive XkbControlsNotify events only under certain
   conditions, use XkbSelectEventDetails using XkbControlsNotify
   as the event_type and specifying the desired state changes in
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits using mask bits from Table
   10.7.

   The structure for the XkbControlsNotify event is defined as
   follows:
typedef struct {
      int            type;            /* Xkb extension base event code *
/
      unsigned long  serial;          /* X server serial number for even
t */
      Bool           send_event;      /*  True => synthetically generate
d */
      Display *      display;         /* server connection where event g
enerated */
      Time           time;            /* server time when event generate
d */
      int            xkb_type;        /*  XkbCompatMapNotify */
      int            device;          /* Xkb device ID, will not be  Xkb
UseCoreKbd */
      unsigned int   changed_ctrls;   /* bits indicating which controls
data have changed*/
      unsigned int   enabled_ctrls;   /* controls currently enabled in s
erver */
      unsigned int   enabled_ctrl_changes;  /* bits indicating enabled/d
isabled controls */
      int            num_groups;      /* current number of keyboard grou
ps */
      KeyCode        keycode;         /* != 0 => keycode of key causing
change */
      char           event_type;      /* Type of event causing change */
      char           req_major;       /* major event code of event causi
ng change */
      char           req_minor;       /* minor event code of event causi
ng change */
} XkbControlsNotifyEvent;

   The changed_ctrls field specifies the controls components that
   have changed and consists of bits taken from the masks defined
   in Table 10.7 with "ok" in the changed_ctrls column.

   The controls currently enabled in the server are reported in
   the enabled_ctrls field. If any controls were just enabled or
   disabled (that is, the contents of the enabled_ctrls field
   changed), they are flagged in the enabled_ctrl_changes field.
   The valid bits for these fields are the masks listed in Table
   10.7 with "ok" in the enabled_ctrls column. The num_groups
   field reports the number of groups bound to the key belonging
   to the most number of groups and is automatically updated when
   the keyboard mapping changes.

   If the change was caused by a request from a client, the
   keycode and event_type fields are set to zero and the req_major
   and req_minor fields identify the request. The req_major value
   is the same as the major extension opcode. Otherwise,
   event_type is set to the type of event that caused the change
   (one of KeyPress , KeyRelease , DeviceKeyPress ,
   DeviceKeyRelease , ButtonPress or ButtonRelease ), and
   req_major and req_minor are undefined. If event_type is
   KeyPress , KeyRelease , DeviceKeyPress , or DeviceKeyRelease ,
   the keycode field is set to the key that caused the change. If
   event_type is ButtonPress or ButtonRelease , keycode contains
   the button number.

   When a client receives an XkbControlsNotify event, it can note
   the changes in a changes structure using XkbNoteControlsChanges
   .
   void XkbNoteControlsChanges ( changes , new , wanted )
   XkbControlsChangesPtr changes ; /* records changes indicated by
   new */
   XkbControlsNotifyEvent * new ; /* tells which things have
   changed */
   unsigned int wanted ; /* tells which parts of new to record in
   changes */

   The wanted parameter is a bitwise inclusive OR of bits taken
   from the set of masks specified in Table 10.7 with "ok" in the
   changed_ctrls column. XkbNoteControlsChanges copies any changes
   reported in new and specified in wanted into the changes record
   specified by old .

   Use XkbGetControlsChanges to update a local copy of a keyboard
   description with the changes previously noted by one or more
   calls to XkbNoteControlsChanges.
   Status XkbGetControlsChanges ( dpy , xkb , changes )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* xkb->ctrls will be updated */
   XkbNameChangesPtr changes ; /* indicates which parts of
   xkb->ctrls to update */

   XkbGetControlsChanges examines the changes parameter, queries
   the server for the necessary information, and copies the
   results into the xkb -> ctrls keyboard description. If the
   ctrls field of xkb is NULL , XkbGetControlsChanges allocates
   and initializes it. To free the ctrls field, use
   XkbFreeControls (see section 10.12).

   XkbGetControlsChanges returns Success if successful and can
   generate BadAlloc , BadImplementation, and BadMatch errors.

Allocating and Freeing an XkbControlsRec

   The need to allocate an XkbControlsRec structure seldom arises;
   Xkb creates one when an application calls XkbGetControls or a
   related function. For those situations where there is not an
   XkbControlsRec structure allocated in the XkbDescRec , allocate
   one by calling XkbAllocControls .
   Status XkbAllocControls ( xkb, which )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description in which to allocate ctrls
   rec */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of components of ctrls to allocate
   */

   XkbAllocControls allocates the ctrls field of the xkb
   parameter, initializes all fields to zero, and returns Success
   . If the ctrls field is not NULL , XkbAllocControls simply
   returns Success . If xkb is NULL , XkbAllocControls reports a
   BadMatch error. If the ctrls field could not be allocated, it
   reports a BadAlloc error.

   The which mask specifies the individual fields of the ctrls
   structure to be allocated and can contain any of the valid
   masks defined in Table 10.7. Because none of the currently
   existing controls have any structures associated with them,
   which is currently of little practical value in this call.

   To free memory used by the ctrls member of an XkbDescRec
   structure, use XkbFreeControls:
   void XkbFreeControls ( xkb, which, free_all )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description in which to free controls
   components */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of components of ctrls to free */
   Bool free_all ; /* True => free everything + ctrls itself */

   XkbFreeControls frees the specified components of the ctrls
   field in the xkb keyboard description and sets the
   corresponding structure component values to NULL or zero . The
   which mask specifies the fields of ctrls to be freed and can
   contain any of the controls components specified in Table 10.7.

   If free_all is True , XkbFreeControls frees every non- NULL
   structure component in the controls, frees the XkbControlsRec
   structure referenced by the ctrls member of xkb , and sets
   ctrls to NULL.

The Miscellaneous Per-client Controls

   You can configure the boolean per-client controls which affect
   the state reported in button and key events. See section
   12.1.1, 12.3, 12.5, and 16.3.11 of the XKB Protocol
   specification for more details.

   To get the current values of the per-client controls, use
   XkbGetPerClientControls .
   Bool XkbGetPerClientControls ( dpy , ctrls )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int * ctrls ; /* 1 bit => corresponding control is on
   */

   XkbGetPerClientControls backfills ctrls with the per-client
   control attributes for this particular client. It returns True
   if successful, and False otherwise.

   To change the current values of the per-client control
   attributes, use XkbSetPerClientControls.
   Bool XkbSetPerClientControls ( dpy , ctrls )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int change ; /* 1 bit => change control */
   unsigned int * value ; /* 1 bit => control on */

   XkbSetPerClientControls changes the per-client values for the
   controls selected by change to the corresponding value in
   value. Legal values for change and value are:
   XkbPCF_GrabsUseXKBStateMask, XkbPCF_LookupStateWhenGrabbed, and
   XkbPCF_SendEventUsesXKBState. More than one control may be
   changed at one time by OR-ing the values together.
   XkbSetPerClientControls backfills value with the per-client
   control attributes for this particular client. It returns True
   if successful, and False otherwise.
   __________________________________________________________

   ^[4] AccessDOS provides access to the DOS operating system for
   people with physical impairments and was developed by the Trace
   R&D Center at the University of Wisconsin. For more information
   on AccessDOS, contact the Trace R&D Center, Waisman Center and
   Department of Industrial Engineering, University of
   Wisconsin-Madison WI 53705-2280. Phone: 608-262-6966. e-mail:
   info@trace.wisc.edu.

Chapter 11. X Library Controls

   Table of Contents

   Controls Affecting Keycode-to-String Translation

        ForceLatin1Lookup
        ConsumeLookupMods
        AlwaysConsumeShiftAndLock

   Controls Affecting Compose Processing

        ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail
        ComposeLED
        BeepOnComposeFail

   Controls Effecting Event Delivery

        IgnoreNewKeyboards

   Manipulating the Library Controls

        Determining Which Library Controls are Implemented
        Determining the State of the Library Controls
        Changing the State of the Library Controls

   The Xkb extension is composed of two parts: a server extension,
   and a client-side X library extension. Chapter 10 discusses
   functions used to modify controls affecting the behavior of the
   server portion of the Xkb extension. This chapter discusses
   functions used to modify controls that affect only the behavior
   of the client portion of the extension; these controls are
   known as Library Controls.

   All of the Library Controls are boolean flags that may be
   enabled and disabled. The controls can be divided into several
   categories:
     * Controls affecting general string lookups
     * Controls affecting compose processing
     * Controls affecting event delivery

   There are two types of string lookups performed by
   XLookupString . The first type involves translating a single
   keycode into a string; the controls in the first category
   affect this type of lookup. The second type involves
   translating a series of keysyms into a string; the controls in
   the second category affect this type of lookup.

   An Xkb implementation is required to support the programming
   interface for all of the controls. However, an implementation
   may choose not to support the semantics associated with the
   controls that deal with compose processing. In this case, a
   program that accesses these controls should still function
   normally; however, the feedback that would normally occur with
   the controls enabled may be missing.

Controls Affecting Keycode-to-String Translation

   The first type of string lookups, which are here called simple
   string lookups , involves translating a single keycode into a
   string. Because these simple lookups involve only a single
   keycode, all of the information needed to do the translation is
   contained in the keyboard state in a single event. The controls
   affecting simple string lookups are:
     ForceLatin1Lookup
     ConsumeLookupMods
     LevelOneUsesShiftAndLock

ForceLatin1Lookup

   If the ForceLatin1Lookup control is enabled, XLookupString only
   returns strings using the Latin1 character set. If
   ForceLatin1Lookup is not enabled, XLookupString can return
   characters that are not in the Latin1 set. By default, this
   control is disabled, allowing characters outside of the Latin1
   set to be returned.

ConsumeLookupMods

   Simple string lookups in XLookupString involve two different
   translation phases. The first phase translates raw device
   keycodes to individual keysyms. The second phase attempts to
   map the resulting keysym into a string of one or more
   characters. In the first phase, some of the modifiers are
   normally used to determine the appropriate shift level for a
   key.

   The ConsumeLookupMods control determines whether or not
   XLookupString consumes the modifiers it uses during the first
   phase of processing (mapping a keycode to a keysym). When a
   modifier is consumed, it is effectively removed from the
   working copy of the keyboard state information XLookupString is
   using and appears to be unset for the remainder of the
   processing.

   If the ConsumeLookupMods control is enabled, XLookupString does
   not use the modifiers used to translate the keycode of the
   event to a keysym when it is determining the string associated
   with a keysym. For example, assume the keymap for the `A' key
   only contains the shift modifier and the ConsumeLookupMods
   control is enabled. If a user presses the Shift key and the A
   key while the Num_Lock key is locked, XLookupString uses the
   Shift modifier when mapping the keycode for the `a' key to the
   keysym for `A'; subsequently, it only uses the NumLock modifier
   when determining the string associated with the keysym `A'.

   If the ConsumeLookupMods control is not enabled, XLookupString
   uses all of the event modifiers to determine the string
   associated with a keysym. This behavior mirrors the behavior of
   XLookupString in the core implementation.

   The ConsumeLookupMods control is unset by default. For more
   information on modifier consumption, refer to Chapter 12.

AlwaysConsumeShiftAndLock

   The AlwaysConsumeShiftAndLock control, if enabled, forces
   XLookupString to consume the Shift and Lock modifiers when
   processing all keys, even if the definition for the key type
   does not specify these modifiers. The AlwaysConsumeShiftAndLock
   control is unset by default. See section 15.2 for a discussion
   of key types.

Controls Affecting Compose Processing

   The second type of string lookup performed by XLookupString
   involves translating a series of keysyms into a string. Because
   these lookups can involve more than one key event, they require
   XLookupString to retain some state information between
   successive calls. The process of mapping a series of keysyms to
   a string is known as compose processing . The controls
   affecting compose processing are:
ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail
ComposeLED
BeepOnComposeFail

   Because different vendors have historically used different
   algorithms to implement compose processing, and these
   algorithms may be incompatible with the semantics required by
   the Xkb compose processing controls, implementation of the
   compose processing controls is optional in an Xkb
   implementation.

ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail

   Some compose processing algorithms signal the start of a
   compose sequence by a key event meaning "start compose". ^[5]
   The subsequent key events should normally result in a valid
   composition yielding a valid translation to a string. If the
   subsequent key events do not have a valid translation, some
   decision must be made about what to do with the key events that
   were processed while attempting the compose. The
   ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail control allows a client to specify
   what happens with the key events XLookupString has been
   considering when it reaches a dead end in a compose sequence.

   If the ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail control is set, all keys
   associated with a failed compose sequence should be consumed
   (discarded). If the ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail control is not
   set, the key events associated with a failed compose sequence
   should be processed as a normal sequence of key events.

   The ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail control is disabled by default.

ComposeLED

   The ComposeLED control allows a client to specify whether or
   not an indicator should be set and cleared to provide feedback
   when compose processing is in progress. The control does not
   specify which indicator should be used; the mapping for this is
   up to the individual implementation. If the ComposeLED control
   is enabled, it specifies that an indicator should be set when a
   compose sequence is in progress and cleared when one is not in
   progress. The ComposeLED control is disabled by default.

   While the Xkb extension does not specify the type of type of
   indicator to be used when the ComposeLED control is
   implemented, a consistent convention between implementations is
   to everyone's benefit. If a named indicator is used for this
   purpose, the recommended name is " Compose ". Note that some
   implementations may use an unnamed, custom hardware LED for
   this purpose.

BeepOnComposeFail

   The BeepOnComposeFail control allows a client to specify
   whether or not a bell should be activated to provide feedback
   when a compose sequence fails. The control does not specify the
   type of bell that should be used; the mapping for this is up to
   the individual implementation. If the BeepOnComposeFail control
   is enabled, it specifies that a bell should be activated when a
   compose sequence fails. The BeepOnComposeFail control is
   disabled by default. If implemented, the bell should be
   activated using XkbBell or XkbDeviceBell .

   While the Xkb extension does not specify the type of bell to be
   used when the BeepOnComposeFail control is implemented, a
   consistent convention between implementations is to everyone's
   benefit. If a named bell is used for this purpose, the
   recommended name is " ComposeFail ".

Controls Effecting Event Delivery

IgnoreNewKeyboards

   When Xkb is initialized, it implicitly forces requests for
   NewKeyboardNotify events. These events may be used by the Xkb
   library extension internally; they are normally translated into
   core protocol MappingNotify events before being passed to the
   client. While delivering the event to the client is appropriate
   in most cases, it is not appropriate for some clients that
   maintain per-key data structures. This is because once the
   server has sent a NewKeyboardNotify event, it is free to send
   the client events for all keys in the new range and that range
   may be outside of the per-key data structures the client is
   maintaining.

   The IgnoreNewKeyboards control, if enabled, prevents Xkb from
   mapping NewKeyboardNotify events to core MappingNotify events
   and passing them to the client. The control is initially
   disabled.

Manipulating the Library Controls

   The Library Controls are manipulated using functions that deal
   with bitmasks to indicate which controls to manipulate. The
   controls are identified by the masks defined in Table 11.1.

   Table 11.1. Library Control Masks
   Library Control Mask            Value
   XkbLC_ForceLatin1Lookup         (1 << 0)
   XkbLC_ConsumeLookupMods         (1 << 1)
   XkbLC_AlwaysConsumeShiftAndLock (1 << 2)
   XkbLC_IgnoreNewKeyboards        (1 << 3)
   XkbLC_ConsumeKeysOnComposeFail  (1 << 29)
   XkbLC_ComposeLED                (1 << 30)
   XkbLC_BeepOnComposeFail         (1 << 31)
   XkbLC_AllControls               (0xc0000007)

Determining Which Library Controls are Implemented

   To determine which Library Controls are actually implemented,
   use XkbXlibControlsImplemented.
   unsigned int XkbXlibControlsImplemented ( display )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */

   XkbXlibControlsImplemented returns a bitmask indicating the
   controls actually implemented in the Xkb library and is
   composed of an inclusive OR of bits from Table 11.1.

Determining the State of the Library Controls

   To determine the current state of the Library Controls, use
   XkbGetXlibControls .
   unsigned int XkbGetXlibControls ( display )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */

   XkbGetXlibControls returns the current state of the Library
   Controls as a bit mask that is an inclusive OR of the control
   masks from Table 11.1 for the controls that are enabled. For
   the optional compose processing controls, the fact that a
   control is enabled does not imply that it is actually
   implemented.

Changing the State of the Library Controls

   To change the state of the Library Controls, use
   XkbSetXlibControls.
   Bool XkbSetXlibControls ( display, bits_to_change,
   values_for_bits )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned long bits_to_change ; /* selects controls to be
   modified */
   unsigned long values_for_bits ; /* turns selected controls on
   (1) or off (0) */

   XkbSetXlibControls modifies the state of the controls selected
   by bits_to_change ; only the controls selected by
   bits_to_change are modified. If the bit corresponding to a
   control is on in bits_to_change and also on in values_for_bits,
   the control is enabled. If the bit corresponding to a control
   is on in bits_to_change but off in values_for_bits , the
   control is disabled. bits_to_change should be an inclusive OR
   of bits from Table 11.1.
   __________________________________________________________

   ^[5] Another possibility is to have the compose processing
   simply be the result of a finite state acceptor; a compose
   sequence would never fail for a properly written finite state
   acceptor.

Chapter 12. Interpreting Key Events

   Table of Contents

   Effects of Xkb on the Core X Library

        Effects of Xkb on Event State
        Effects of Xkb on MappingNotify Events
        X Library Functions Affected by Xkb

   Xkb Event and Keymap Functions

   Xkb provides functions to help developers interpret key events
   without having to directly interpret Xkb data structures. Xkb
   also modifies the behavior of several core X library functions.

Effects of Xkb on the Core X Library

   When support for Xkb is built into the X library, the
   XOpenDisplay function looks for a compatible version of Xkb on
   the server. If it finds a compatible version, it initializes
   the extension and enables implicit support for Xkb in a number
   of X library functions. This makes it possible for clients to
   take advantage of nearly all Xkb features without having to be
   rewritten or even recompiled, if they are built with shared
   libraries. This implicit support is invisible to most clients,
   but it can have side effects, so the extension includes ways to
   control or disable it.

Effects of Xkb on Event State

   Because XOpenDisplay initializes Xkb, some events contain an
   Xkb description of the keyboard state instead of that normally
   used by the core protocol. See section 17.1.1 for more
   information about the differences between Xkb keyboard state
   and that reported by the core protocol.

Effects of Xkb on MappingNotify Events

   When Xkb is missing or disabled, the X library tracks changes
   to the keyboard mapping using MappingNotify events. Whenever
   the keyboard mapping is changed, the server sends all clients a
   MappingNotify event to report the change. When a client
   receives a MappingNotify event, it is supposed to call
   XRefreshKeyboardMapping to update the keyboard description used
   internally by the X library.

   The X Keyboard Extension uses XkbMapNotify and
   XkbNewKeyboardNotify events to track changes to the keyboard
   mapping. When an Xkb-aware client receives either event, it
   should call XkbRefreshKeyboardMapping to update the keyboard
   description used internally by the X library. To avoid
   duplicate events, the X server does not send core protocol
   MappingNotify events to a client that has selected for
   XkbMapNotify events.

   The implicit support for Xkb selects for XkbMapNotify events.
   This means that clients that do not explicitly use Xkb but that
   are using a version of the X library that has implicit support
   for Xkb do not receive MappingNotify events over the wire.
   Clients that were not written with Xkb in mind do not recognize
   or properly handle the new Xkb events, so the implicit support
   converts them to MappingNotify events that report approximately
   the same information, unless the client has explicitly selected
   for the Xkb version of the event.

   An Xkb-capable X server does not send events from keys that
   fall outside the legal range of keycodes expected by that
   client. Once the server sends a client an XkbNewKeyboardNotify
   event, it reports events from all keys because it assumes that
   any client that has receieved an XkbNewKeyboardNotify event
   expects key events from the new range of keycodes. The implicit
   support for Xkb asks for XkbNewKeyboardNotify events, so the
   range of keycodes reported to the client might vary without the
   client's knowledge. Most clients don't really care about the
   range of legal keycodes, but some clients maintain information
   about each key and might have problems with events that come
   from unexpected keys. Such clients can set the
   XkbLC_IgnoreNewKeyboards library control (see section 11.3.1)
   to prevent the implicit support from requesting notification of
   changes to the legal range of keycodes.

X Library Functions Affected by Xkb

   The following X library functions are modified by Xkb:
     XKeycodeToKeysym
     XKeysymToKeycode
     XLookupKeysym
     XLookupString
     XRefreshKeyboardMapping
     XRebindKeysym

   The implicit support for Xkb replaces a number of X library
   functions with versions that understand and use the X Keyboard
   Extension. In most cases, the semantics of the new versions are
   identical to those of the old, but there are occasional visible
   differences. This section lists all of the functions that are
   affected and the differences in behavior, if any, that are
   visible to clients.

   The XKeycodeToKeysym function reports the keysym associated
   with a particular index for a single key. The index specifies a
   column of symbols in the core keyboard mapping (that is, as
   reported by the core protocol GetKeyboardMapping request). The
   order of the symbols in the core mapping does not necessarily
   correspond to the order of the symbols used by Xkb; section
   17.1.3 describes the differences.

   The XKeysymToKeycode function reports a keycode to which a
   particular keysym is bound. When Xkb is missing or disabled,
   this function looks in each column of the core keyboard mapping
   in turn and returns the lowest numbered key that matches in the
   lowest numbered group. When Xkb is present, this function uses
   the Xkb ordering for symbols instead.

   The XLookupKeysym function reports the symbol in a specific
   column of the key associated with an event. Whether or not Xkb
   is present, the column specifies an index into the core symbol
   mapping.

   The XLookupString function reports the symbol and string
   associated with a key event, taking into account the keycode
   and keyboard state as reported in the event. When Xkb is
   disabled or missing, XLookupString uses the rules specified by
   the core protocol and reports only ISO Latin-1 characters. When
   Xkb is present, XLookupString uses the explicit keyboard group,
   key types, and rules specified by Xkb. When Xkb is present,
   XLookupString is allowed, but not required, to return strings
   in character sets other than ISO Latin-1, depending on the
   current locale. If any key bindings are defined, XLookupString
   does not use any consumed modifiers (see sections 11.1.2 and
   15.2) to determine matching bindings.

   The XRefreshKeyboardMapping function updates the X library's
   internal representation of the keyboard to reflect changes
   reported via MappingNotify events. When Xkb is missing or
   disabled, this function reloads the entire modifier map or
   keyboard mapping. When Xkb is present, the implicit Xkb support
   keeps track of the changed components reported by each
   XkbMapNotify event and updates only those pieces of the
   keyboard description that have changed. If the implicit support
   has not noted any keyboard mapping changes,
   XRefreshKeyboardMapping updates the entire keyboard
   description.

   The XRebindKeysym function associates a string with a keysym
   and a set of modifiers. Xkb does not directly change this
   function, but it does affect the way that the state reported in
   the event is compared to the state specified to XRebindKeysym .
   When Xkb is missing or disabled, XLookupString returns the
   specified string if the modifiers in the event exactly match
   the modifiers from this call. When Xkb is present, any
   modifiers used to determine the keysym are consumed and are not
   used to look up the string.

Xkb Event and Keymap Functions

   To find the keysym bound to a particular key at a specified
   group and shift level, use XkbKeycodeToKeysym.
   KeySym XkbKeycodeToKeysym ( dpy, kc, group, level )
   Display * dpy; /* connection to X server */
   KeyCode kc; /* key of interest */
   unsigned int group; /* group of interest */
   unsigned int level; /* shift level of interest */

   XkbKeycodeToKeysym returns the keysym bound to a particular
   group and shift level for a particular key on the core
   keyboard. If kc is not a legal keycode for the core keyboard,
   or if group or level are out of range for the specified key,
   XkbKeycodeToKeysym returns NoSymbol .

   To find the set of modifiers bound to a particular keysym on
   the core keyboard, use XkbKeysymToModifiers .
   unsigned int XkbKeysymToModifiers ( dpy , ks )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   KeySym ks ; /* keysym of interest */

   XkbKeysymToModifiers finds the set of modifiers currently bound
   to the keysym ks on the core keyboard. The value returned is
   the mask of modifiers bound to the keysym ks . If no modifiers
   are bound to the keysym, XkbKeysymToModifiers returns zero;
   otherwise, it returns the inclusive OR of zero or more of the
   following: ShiftMask , ControlMask , LockMask , Mod1Mask ,
   Mod2Mask , Mod3Mask , Mod4Mask, and Mod5Mask .

   Use XkbLookupKeySym to find the symbol associated with a key
   for a particular state.
   Bool XkbLookupKeySym ( dpy , key , state , mods_rtrn , sym_rtrn
   )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   KeyCode key ; /* key for which symbols are to be found */
   unsigned int state ; /* state for which symbol should be found
   */
   unsigned int * mods_rtrn ; /* backfilled with unconsumed
   modifiers */
   KeySym * sym_rtrn ; /* backfilled with symbol associated with
   key + state */

   XkbLookupKeySym is the equivalent of the core XLookupKeySym
   function. For the core keyboard, given a keycode key and an Xkb
   state state , XkbLookupKeySym returns the symbol associated
   with the key in sym_rtrn and the list of modifiers that should
   still be applied in mods_rtrn . The state parameter is the
   state from a KeyPress or KeyRelease event. XkbLookupKeySym
   returns True if it succeeds.

   Use XkbLookupKeyBinding to find the string bound to a key by
   XRebindKeySym . XkbLookupKeyBinding is the equivalent of the
   core XLookupString function.
   int XkbLookupKeyBinding ( dpy , sym , state , buf , nbytes ,
   extra_rtrn )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to server */
   KeySym sym ; /* symbol to be looked up */
   unsigned int state ; /* state for which string is to be looked
   up */
   char * buf ; /* buffer into which returned string is written */
   int nbytes ; /* size of buffer in bytes */
   int * extra_rtrn ; /* backfilled with number bytes overflow */

   XRebindKeysym binds an ASCII string to a specified keysym, so
   that the string and keysym are returned when the key is pressed
   and a specified list of modifiers are also being held down.
   XkbLookupKeyBinding returns in buf the string associated with
   the keysym sym and modifier state state . buf is NULL
   terminated unless there's an overflow. If the string returned
   is larger than nbytes , a count of bytes that does not fit into
   the buffer is returned in extra_rtrn. XkbTranslateKeySym
   returns the number of bytes that it placed into buf .

   To find the string and symbol associated with a keysym for a
   given keyboard state, use XkbTranslateKeySym .
   int XkbTranslateKeySym ( dpy , sym_inout , mods , buf , nbytes
   , extra_rtrn )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   KeySym * sym_inout ; /* symbol to be translated; result of
   translation */
   unsigned int mods ; /* modifiers to apply to sym_inout */
   char * buf ; /* buffer into which returned string is written */
   int nbytes ; /* size of buffer in bytes */
   int * extra_rtrn ; /* number of bytes overflow*/

   XkbTranslateKeySym applies the transformations specified in
   mods to the symbol specified by sym_inout . It returns in buf
   the string, if any, associated with the keysym for the current
   locale. If the transformations in mods changes the keysym,
   sym_inout is updated accordingly. If the string returned is
   larger than nbytes , a count of bytes that does not fit into
   the buffer is returned in extra_rtrn. XkbTranslateKeySym
   returns the number of bytes it placed into buf .

   To update the keyboard description that is internal to the X
   library, use XkbRefreshKeyboardMapping .
   Status XkbRefreshKeyboardMapping ( event)
   XkbMapNotifyEvent * event ; /* event initiating remapping */

   XkbRefreshKeyboardMapping is the Xkb equivalent of the core
   XRefreshKeyboardMapping function. It requests that the X server
   send the current key mapping information to this client. A
   client usually invokes XkbRefreshKeyboardMapping after
   receiving an XkbMapNotify event. XkbRefreshKeyboardMapping
   returns Success if it succeeds and BadMatch if the event is not
   an Xkb event.

   The XkbMapNotify event can be generated when some client calls
   XkbSetMap , XkbChangeMap , XkbGetKeyboardByName , or any of the
   standard X library functions that change the keyboard mapping
   or modifier mapping.

   To translate a keycode to a key symbol and modifiers, use
   XkbTranslateKeyCode .
   Booll XkbTranslateKeyCode ( xkb, key, mods, mods_rtrn,
   keysym_rtrn)
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to use for translation
   */
   KeyCode key ; /* keycode to translate */
   unsigned int mods ; /* modifiers to apply when translating key
   */
   unsigned int * mods_rtrn ; /* backfilled with unconsumed
   modifiers */
   KeySym * keysym_rtrn ; /* keysym resulting from translation */

   mods_rtrn is backfilled with the modifiers consumed by the
   translation process. mods is a bitwise inclusive OR of the
   legal modifier masks: ShiftMask , LockMask , ControlMask ,
   Mod1Mask , Mod2Mask , Mod3Mask , Mod4Mask , Mod5Mask .The
   AlwaysConsumeShiftAndLock library control (see section 11.1.3),
   if enabled, causes XkbTranslateKeyCode to consume shift and
   lock. XkbTranslateKeyCode returns True if the translation
   resulted in a keysym, and False if it resulted in NoSymbol .

Chapter 13. Keyboard Geometry

   Table of Contents

   Shapes and Outlines
   Sections
   Rows and Keys
   Doodads
   Overlay Rows and Overlay Keys
   Drawing a Keyboard Representation
   Geometry Data Structures

        DoodadRec Structures

   Getting Keyboard Geometry From the Server
   Using Keyboard Geometry
   Adding Elements to a Keyboard Geometry
   Allocating and Freeing Geometry Components

   The Xkb description of a keyboard includes an optional keyboard
   geometry that describes the physical appearance of the
   keyboard. Keyboard geometry describes the shape, location, and
   color of all keyboard keys or other visible keyboard components
   such as indicators. The information contained in a keyboard
   geometry is sufficient to allow a client program to draw an
   accurate two-dimensional image of the keyboard.

   You can retrieve a keyboard geometry from an X server that
   supports Xkb, or you can allocate it from scratch and
   initialize it in a client program. The keyboard geometry need
   not have any correspondence with the physical keyboard that is
   connected to the X server.

   Geometry measurements are specified in mm/10 units. The origin
   (0,0) is in the top left corner of the keyboard image. A
   component's own origin is also its upper left corner. In some
   cases a component needs to be drawn rotated. For example, a
   special keyboard may have a section of keys arranged in rows in
   a rectangular area, but the entire rectangle may not be in
   alignment with the rest of the keyboard, and instead, it is
   rotated from horizontal by 30 o . Rotation for a geometry
   object is specified in 1/10 o increments about its origin. An
   example of a keyboard with rotated sections is shown in Figure
   13.1.
   Rotated Keyboard Sections

   Some geometry components include a priority , which indicates
   the order in which overlapping objects should be drawn. Objects
   should be drawn in order from highest priority (0) to lowest
   (255).

   The keyboard geometry's top-level description is stored in a
   XkbGeometryRec structure. This structure contains three types
   of information:
    1. Lists of items, not used to draw the basic keyboard, but
       indexed by the geometry descriptions that comprise the
       entire keyboard geometry (colors, geometry properties, key
       aliases, shapes)
    2. A number of singleton items that describe the keyboard as a
       whole (keyboard name, width and height, a color for the
       keyboard as a whole, and a color for keyboard key labels)
    3. A list of the keyboard's sections and nonkey doodads

   The top-level geometry is described in more detail in the
   following.

   The lists of items used by components of the keyboard geometry
   description is as follows:
     * The top-level keyboard geometry description includes a list
       of up to MaxColors (32) color names . A color name is a
       string whose interpretation is not specified by Xkb. The
       XkbColorRec structure provides a field for this name as
       well as a pixel field. The pixel field is a convenient
       place for an application to store a pixel value or color
       definition, if it needs to. All other geometry data
       structures refer to colors using their indices in this
       global list.
     * The top-level keyboard geometry description includes a list
       of geometry properties . A geometry property associates an
       arbitrary string with an equally arbitrary name. Geometry
       properties can be used to provide hints to programs that
       display images of keyboards, but they are not interpreted
       by Xkb. No other geometry structures refer to geometry
       properties. As an example of a possible use of properties ,
       consider the pause/break key on most PC keyboards: the
       "break" symbol is usually on the front of the key and is
       often a different color. A program might set a property to:
       LBL_PAUS = "{Pause/top/black,Break/front/red}"
       and use the property information to draw the key with a
       front label as well as a top label.
     * The top-level keyboard geometry description includes a list
       of key aliases (see Chapter 18). Key aliases allow the
       keyboard layout designer to assign multiple key names to a
       single key.

Note
       Key aliases defined in the geometry component of a keyboard
       mapping override those defined in the keycodes component of
       the server database, which are stored in the XkbNamesRec (
       xkb->names ). Therefore, consider the key aliases defined
       by the geometry before considering key aliases supplied by
       the keycodes.
     * The top-level keyboard geometry description includes a list
       of shapes ; other keyboard components refer to shapes by
       their index in this list. A shape consists of an arbitrary
       name of type Atom and one or more closed-polygon outlines .
       All points in an outline are specified relative to the
       origin of its enclosing shape, that is, whichever shape
       that contains this outline in its list of outlines. One
       outline is the primary outline. The primary outline is by
       default the first outline, or it can be optionally
       specified by the primary field in the XkbShapeRec
       structure. A keyboard display application can generate a
       simpler but still accurate keyboard image by displaying
       only the primary outlines for each shape. Nonrectangular
       keys must include a rectangular approximation as one of the
       outlines associated with the shape. The approximation is
       not normally displayed but can be used by very simple
       keyboard display applications to generate a recognizable
       but degraded image of the keyboard.

   The XkbGeometryRec top-level geometry description contains the
   following information that pertains to the keyboard as a whole:
     * A keyboard symbolic name of type Atom to help users
       identify the keyboard.
     * The width and height of the keyboard, in mm/10. For
       nonrectangular keyboards, the width and height describe the
       smallest bounding box that encloses the outline of the
       keyboard.
     * The base color of the keyboard is the predominant color on
       the keyboard and is used as the default color for any
       components whose color is not explicitly specified.
     * The label color is the color used to draw the labels on
       most of the keyboard keys.
     * The label font is a string that describes the font used to
       draw labels on most keys; label fonts are arbitrary
       strings, because Xkb does not specify the format or name
       space for font names.

   The keyboard is subdivided into named sections of related keys
   and doodads. The sections and doodads on the keyboard are
   listed in the XkbGeometryRec top-level keyboard geometry
   description. A section is composed of keys that are physically
   together and logically related. Figure 13.2 shows a keyboard
   that is divided into four sections. A doodad describes some
   visible aspect of the keyboard that is not a key and is not a
   section.
   Keyboard with Four Sections

Shapes and Outlines

   A shape , used to draw keyboard components and stored in a
   XkbShapeRec structure, has:
     * An arbitrary name of type Atom.
     * Bounds (two x and y coordinates) that describe the corners
       of a rectangle containing the shape's top surface outline.
     * A list of one or more outlines (described below).
     * Optional pointers to a primary and an approximation outline
       (described below). If either of these pointers is NULL ,
       the default primary/approximation outline is the first one
       in the list of outlines for the shape.

   An outline , stored in a XkbOutlineRec structure, is a list of
   one or more points that describes a single closed-polygon, as
   follows:
     * A list with a single point describes a rectangle with one
       corner at the origin of the shape (0,0) and the opposite
       corner at the specified point.
     * A list of two points describes a rectangle with one corner
       at the position specified by the first point and the
       opposite corner at the position specified by the second
       point.
     * A list of three or more points describes an arbitrary
       polygon. If necessary, the polygon is automatically closed
       by connecting the last point in the list with the first.
     * A nonzero value for the corner_radius field specifies that
       the corners of the polygon should be drawn as circles with
       the specified radius.

   All points in an outline are specified relative to the origin
   of the enclosing shape. Points in an outline may have negative
   values for the X and Y coordinate.

   One outline is the primary outline; a keyboard display
   application can generate a simple but still accurate keyboard
   image by displaying only the primary outlines for each shape.
   The default primary outline is the first in a shape's list of
   outlines. If the primary field of the XkbShapeRec structure is
   not NULL , it points to the primary outline. A rectangular
   approximation must be included for nonrectangular keys as one
   of the outlines associated with the shape; the approximation is
   not normally displayed but can be used by very simple keyboard
   display applications to generate a recognizable but degraded
   image of the keyboard.

Sections

   As previously noted, a keyboard is subdivided into sections of
   related keys. Each section has its own coordinate system -- if
   a section is rotated, the coordinates of any components within
   the section are interpreted relative to the edges that were on
   the top and left before rotation. The components that make up a
   section, stored in a XkbSectionRec , include:
     * An arbitrary name of type Atom.
     * A priority, to indicate drawing order. 0 is the highest
       priority, 255 the lowest.
     * Origin of the section, relative to the origin of the
       keyboard.
     * The width and height and the angle of rotation.
     * A list of rows . A row is a list of horizontally or
       vertically adjacent keys. Horizontal rows parallel the
       (prerotation) top of the section, and vertical rows
       parallel the (prerotation) left of the section. All keys in
       a horizontal row share a common top coordinate; all keys in
       a vertical row share a left coordinate. Figure 13.3 shows
       the alpha section from the keyboard shown in Figure 13.2,
       divided into rows. Rows and keys are defined below.

   Rows in a Section
     * An optional list of doodads ; any type of doodad can be
       enclosed within a section. Position and angle of rotation
       are relative to the origin and angle of rotation of the
       sections that contain them. Priority for doodads in a
       section is relative to the other components of the section,
       not to the keyboard as a whole.
     * An optional overlay with a name of type Atom and a list of
       overlay rows (described below).
     * Bounds (two x and y coordinates) that describe the corners
       of a rectangle containing the entire section.

Rows and Keys

   A row description ( XkbRowRec ) consists of the coordinates of
   its origin relative to its enclosing section, a flag indicating
   whether the row is horizontal or vertical, and a list of keys
   in the row.

   A key description ( XkbKeyRec ) consists of a key name, a
   shape, a key color, and a gap. The key name should correspond
   to one of the keys named in the keyboard names description, the
   shape specifies the appearance of the key, and the key color
   specifies the color of the key (not the label on the key; the
   label color is stored in the XkbGeometryRec ). Keys are
   normally drawn immediately adjacent to one another from left to
   right (or top to bottom) within a row. The gap field specifies
   the distance between a key and its predecessor.

Doodads

   Doodads can be global to the keyboard or part of a section.
   Doodads have symbolic names of arbitrary length. The only
   doodad name whose interpretation is specified by Xkb is
   "Edges", which, if present, describes the outline of the entire
   keyboard.

   Each doodad's origin is stored in fields named left and top ,
   which are the coordinates of the doodad's origin relative to
   its enclosing object, whether it be a section or the top-level
   keyboard. The priority for doodads that are listed in the
   top-level geometry is relative to the other doodads listed in
   the top-level geometry and the sections listed in the top-level
   geometry. The priority for doodads listed in a section are
   relative to the other components of the section. Each doodad is
   stored in a structure with a type field, which specifies the
   type of doodad.

   Xkb supports five types of doodads:
     * An indicator doodad describes one of the physical keyboard
       indicators. Indicator doodads specify the shape of the
       indicator, the indicator color when it is lit ( on_color )
       and the indicator color when it is dark ( off_color ).
     * An outline doodad describes some aspect of the keyboard to
       be drawn as one or more hollow, closed polygons. Outline
       doodads specify the shape, color, and angle of rotation
       about the doodad origin at which they should be drawn.
     * A solid doodad describes some aspect of the keyboard to be
       drawn as one or more filled polygons. Solid doodads specify
       the shape, color, and angle of rotation about the doodad
       origin at which they should be drawn.
     * A text doodad describes a text label somewhere on the
       keyboard. Text doodads specify the label string, the font
       and color to use when drawing the label, and the angle of
       rotation of the doodad about its origin.
     * A logo doodad is a catch-all, which describes some other
       visible element of the keyboard. A logo doodad is
       essentially an outline doodad with an additional symbolic
       name that describes the element to be drawn. If a keyboard
       display program recognizes the symbolic name, it can draw
       something appropriate within the bounding region of the
       shape specified in the doodad. If the symbolic name does
       not describe a recognizable image, it should draw an
       outline using the specified shape, outline, and angle of
       rotation. The Xkb extension does not specify the
       interpretation of logo names.

   The structures these doodads are stored in and the values of
   the type fields are shown in Table 13.1.

   Table 13.1. Doodad Types
   Doodad           Structure             Type
   indicator doodad XkbIndicatorDoodadRec XkbIndicatorDoodad
   outline doodad   XkbShapeDoodadRec     XkbOutlineDoodad
   solid doodad     XkbShapeDoodadRec     XkbSolidDoodad
   text doodad      XkbTextDoodadRec      XkbTextDoodad
   logo doodad      XkbLogoDoodadRec      XkbLogoDoodad

Overlay Rows and Overlay Keys

   An overlay row ( XkbOverlayRowRec ) contains a pointer to the
   row it overlays and a list of overlay keys .

   Each overlay key definition ( XkbOverlayKeyRec ) indicates a
   key that can yield multiple keycodes and consists of a field
   named under , which specifies the primary name of the key and a
   field named over , which specifies the name for the key when
   the overlay keycode is selected. The key specified in under
   must be a member of the section that contains the overlay key
   definition, while the key specified in over must not be.

Drawing a Keyboard Representation

   To draw a representation of the keyboard, draw in the following
   order:
     Draw the top-level keyboard as a rectangle, using its width and hei
ght.
     For each component (section or doodad) of the top-level geometry, i
n priority order:
        If component is a section
           For each row, in the order it appears in the section
              Draw keys in the order they appear in the row
           Draw doodads within the section in priority order.
        Else draw doodad

Geometry Data Structures

   In the following figures, a solid arrow denotes a pointer to an
   array of structures or a singleton structure. A dotted arrow
   denotes an index or a pointer into the array.
   Xkb Geometry Data Structures
   Xkb Geometry Data Structures (Doodads)
   Xkb Geometry Data Structures (Overlays)
typedef struct _XkbGeometry {              /* top-level keyboard geometr
y structure */
      Atom                name;            /* keyboard name */
      unsigned short      width_mm;        /* keyboard width in  mm / 10
 */
      unsigned short      height_mm;       /* keyboard height in  mm / 1
0 */
      char *              label_font;      /* font for key labels */
      XkbColorPtr         label_color;     /* color for key labels - poi
nter into colors array */
      XkbColorPtr         base_color;      /* color for basic keyboard -
 pointer into colors array */
      unsigned short      sz_properties;   /* size of properties array *
/
      unsigned short      sz_colors;       /* size of colors array */
      unsigned short      sz_shapes;       /* size of shapes array */
      unsigned short      sz_sections;     /* size of sections array */
      unsigned short      sz_doodads;      /* size of doodads array */
      unsigned short      sz_key_aliases;  /* size of key aliases array
*/
      unsigned short      num_properties;  /* number of properties in th
e properties array */
      unsigned short      num_colors;      /* number of colors in the co
lors array */
      unsigned short      num_shapes;      /* number of shapes in the sh
apes array */
      unsigned short      num_sections;    /* number of sections in the
sections array */
      unsigned short      num_doodads;     /* number of doodads in the d
oodads array */
      unsigned short      num_key_aliases; /* number of key aliases in t
he key */
      XkbPropertyPtr      properties;      /* properties array */
      XkbColorPtr         colors;          /* colors array */
      XkbShapePtr         shapes;          /* shapes array */
      XkbSectionPtr       sections;        /* sections array */
      XkbDoodadPtr        doodads;         /* doodads array */
      XkbKeyAliasPtr      key_aliases;     /* key aliases array */
} XkbGeometryRec*XkbGeometryPtr;

   The doodads array is only for doodads not contained in any of
   the sections that has its own doodads . The key aliases
   contained in the key_aliases array take precedence over any
   defined in the keycodes component of the keyboard description.
typedef struct _XkbProperty {
      char *      name;            /* property name */
      char *      value;           /* property value */
} XkbPropertyRec,*XkbPropertyPtr;

typedef struct _XkbColor {
      unsigned int      pixel;     /* color */
      char *            spec;      /* color name */
} XkbColorRec,*XkbColorPtr;

typedef struct _XkbKeyAliasRec {
      char      real[XkbKeyNameLength];   /* real name of the key */
      char      alias[XkbKeyNameLength];  /* alias for the key */
} XkbKeyAliasRec,*XkbKeyAliasPtr;

typedef struct _XkbPoint {                /* x,y coordinates */
      short      x;
      short      y;
} XkbPointRec, *XkbPointPtr;

typedef struct _XkbOutline {
      unsigned short      num_points;     /* number of points in the out
line */
      unsigned short      sz_points;      /* size of the points array */
      unsigned short      corner_radius;  /* draw corners as circles wit
h this radius */
      XkbPointPtr         points;         /* array of points defining th
e outline */
} XkbOutlineRec, *XkbOutlinePtr;

typedef struct _XkbBounds {
      short      x1,y1;            /* upper left corner of the bounds,
                                      in mm/10 */
       short      x2,y2;            /* lower right corner of the bounds,
 in
                                      mm/10 */
} XkbBoundsRec, *XkbBoundsPtr;

typedef struct _XkbShape {
      Atom              name;           /* shape's name */
      unsigned short    num_outlines;   /* number of outlines for the sh
ape */
      unsigned short    sz_outlines;    /* size of the outlines array */
      XkbOutlinePtr     outlines;       /* array of outlines for the sha
pe */
      XkbOutlinePtr     approx;         /* pointer into the array to the
 approximating outline */
      XkbOutlinePtr     primary;        /* pointer into the array to the
 primary outline */
      XkbBoundsRec      bounds;         /* bounding box for the shape; e
ncompasses all outlines */
} XkbShapeRec, *XkbShapePtr;

   If approx and/or primary is NULL , the default value is used.
   The default primary outline is the first element in the
   outlines array, as is the default approximating outline.
typedef struct _XkbKey {         /* key in a row */
      XkbKeyNameRec    name;     /* key name */
      short            gap;      /* gap in mm/10 from previous key in ro
w */
      unsigned char    shape_ndx;      /* index of shape for key */
      unsigned char    color_ndx;      /* index of color for key body */
} XkbKeyRec, *XkbKeyPtr;

typedef struct _XkbRow {             /* row in a section */
      short               top;       /* top coordinate of row origin, re
lative to section's origin */
      short               left;      /* left coordinate of row origin, r
elative to section's origin */
      unsigned short      num_keys;  /* number of keys in the keys array
 */
      unsigned short      sz_keys;   /* size of the keys array */
      int                 vertical;  /* True =>vertical row,
                                         False =>horizontal row */
      XkbKeyPtr           keys;      /* array of keys in the row*/
      XkbBoundsRec        bounds;    /* bounding box for the row */
} XkbRowRec, *XkbRowPtr;

   top and left are in mm / 10 .
typedef struct _XkbOverlayRec {
      Atom              name;           /* overlay name */
      XkbSectionPtr     section_under;  /* the section under this overla
y */
      unsigned short    num_rows;       /* number of rows in the rows ar
ray */
      unsigned short    sz_rows;        /* size of the rows array */
      XkbOverlayRowPtr  rows;           /* array of rows in the overlay
*/
      XkbBoundsPtr      bounds;         /* bounding box for the overlay
*/
} XkbOverlayRec,*XkbOverlayPtr;

typedef struct _XkbOverlayRow {
      unsigned short      row_under;     /* index into the row under thi
s overlay row */
      unsigned short      num_keys;      /* number of keys in the keys a
rray */
      unsigned short      sz_keys;       /* size of the keys array */
      XkbOverlayKeyPtr    keys;          /* array of keys in the overlay
 row */
} XkbOverlayRowRec,*XkbOverlayRowPtr;

   row_under is an index into the array of rows in the section
   under this overlay. The section under this overlay row is the
   one pointed to by section_under in this overlay row's
   XkbOverlayRec .
typedef struct _XkbOverlayKey {
      XkbKeyNameRec      over;      /* name of this overlay key */
      XkbKeyNameRec      under;     /* name of the key under this overla
y key */
} XkbOverlayKeyRec,*XkbOverlayKeyPtr;

typedef struct _XkbSection {
      Atom            name;          /* section name */
      unsigned char   priority;      /* drawing priority, 0=>highest, 25
5=>lowest */
      short           top;           /* top coordinate of section origin
 */
      short           left;          /* left coordinate of row origin */
      unsigned short  width;         /* section width, in mm/10 */
      unsigned short  height;        /* section height, in mm/10 */
      short           angle;         /* angle of section rotation, count
erclockwise */
      unsigned short  num_rows;      /* number of rows in the rows array
 */
      unsigned short  num_doodads;   /* number of doodads in the doodads
 array */
      unsigned short  num_overlays;  /* number of overlays in the overla
ys array */
      unsigned short  sz_rows;       /* size of the rows array */
      unsigned short  sz_doodads;    /* size of the doodads array */
      unsigned short  sz_overlays;   /* size of the overlays array */
      XkbRowPtr       rows;          /* section rows array */
      XkbDoodadPtr    doodads;       /* section doodads array */
      XkbBoundsRec    bounds;        /* bounding box for the section, be
fore rotation*/
      XkbOverlayPtr   overlays;      /* section overlays array */
} XkbSectionRec, *XkbSectionPtr;

   top and left are the origin of the section, relative to the
   origin of the keyboard, in mm / 10 . angle is in 1 / 10
   degrees.

DoodadRec Structures

   The doodad arrays in the XkbGeometryRec and the XkbSectionRec
   may contain any of the doodad structures and types shown in
   Table 13.1.

   The doodad structures form a union:
typedef union _XkbDoodad {
        XkbAnyDoodadRec        any;
        XkbShapeDoodadRec      shape;
        XkbTextDoodadRec       text;
        XkbIndicatorDoodadRec  indicator;
        XkbLogoDoodadRec       logo;
} XkbDoodadRec, *XkbDoodadPtr;

   The top and left coordinates of each doodad are the coordinates
   of the origin of the doodad relative to the keyboard's origin
   if the doodad is in the XkbGeometryRec doodad array, and with
   respect to the section's origin if the doodad is in a
   XkbSectionRec doodad array. The color_ndx or on_color_ndx and
   off_color_ndx fields are color indices into the XkbGeometryRec
   's color array and are the colors to draw the doodads with.
   Similarly, the shape_ndx fields are indices into the
   XkbGeometryRec 's shape array.
typedef struct _XkbShapeDoodad {
      Atom       name;                /* doodad name */
      unsigned char      type;        /* XkbOutlineDoodad
                                         or XkbSolidDoodad */
      unsigned char      priority;    /* drawing priority,
                                         0=>highest, 255=>lowest */
      short      top;                 /* top coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short      left;                /* left coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short      angle;               /* angle of rotation, clockwise, i
n 1/10 degrees */
      unsigned short      color_ndx;  /* doodad color */
      unsigned short      shape_ndx;  /* doodad shape */
} XkbShapeDoodadRec, *XkbShapeDoodadPtr;

typedef struct _XkbTextDoodad {
      Atom            name;         /* doodad name */
      unsigned char   type;         /*  XkbTextDoodad */
      unsigned char   priority;     /* drawing priority,
                                       0=>highest, 255=>lowest */
      short           top;          /* top coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short           left;         /* left coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short           angle;        /* angle of rotation, clockwise, in
1/10 degrees */
      short           width;        /* width in mm/10 */
      short           height;       /* height in mm/10 */
      unsigned short  color_ndx;    /* doodad color */
      char *           text;        /* doodad text */
      char *           font;        /* arbitrary font name for doodad te
xt */
} XkbTextDoodadRec, *XkbTextDoodadPtr;

typedef struct _XkbIndicatorDoodad {
      Atom           name;          /* doodad name */
      unsigned char  type;          /* XkbIndicatorDoodad */
      unsigned char  priority;      /* drawing priority, 0=>highest, 255
=>lowest */
      short          top;           /* top coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short          left;          /* left coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short          angle;         /* angle of rotation, clockwise, in
1/10 degrees */
      unsigned short shape_ndx;     /* doodad shape */
      unsigned short on_color_ndx;  /* color for doodad if indicator is
on */
      unsigned short off_color_ndx; /* color for doodad if indicator is
off */
} XkbIndicatorDoodadRec, *XkbIndicatorDoodadPtr;

typedef struct _XkbLogoDoodad {
      Atom               name;        /* doodad name */
      unsigned char      type;        /*  XkbLogoDoodad */
      unsigned char      priority;    /* drawing priority, 0=>highest, 2
55=>lowest */
      short              top;         /* top coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short              left;        /* left coordinate, in mm/10 */
      short              angle;       /* angle of rotation, clockwise, i
n 1/10 degrees */
      unsigned short      color_ndx;  /* doodad color */
      unsigned short      shape_ndx;  /* doodad shape */
      char *      logo_name;          /* text for logo */
} XkbLogoDoodadRec, *XkbLogoDoodadPtr

Getting Keyboard Geometry From the Server

   You can load a keyboard geometry as part of the keyboard
   description returned by XkbGetKeyboard . However, if a keyboard
   description has been previously loaded, you can instead obtain
   the geometry by calling the XkbGetGeometry . In this case, the
   geometry returned is the one associated with the keyboard whose
   device ID is contained in the keyboard description.

   To load a keyboard geometry if you already have the keyboard
   description, use XkbGetGeometry.
   Status XkbGetGeometry ( dpy , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description that contains the ID
   for the keyboard and into which the geometry should be loaded
   */

   XkbGetGeometry can return BadValue , BadImplementation ,
   BadName , BadAlloc, or BadLength errors or Success if it
   succeeds.

   It is also possible to load a keyboard geometry by name. The X
   server maintains a database of keyboard components (see Chapter
   20). To load a keyboard geometry description from this database
   by name, use XkbGetNamedGeometry.
   Status XkbGetNamedGeometry ( dpy , xkb , name )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description into which the
   geometry should be loaded */
   Atom name ; /* name of the geometry to be loaded */

   XkbGetNamedGeometry can return BadName if the name cannot be
   found.

Using Keyboard Geometry

   Xkb provides a number of convenience functions to help use a
   keyboard geometry. These include functions to return the
   bounding box of a shape's top surface and to update the
   bounding box of a shape row or section.

   A shape is made up of a number of outlines. Each outline is a
   polygon made up of a number of points. The bounding box of a
   shape is a rectangle that contains all the outlines of that
   shape.
   Key Surface, Shape Outlines, and Bounding Box

   To determine the bounding box of the top surface of a shape,
   use XkbComputeShapeTop.
   Bool XkbComputeShapeTop ( shape , bounds_rtrn )
   XkbShapePtr shape ; /* shape to be examined */
   XkbBoundsPtr bounds_rtrn /* backfilled with the bounding box
   for the shape */

   XkbComputeShapeTop returns a BoundsRec that contains two x and
   y coordinates. These coordinates describe the corners of a
   rectangle that contains the outline that describes the top
   surface of the shape. The top surface is defined to be the
   approximating outline if the approx field of shape is not NULL
   . If approx is NULL , the top surface is defined as the last
   outline in the shape 's array of outlines. XkbComputeShapeTop
   returns False if shape is NULL or if there are no outlines for
   the shape; otherwise, it returns True.

   A ShapeRec contains a BoundsRec that describes the bounds of
   the shape. If you add or delete an outline to or from a shape,
   the bounding box must be updated. To update the bounding box of
   a shape, use XkbComputeShapeBounds.
   Bool XkbComputeShapeBounds ( shape )
   XkbShapePtr shape ; /* shape to be examined */

   XkbComputeShapeBounds updates the BoundsRec contained in the
   shape by examining all the outlines of the shape and setting
   the BoundsRec to the minimum x and minimum y, and maximum x and
   maximum y values found in those outlines. XkbComputeShapeBounds
   returns False if shape is NULL or if there are no outlines for
   the shape; otherwise, it returns True .

   If you add or delete a key to or from a row, or if you update
   the shape of one of the keys in that row, you may need to
   update the bounding box of that row. To update the bounding box
   of a row, use XkbComputeRowBounds.
   Bool XkbComputeRowBounds ( geom , section , row )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry that contains the section */
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section that contains the row */
   XkbRowPtr row ; /* row to be examined and updated */

   XkbComputeRowBounds checks the bounds of all keys in the row
   and updates the bounding box of the row if necessary.
   XkbComputeRowBounds returns False if any of the arguments is
   NULL ; otherwise, it returns True .

   If you add or delete a row to or from a section, or if you
   change the geometry of any of the rows in that section, you may
   need to update the bounding box for that section. To update the
   bounding box of a section, use XkbComputeSectionBounds.
   Bool XkbComputeSectionBounds ( geom , section )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry that contains the section */
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section to be examined and updated
   */

   XkbComputeSectionBounds examines all the rows of the section
   and updates the bounding box of that section so that it
   contains all rows. XkbComputeSectionBounds returns False if any
   of the arguments is NULL ; otherwise, it returns True .

   Keys that can generate multiple keycodes may be associated with
   multiple names. Such keys have a primary name and an alternate
   name. To find the alternate name by using the primary name for
   a key that is part of an overlay, use XkbFindOverlayForKey.
   char * XkbFindOverlayForKey ( geom , section , under )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry that contains the section */
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section to be searched for matching
   keys */
   char * under . /* primary name of the key to be considered */

   XkbFindOverlayForKey uses the primary name of the key, under ,
   to look up the alternate name, which it returns.

Adding Elements to a Keyboard Geometry

   Xkb provides functions to add a single new element to the
   top-level keyboard geometry. In each case the num_ * fields of
   the corresponding structure is incremented by 1. These
   functions do not change sz_ * unless there is no more room in
   the array. Some of these functions fill in the values of the
   element's structure from the arguments. For other functions,
   you must explicitly write code to fill the structure's
   elements.

   The top-level geometry description includes a list of geometry
   properties . A geometry property associates an arbitrary string
   with an equally arbitrary name. Programs that display images of
   keyboards can use geometry properties as hints, but they are
   not interpreted by Xkb. No other geometry structures refer to
   geometry properties.

   To add one property to an existing keyboard geometry
   description, use XkbAddGeomProperty .
   XkbPropertyPtr XkbAddGeomProperty ( geom , name , value )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry to be updated */
   char * name ; /* name of the new property */
   char * value ; /* value for the new property */

   XkbAddGeomProperty adds one property with the specified name
   and value to the keyboard geometry specified by geom.
   XkbAddGeomProperty returns NULL if any of the parameters is
   empty or if it was not able to allocate space for the property.
   To allocate space for an arbitrary number of properties, use
   the XkbAllocGeomProps function.

   To add one key alias to an existing keyboard geometry
   description, use XkbAddGeomKeyAlias .
   XkbKeyAliasPtr XkbAddGeomKeyAlias ( geom , alias, real )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry to be updated */
   char * alias ; /* alias to be added */
   char * real ; /* real name to be bound to the new alias */

   XkbAddGeomKeyAlias adds one key alias with the value alias to
   the geometry geom, and associates it with the key whose real
   name is real. XkbAddGeomKeyAlias returns NULL if any of the
   parameters is empty or if it was not able to allocate space for
   the alias. To allocate space for an arbitrary number of
   aliases, use the XkbAllocGeomKeyAliases function.

   To add one color name to an existing keyboard geometry
   description, use XkbAddGeomColor .
   XkbColorPtr XkbAddGeomColor ( geom , spec , pixel )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry to be updated */
   char * spec ; /* color to be added */
   unsigned int pixel ; /* color to be added */

   XkbAddGeomColor adds the specified color name and pixel to the
   specified geometry geom . The top-level geometry description
   includes a list of up to MaxColors (32) color names . A color
   name is a string whose interpretation is not specified by Xkb
   and neither is the pixel value's interpretation. All other
   geometry data structures refer to colors using their indices in
   this global list or pointers to colors in this list.
   XkbAddGeomColor returns NULL if any of the parameters is empty
   or if it was not able to allocate space for the color. To
   allocate space for an arbitrary number of colors to a geometry,
   use the XkbAllocGeomColors function.

   To add one outline to an existing shape, use XkbAddGeomOutline.
   XkbOutlinePtr XkbAddGeomOutline ( shape , sz_points )
   XkbShapePtr shape ; /* shape to be updated */
   int sz_points ; /* number of points to be reserved */

   An outline consists of an arbitrary number of points.
   XkbAddGeomOutline adds an outline to the specified shape by
   reserving sz_points points for it. The new outline is allocated
   and zeroed. XkbAddGeomOutline returns NULL if any of the
   parameters is empty or if it was not able to allocate space. To
   allocate space for an arbitrary number of outlines to a shape,
   use XkbAllocGeomOutlines.

   To add a shape to a keyboard geometry, use XkbAddGeomShape .
   XkbShapePtr XkbAddGeomShape ( geom , name , sz_outlines )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry to be updated */
   Atom name ; /* name of the new shape */
   int sz_outlines ; /* number of outlines to be reserved */

   A geometry contains an arbitrary number of shapes, each of
   which is made up of an arbitrary number of outlines.
   XkbAddGeomShape adds a shape to a geometry geom by allocating
   space for sz_outlines outlines for it and giving it the name
   specified by name. If a shape with name name already exists in
   the geometry, a pointer to the existing shape is returned.
   XkbAddGeomShape returns NULL if any of the parameters is empty
   or if it was not able to allocate space. To allocate space for
   an arbitrary number of geometry shapes, use XkbAllocGeomShapes
   .

   To add one key at the end of an existing row of keys, use
   XkbAddGeomKey .
   XkbKeyPtr XkbAddGeomKey ( row )
   XkbRowPtr row ; /* row to be updated */

   Keys are grouped into rows. XkbAddGeomKey adds one key to the
   end of the specified row . The key is allocated and zeroed.
   XkbAddGeomKey returns NULL if row is empty or if it was not
   able to allocate space for the key. To allocate space for an
   arbitrary number of keys to a row, use XkbAllocGeomKeys.

   To add one section to an existing keyboard geometry, use
   XkbAddGeomSection .
   XkbSectionPtr XkbAddGeomSection ( geom , name , sz_rows ,
   sz_doodads , sz_overlays )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry to be updated */
   Atom name ; /* name of the new section */
   int sz_rows ; /* number of rows to reserve in the section */
   int sz_doodads ; /* number of doodads to reserve in the section
   */
   int sz_overlays ; /* number of overlays to reserve in the
   section */

   A keyboard geometry contains an arbitrary number of sections.
   XkbAddGeomSection adds one section to an existing keyboard
   geometry geom . The new section contains space for the number
   of rows, doodads, and overlays specified by sz_rows ,
   sz_doodads , and sz_overlays . The new section is allocated and
   zeroed and given the name specified by name . If a section with
   name name already exists in the geometry, a pointer to the
   existing section is returned. XkbAddGeomSection returns NULL if
   any of the parameters is empty or if it was not able to
   allocate space for the section. To allocate space for an
   arbitrary number of sections to a geometry, use
   XkbAllocGeomSections.

   To add a row to a section, use XkbAddGeomRow .
   XkbRowPtr XkbAddGeomRow ( section , sz_keys )
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section to be updated */
   int sz_keys ; /* number of keys to be reserved */

   One of the components of a keyboard geometry section is one or
   more rows of keys. XkbAddGeomRow adds one row to the specified
   section . The newly created row contains space for the number
   of keys specified in sz_keys . They are allocated and zeroed,
   but otherwise uninitialized. XkbAddGeomRow returns NULL if any
   of the parameters is empty or if it was not able to allocate
   space for the row. To allocate space for an arbitrary number of
   rows to a section, use the XkbAllocGeomRows function.

   To add one doodad to a section of a keyboard geometry or to the
   top-level geometry, use XkbAddGeomDoodad .
   XkbDoodadPtr XkbAddGeomDoodad ( geom , section , name )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry to which the doodad is added
   */
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section, if any, to which the doodad
   is added */
   Atom name ; /* name of the new doodad */

   A doodad describes some visible aspect of the keyboard that is
   not a key and is not a section. XkbAddGeomDoodad adds a doodad
   with name specified by name to the geometry geom if section is
   NULL or to the section of the geometry specified by section if
   section is not NULL . XkbAddGeomDoodad returns NULL if any of
   the parameters is empty or if it was not able to allocate space
   for the doodad. If there is already a doodad with the name name
   in the doodad array for the geometry (if section is NULL ) or
   the section (if section is non- NULL ), a pointer to that
   doodad is returned. To allocate space for an arbitrary number
   of doodads to a section, use the XkbAllocGeomSectionDoodads
   function. To allocate space for an arbitrary number of doodads
   to a keyboard geometry, use the XkbAllocGeomDoodads function.

   To add one overlay to a section, use XkbAddGeomOverlay .
   XkbOverlayPtr XkbAddGeomOverlay ( section , name , sz_rows )
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section to which an overlay will be
   added */
   Atom name ; /* name of the overlay */
   int sz_rows ; /* number of rows to reserve in the overlay */

   XkbAddGeomOverlay adds an overlay with the specified name to
   the specified section . The new overlay is created with space
   allocated for sz_rows rows. If an overlay with name name
   already exists in the section, a pointer to the existing
   overlay is returned. XkbAddGeomOverlay returns NULL if any of
   the parameters is empty or if it was not able to allocate space
   for the overlay. To allocate space for an arbitrary number of
   overlays to a section, use the XkbAllocGeomOverlay function.

   To add a row to an existing overlay, use XkbAddGeomOverlayRow .
   XkbOverlayRowPtr XkbAddGeomOverlayRow ( overlay , row_under,
   sz_keys )
   XkbOverlayPtr overlay ; /* overlay to be updated */
   XkbRowPtr row_under ; /* row to be overlayed in the section
   overlay overlays */
   int sz_keys ; /* number of keys to reserve in the row */

   XkbAddGeomOverlayRow adds one row to the overlay . The new row
   contains space for sz_keys keys. If row_under specifies a row
   that doesn't exist on the underlying section,
   XkbAddGeomOverlayRow returns NULL and doesn't change the
   overlay. XkbAddGeomOverlayRow returns NULL if any of the
   parameters is empty or if it was not able to allocate space for
   the overlay.

   To add a key to an existing overlay row, use
   XkbAddGeomOverlayKey .
   XkbOverlayKeyPtr XkbAddGeomOverlayKey ( overlay , row, under )
   XkbOverlayPtr overlay ; /* overlay to be updated */
   XkbRowPtr row ; /* row in overlay to be updated */
   char * under ; /* primary name of the key to be considered */

   XkbAddGeomOverlayKey adds one key to the row in the overlay .
   If there is no key named under in the row of the underlying
   section, XkbAddGeomOverlayKey returns NULL .

Allocating and Freeing Geometry Components

   Xkb provides a number of functions to allocate and free
   subcomponents of a keyboard geometry. Use these functions to
   create or modify keyboard geometries. Note that these functions
   merely allocate space for the new element(s), and it is up to
   you to fill in the values explicitly in your code. These
   allocation functions increase sz_ * but never touch num_ *
   (unless there is an allocation failure, in which case they
   reset both sz_ * and num_ * to zero). These functions return
   Success if they succeed, BadAlloc if they are not able to
   allocate space, or BadValue if a parameter is not as expected.

   To allocate space for an arbitrary number of outlines to a
   shape, use XkbAllocGeomOutlines.
   Status XkbAllocGeomOutlines ( shape , num_needed )
   XkbShapePtr shape ; /* shape for which outlines should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new outlines required */

   XkbAllocGeomOutlines allocates space for num_needed outlines in
   the specified shape . The outlines are not initialized.

   To free geometry outlines, use XkbFreeGeomOutlines .
   void XkbFreeGeomOutlines ( shape , first , count , free_all )
   XkbShapePtr shape ; /* shape in which outlines should be freed
   */
   int first ; /* first outline to be freed */
   int count ; /* number of outlines to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all outlines are freed */

   If free_all is True , all outlines are freed regardless of the
   value of first or count. Otherwise, count outlines are freed
   beginning with the one specified by first.

   To allocate space for an arbitrary number of keys to a row, use
   XkbAllocGeomKeys.
   Status XkbAllocGeomKeys ( row , num_needed )
   XkbRowPtr row ; /* row to which keys should be allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new keys required */

   XkbAllocGeomKeys allocates num_needed keys and adds them to the
   row. No initialization of the keys is done.

   To free geometry keys, use XkbFreeGeomKeys .
   void XkbFreeGeomKeys ( row , first , count , free_all )
   XkbRowPtr row ; /* row in which keys should be freed */
   int first ; /* first key to be freed */
   int count ; /* number of keys to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all keys are freed */

   If free_all is True , all keys are freed regardless of the
   value of first or count. Otherwise, count keys are freed
   beginning with the one specified by first.

   To allocate geometry properties, use XkbAllocGeomProps .
   Status XkbAllocGeomProps ( geom , num_needed )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry for which properties should
   be allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new properties required */

   XkbAllocGeomProps allocates space for num_needed properties and
   adds them to the specified geometry geom . No initialization of
   the properties is done. A geometry property associates an
   arbitrary string with an equally arbitrary name. Geometry
   properties can be used to provide hints to programs that
   display images of keyboards, but they are not interpreted by
   Xkb. No other geometry structures refer to geometry properties.

   To free geometry properties, use XkbFreeGeomProperties .
   void XkbFreeGeomProperties ( geom , first , count , free_all )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry in which properties should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first property to be freed */
   int count ; /* number of properties to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all properties are freed */

   If free_all is True , all properties are freed regardless of
   the value of first or count. Otherwise, count properties are
   freed beginning with the one specified by first.

   To allocate geometry key aliases, use XkbAllocGeomKeyAliases .
   Status XkbAllocGeomKeyAliases ( geom , num_needed )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry for which key aliases should
   be allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new key aliases required */

   XkbAllocGeomKeyAliases allocates space for num_needed key
   aliases and adds them to the specified geometry geom . A key
   alias is a pair of strings that associates an alternate name
   for a key with the real name for that key.

   To free geometry key aliases, use XkbFreeGeomKeyAliases .
   void XkbFreeGeomKeyAliases ( geom , first , count , free_all )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry in which key aliases should
   be freed */
   int first ; /* first key alias to be freed */
   int count ; /* number of key aliases to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all key aliases are freed */

   If free_all is True , all aliases in the top level of the
   specified geometry geom are freed regardless of the value of
   first or count. Otherwise, count aliases in geom are freed
   beginning with the one specified by first.

   To allocate geometry colors, use XkbAllocGeomColors .
   Status XkbAllocGeomColors ( geom , num_needed )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry for which colors should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new colors required. */

   XkbAllocGeomColors allocates space for num_needed colors and
   adds them to the specified geometry geom . A color name is a
   string whose interpretation is not specified by Xkb. All other
   geometry data structures refer to colors using their indices in
   this global list or pointers to colors in this list.

   To free geometry colors, use XkbFreeGeomColors .
   void XkbFreeGeomColors ( geom , first , count , free_all )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry in which colors should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first color to be freed */
   int count ; /* number of colors to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all colors are freed */

   If free_all is True , all colors are freed regardless of the
   value of first or count. Otherwise, count colors are freed
   beginning with the one specified by first.

   To allocate points in an outline, use XkbAllocGeomPoints .
   Status XkbAllocGeomPoints ( outline , num_needed )
   XkbOutlinePtr outline ; /* outline for which points should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new points required */

   XkbAllocGeomPoints allocates space for num_needed points in the
   specified outline . The points are not initialized.

   To free points in a outline, use XkbFreeGeomPoints .
   void XkbFreeGeomPoints ( outline , first , count , free_all )
   XkbOutlinePtr outline ; /* outline in which points should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first point to be freed. */
   int count ; /* number of points to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all points are freed */

   If free_all is True , all points are freed regardless of the
   value of first and count. Otherwise, the number of points
   specified by count are freed, beginning with the point
   specified by first in the specified outline.

   To allocate space for an arbitrary number of geometry shapes,
   use XkbAllocGeomShapes .
   Status XkbAllocGeomShapes ( geom , num_needed )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry for which shapes should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new shapes required */

   XkbAllocGeomShapes allocates space for num_needed shapes in the
   specified geometry geom . The shapes are not initialized.

   To free geometry shapes, use XkbFreeGeomShapes .
   void XkbFreeGeomShapes ( geom , first , count , f ree_all )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry in which shapes should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first shape to be freed */
   int count ; /* number of shapes to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all shapes are freed */

   If free_all is True , all shapes in the geometry are freed
   regardless of the values of first and count. Otherwise, count
   shapes are freed, beginning with the shape specified by first.

   To allocate geometry sections, use XkbAllocGeomSections .
   Status XkbAllocGeomSections ( geom , num_needed )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /*geometry for which sections should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new sections required */

   XkbAllocGeomSections allocates num_needed sections and adds
   them to the geometry geom. No initialization of the sections is
   done.

   To free geometry sections, use XkbFreeGeomSections .
   void XkbFreeGeomSections ( geom , first , count , free_all )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry in which sections should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first section to be freed. */
   int count ; /* number of sections to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all sections are freed */

   If free_all is True , all sections are freed regardless of the
   value of first and count. Otherwise, the number of sections
   specified by count are freed, beginning with the section
   specified by first in the specified geometry.

   To allocate rows in a section, use XkbAllocGeomRows .
   Status XkbAllocGeomRows ( section , num_needed )
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section for which rows should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new rows required */

   XkbAllocGeomRows allocates num_needed rows and adds them to the
   section. No initialization of the rows is done.

   To free rows in a section, use XkbFreeGeomRows .
   void XkbFreeGeomRows ( section , first , count , free_all )
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section in which rows should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first row to be freed. */
   int count ; /* number of rows to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all rows are freed */

   If free_all is True , all rows are freed regardless of the
   value of first and count. Otherwise, the number of rows
   specified by count are freed, beginning with the row specified
   by first in the specified section.

   To allocate overlays in a section, use XkbAllocGeomOverlays .
   Status XkbAllocGeomOverlays ( section , num_needed )
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section for which overlays should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new overlays required */

   XkbAllocGeomRows allocates num_needed overlays and adds them to
   the section. No initialization of the overlays is done.

   To free rows in an section, use XkbFreeGeomOverlays .
   void XkbFreeGeomOverlays ( section , first , count , free_all )
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section in which overlays should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first overlay to be freed. */
   int count ; /* number of overlays to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all overlays are freed */

   If free_all is True , all overlays are freed regardless of the
   value of first and count. Otherwise, the number of overlays
   specified by count are freed, beginning with the overlay
   specified by first in the specified section.

   To allocate rows in a overlay, use XkbAllocGeomOverlayRows .
   Status XkbAllocGeomOverlayRows ( overlay , num_needed )
   XkbSectionPtr overlay ; /* section for which rows should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new rows required */

   XkbAllocGeomOverlayRows allocates num_needed rows and adds them
   to the overlay. No initialization of the rows is done.

   To free rows in an overlay, use XkbFreeGeomOverlayRows .
   void XkbFreeGeomOverlayRows ( overlay , first , count ,
   free_all )
   XkbSectionPtr overlay ; /* section in which rows should be
   freed */
   int first ; /* first row to be freed. */
   int count ; /* number of rows to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all rows are freed */

   If free_all is True , all rows are freed regardless of the
   value of first and count. Otherwise, the number of rows
   specified by count are freed, beginning with the row specified
   by first in the specified overlay.

   To allocate keys in an overlay row, use XkbAllocGeomOverlayKeys
   .
   Status XkbAllocGeomOverlayKeys ( row , num_needed )
   XkbRowPtr row ; /* section for which rows should be allocated
   */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new rows required */

   XkbAllocGeomOverlayKeys allocates num_needed keys and adds them
   to the row. No initialization of the keys is done.

   To free keys in an overlay row, use XkbFreeGeomOverlayKeys .
   void XkbFreeGeomOverlayKeys ( row , first , count , free_all )
   XkbRowPtr row ; /* row in which keys should be freed */
   int first ; /* first key to be freed. */
   int count ; /* number of keys to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all keys are freed */

   If free_all is True , all keys are freed regardless of the
   value of first and count. Otherwise, the number of keys
   specified by count are freed, beginning with the key specified
   by first in the specified row.

   To allocate doodads that are global to a keyboard geometry, use
   XkbAllocGeomDoodads .
   Status XkbAllocGeomDoodads ( geom , num_needed )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry for which doodads should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new doodads required */

   XkbAllocGeomDoodads allocates num_needed doodads and adds them
   to the specified geometry geom . No initialization of the
   doodads is done.

   To allocate doodads that are specific to a section, use
   XkbAllocGeomSectionDoodads .
   Status XkbAllocGeomSectionDoodads ( section , num_needed )
   XkbSectionPtr section ; /* section for which doodads should be
   allocated */
   int num_needed ; /* number of new doodads required */

   XkbAllocGeomSectionDoodads allocates num_needed doodads and
   adds them to the specified section . No initialization of the
   doodads is done.

   To free geometry doodads, use XkbFreeGeomDoodads .
   void XkbFreeGeomDoodads ( doodads , count , free_all )
   XkbDoodadPtr doodads ; /* doodads to be freed */
   int count ; /* number of doodads to be freed */
   Bool free_all; /* True => all doodads are freed */

   If free_all is True , all doodads in the array are freed,
   regardless of the value of count. Otherwise, count doodads are
   freed.

   To allocate an entire geometry, use XkbAllocGeometry .
   Status XkbAllocGeometry ( xkb , sizes )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description for which geometry is
   to be allocated */
   XkbGeometrySizesPtr sizes ; /* initial sizes for all geometry
   components */

   XkbAllocGeometry allocates a keyboard geometry and adds it to
   the keyboard description specified by xkb. The keyboard
   description should be obtained via the XkbGetKeyboard or
   XkbAllockeyboard functions. The sizes parameter specifies the
   number of elements to be reserved for the subcomponents of the
   keyboard geometry and can be zero or more. These subcomponents
   include the properties, colors, shapes, sections, and doodads.

   To free an entire geometry, use XkbFreeGeometry .
   void XkbFreeGeometry ( geom , which , free_all )
   XkbGeometryPtr geom ; /* geometry to be freed */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of geometry components to be freed
   */
   Bool free_all; /* True => the entire geometry is freed. */

   The values of which and free_all determine how much of the
   specified geometry is freed. The valid values for which are:
#define      XkbGeomPropertiesMask  (1<<0)
#define      XkbGeomColorsMask      (1<<1)
#define      XkbGeomShapesMask      (1<<2)
#define      XkbGeomSectionsMask    (1<<3)
#define      XkbGeomDoodadsMask     (1<<4)
#define      XkbGeomAllMask         (0x1f)

   If free_all is True , the entire geometry is freed regardless
   of the value of which. Otherwise, the portions of the geometry
   specified by which are freed.

Chapter 14. Xkb Keyboard Mapping

   Table of Contents

   Notation and Terminology

        Core Implementation
        Xkb Implementation

   Getting Map Components from the Server
   Changing Map Components in the Server

        The XkbMapChangesRec Structure

   Tracking Changes to Map Components
   Allocating and Freeing Client and Server Maps

        Allocating an Empty Client Map
        Freeing a Client Map
        Allocating an Empty Server Map
        Freeing a Server Map

   The Xkb keyboard mapping contains all the information the
   server and clients need to interpret key events. This chapter
   provides an overview of the terminology used to describe an Xkb
   keyboard mapping and introduces common utilities for
   manipulating the keyboard mapping.

   The mapping consists of two components, a server map and a
   client map. The client map is the collection of information a
   client needs to interpret key events from the keyboard. It
   contains a global list of key types and an array of key symbol
   maps, each of which describes the symbols bound to a key and
   the rules to be used to interpret those symbols. The server map
   contains the information the server needs to interpret key
   events. This includes actions and behaviors for each key,
   explicit components for a key, and the virtual modifiers and
   the per-key virtual modifier mapping.

   For detailed information on particular components of the
   keyboard map, refer to Chapter 15, "Xkb Client Keyboard
   Mapping" and Chapter 16, "Xkb Server Keyboard Mapping."

Notation and Terminology

   The graphic characters or control functions that may be
   accessed by one key are logically arranged in groups and
   levels, where group and level are defined as in the ISO9995
   standard:

   Group:

   A logical state of a keyboard providing access to a collection
   of graphic characters. Usually these graphic characters
   logically belong together and may be arranged on several levels
   within a group.

   Level:

   One of several states (normally 2 or 3) governing which graphic
   character is produced when a graphic key is actuated. In
   certain cases the level may also affect function keys.

   These definitions, taken from the ISO standard, refer to
   graphic keys and characters. In the context of Xkb, Group and
   Level are not constrained to graphic keys and characters; they
   may be used with any key to access any character the key is
   capable of generating.

   Level is often referred to as "Shift Level". Levels are
   numbered sequentially starting at one.

Note

   Shift level is derived from the modifier state, but not
   necessarily in the same way for all keys. For example, the
   Shift modifier selects shift level 2 on most keys, but for
   keypad keys the modifier bound to Num_Lock (that is, the
   NumLock virtual modifier) also selects shift level 2.

   For example, consider the following key (the gray characters
   indicate symbols that are implied or expected but are not
   actually engraved on the key):
   Shift Levels and Groups

   This key has two groups, indicated by the columns, and each
   group has two shift levels. For the first group (Group1), the
   symbol shift level one is a , and the symbol for shift level
   two is A . For the second group, the symbol for shift level one
   is  , and the symbol for shift level two is  .

Core Implementation

   The standard interpretation rules for the core X keymap only
   allow clients to access keys such as the one shown in Figure
   14.1. That is, clients using the standard interpretation rules
   can only access one of four keysyms for any given KeyPress
   event -- two different symbols in two different groups.

   In general, the Shift modifier, the Lock modifier, and the
   modifier bound to the Num_Lock key are used to change between
   shift level 1 and shift level 2. To switch between groups, the
   core implementation uses the modifier bound to the Mode_switch
   key. When the Mode_switch modifier is set, the keyboard is
   logically in Group 2. When the Mode_switch modifier is not set,
   the keyboard is logically in Group 1.

   The core implementation does not clearly specify the behavior
   of keys. For example, the locking behavior of the CapsLock and
   Num_Lock keys depends on the vendor.

Xkb Implementation

   Xkb extends the core implementation by providing access to up
   to four keyboard groups with up to 63 shift levels per key
   ^[6]. In addition, Xkb provides precise specifications
   regarding the behavior of keys. In Xkb, modifier state and the
   current group are independent (with the exception of
   compatibility mapping, discussed in Chapter 17).

   Xkb handles switching between groups via key actions,
   independent of any modifier state information. Key actions are
   in the server map component and are described in detail in
   section 16.1.4.

   Xkb handles shift levels by associating a key type with each
   group on each key. Each key type defines the shift levels
   available for the groups on keys of its type and specifies the
   modifier combinations necessary to access each level.

   For example, Xkb allows key types where the Control modifier
   can be used to access the shift level two of a key. Key types
   are in the client map component and are described in detail in
   section 15.2.

   Xkb provides precise specification of the behavior of a key
   using key behaviors. Key behaviors are in the server map
   component and are described in detail in section 16.2.

Getting Map Components from the Server

   Xkb provides two functions to obtain the keyboard mapping
   components from the server. The first function, XkbGetMap ,
   allocates an XkbDescRec structure, retrieves mapping components
   from the server, and stores them in the XkbDescRec structure it
   just allocated. The second function, XkbGetUpdatedMap ,
   retrieves mapping components from the server and stores them in
   an XkbDescRec structure that has previously been allocated.

   To allocate an XkbDescRec structure and populate it with the
   server's keyboard client map and server map, use XkbGetMap.
   XkbGetMap is similar to XkbGetKeyboard (see section 6.2), but
   is used only for obtaining the address of an XkbDescRec
   structure that is populated with keyboard mapping components.
   It allows finer control over which substructures of the
   keyboard mapping components are to be populated. XkbGetKeyboard
   always returns fully populated components, while XkbGetMap can
   be instructed to return a partially populated component.
   XkbDescPtr XkbGetMap ( display, which, device_spec )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask selecting subcomponents to
   populate */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device_id, or XkbUseCoreKbd */

   The which mask is a bitwise inclusive OR of the masks defined
   in Table 14.1. Only those portions of the keyboard server map
   and the keyboard client maps that are specified in which are
   allocated and populated.

   In addition to allocating and obtaining the server map and the
   client map, XkbGetMap also sets the device_spec , the
   min_key_code , and max_key_code fields of the keyboard
   description.

   XkbGetMap is synchronous; it queries the server for the desired
   information, waits for a reply, and then returns. If successful
   , XkbGetMap returns a pointer to the XkbDescRec structure it
   allocated. If unsuccessful, XkbGetMap returns NULL . When
   unsuccessful, one of the following protocol errors is also
   generated: BadAlloc (unable to allocate the XkbDescRec
   structure), BadValue (some mask bits in which are undefined) ,
   or BadImplementation (a compatible version of the Xkb extension
   is not available in the server). To free the returned data, use
   XkbFreeClientMap .

   Xkb also provides convenience functions to get partial
   component definitions from the server. These functions are
   specified in the "convenience functions" column in Table 14.1.
   Refer to the sections listed in the table for more information
   on these functions.

   Table 14.1. Xkb Mapping Component Masks and Convenience
   Functions
   Mask Value Map Fields Convenience Functions Section
   XkbKeyTypesMask (1<<0) client

   types

   size_types

   num_types

   XkbGetKeyTypes

   XkbResizeKeyType

   XkbCopyKeyType

   XkbCopyKeyTypes
   15.2
   XkbKeySymsMask (1<<1) client

   syms

   size_syms

   num_syms

   key_sym_map

   XkbGetKeySyms

   XkbResizeKeySyms

   XkbChangeTypesOfKey
   15.3
   XkbModifierMapMask (1<<2) client modmap XkbGetKeyModifierMap
   15.4
   XkbExplicitComponentsMask (1<<3) server explicit
   XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents 16.3
   XkbKeyActionsMask (1<<4) server

   key_acts

   acts

   num_acts

   size_acts

   XkbGetKeyActions

   XkbResizeKeyActions
   16.1
   XkbKeyBehaviorsMask (1<<5) server behaviors XkbGetKeyBehaviors
   16.2
   XkbVirtualModsMask (1<<6) server vmods XkbGetVirtualMods 16.4
   XkbVirtualModMapMask (1<<7) server vmodmap XkbGetVirtualModMap
   16.4

   Xkb defines combinations of these masks for convenience:
#define  XkbResizableInfoMask      (XkbKeyTypesMask)
#define  XkbAllClientInfoMask      (XkbKeyTypesMask | XkbKeySymsMask |
                                    XkbModifierMapMask)
#define  XkbAllServerInfoMask      (XkbExplicitComponentsMask |
                                    XkbKeyActionsMask| XkbKeyBehaviorsMa
sk |
                                    XkbVirtualModsMask | XkbVirtualModMa
pMask)
#define  XkbAllMapComponentsMask   (XkbAllClientInfoMask|XkbAllServerInf
oMask)

   Key types, symbol maps, and actions are all interrelated:
   changes in one require changes in the others. The convenience
   functions make it easier to edit these components and handle
   the interdependencies.

   To update the client or server map information in an existing
   keyboard description, use XkbGetUpdatedMap.
   Status XkbGetUpdatedMap ( display, which, xkb )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask selecting subcomponents to
   populate */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to be updated */

   The which parameter is a bitwise inclusive OR of the masks in
   Table 14.1. If the needed components of the xkb structure are
   not already allocated, XkbGetUpdatedMap allocates them.
   XkbGetUpdatedMap fetches the requested information for the
   device specified in the XkbDescRec passed in the xkb parameter.

   XkbGetUpdatedMap is synchronous; it queries the server for the
   desired information, waits for a reply, and then returns. If
   successful , XkbGetUpdatedMap returns Success . If
   unsuccessful, XkbGetUpdatedMap returns one of the following:
   BadAlloc (unable to allocate a component in the XkbDescRec
   structure), BadValue (some mask bits in which are undefined),
   BadImplementation (a compatible version of the Xkb extension is
   not available in the server or the reply from the server was
   invalid).

Changing Map Components in the Server

   There are two ways to make changes to map components: either
   change a local copy of the keyboard map and call XkbSetMap to
   send the modified map to the server, or, to reduce network
   traffic, use an XkbMapChangesRec structure and call
   XkbChangeMap.
   Bool XkbSetMap ( dpy , which , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask selecting subcomponents to update
   */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* description from which new values are taken
   */

   Use XkbSetMap to send a complete new set of values for entire
   components (for example, all symbols, all actions, and so on)
   to the server. The which parameter specifies the components to
   be sent to the server, and is a bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks listed in Table 14.1. The xkb parameter is a pointer to
   an XkbDescRec structure and contains the information to be
   copied to the server. For each bit set in the which parameter,
   XkbSetMap takes the corresponding structure values from the xkb
   parameter and sends it to the server specified by dpy.

   If any components specified by which are not present in the xkb
   parameter, XkbSetMap returns False . Otherwise, it sends the
   update request to the server and returns True . XkbSetMap can
   generate BadAlloc , BadLength , and BadValue protocol errors.

   Key types, symbol maps, and actions are all interrelated;
   changes in one require changes in the others. Xkb provides
   functions to make it easier to edit these components and handle
   the interdependencies. Table 14.1 lists these helper functions
   and provides a pointer to where they are defined.

The XkbMapChangesRec Structure

   Use the XkbMapChangesRec structure to identify and track
   partial modifications to the mapping components and to reduce
   the amount of traffic between the server and clients.
typedef struct _XkbMapChanges {
      unsigned short    changed;              /* identifies valid compon
ents
                                                 in structure */
      KeyCode           min_key_code;         /* lowest numbered keycode
 for
                                                 device */
      KeyCode           max_key_code;         /* highest numbered keycod
e for
                                                 device */
      unsigned char     first_type;           /* index of first key type
                                                 modified */
      unsigned char     num_types;            /* # types modified */
      KeyCode           first_key_sym;        /* first key whose key_sym
_map
                                                 changed */
      unsigned char     num_key_syms;         /* # key_sym_map
                                                 entries changed */
      KeyCode           first_key_act;        /* first key whose key_act
s
                                                 entry changed */
      unsigned char     num_key_acts;         /* # key_acts
                                                 entries changed */
      KeyCode           first_key_behavior;   /* first key whose behavio
rs
                                                 changed */
      unsigned char     num_key_behaviors;    /* # behaviors
                                                 entries changed */
      KeyCode           first_key_explicit;   /* first key whose explici
t
                                                 entry changed */
      unsigned char     num_key_explicit;     /* #  explicit
                                                 entries changed */
      KeyCode           first_modmap_key;     /* first key whose modmap
                                                 entry changed */
      unsigned char     num_modmap_keys;      /* # modmap
                                                 entries changed */
      KeyCode           first_vmodmap_key;    /* first key whose vmodmap
                                                 changed */
      unsigned char     num_vmodmap_keys;     /* #  vmodmap
                                                 entries changed */
      unsigned char     pad1;                 /* reserved */
      unsigned short    vmods;                /* mask indicating which v
mods
                                                 changed */
} XkbMapChangesRec,*XkbMapChangesPtr;

   The changed field identifies the map components that have
   changed in an XkbDescRec structure and may contain any of the
   bits in Table 14.1, which are also shown in Table 14.2. Every 1
   bit in changed also identifies which other fields in the
   XkbMapChangesRec structure contain valid values, as indicated
   in Table 14.2. The min_key_code and max_key_code fields are for
   reference only; they are ignored on any requests sent to the
   server and are always updated by the server whenever it returns
   the data for an XkbMapChangesRec .

   Table 14.2. XkbMapChangesRec Masks
   Mask Valid XkbMapChangesRec Fields XkbDescRec Field Containing
   Changed Data
   XkbKeyTypesMask

   first_type
   ,

   num_types

   map->type[first_type] ..

   map->type[first_type + num_types - 1]
   XkbKeySymsMask

   first_key_sym
   ,

   num_key_syms

   map->key_sym_map[first_key_sym] ..

   map->key_sym_map[first_key_sym + num_key_syms - 1]
   XkbModifierMapMask

   first_modmap_key
   ,

   num_modmap_keys

   map->modmap[first_modmap_key] ..

   map->modmap[first_modmap_key + num_modmap_keys-1]
   XkbExplicitComponentsMask

   first_key_explicit
   ,

   num_key_explicit

   server->explicit[first_key_explicit] ..

   server->explicit[first_key_explicit + num_key_explicit - 1]
   XkbKeyActionsMask

   first_key_act,

   num_key_acts

   server->key_acts[first_key_act] ..

   server->key_acts[first_key_act + num_key_acts - 1]
   XkbKeyBehaviorsMask

   first_key_behavior,

   num_key_behaviors

   server->behaviors[first_key_behavior] ..

   server->behaviors[first_key_behavior + num_key_behaviors - 1]
   XkbVirtuawModsMask vmods server->vmods[*]
   XkbVirtualModMapMask

   first_vmodmap_key,

   num_vmodmap_keys

   server->vmodmap[first_vmodmap_key] ..

   server->vmodmap[first_vmodmap_key + num_vmodmap_keys - 1]

   To update only partial components of a keyboard description,
   modify the appropriate fields in the server and map components
   of a local copy of the keyboard description, then call
   XkbChangeMap with an XkbMapChangesRec structure indicating
   which components have changed.
   Bool XkbChangeMap ( dpy , xkb , changes )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* description from which new values are taken
   */
   XkbMapChangesPtr changes ; /*identifies component parts to
   update */

   XkbChangeMap copies any components specified by the changes
   structure from the keyboard description, xkb , to the X server
   specified by dpy .

   If any components specified by changes are not present in the
   xkb parameter, XkbChangeMap returns False . Otherwise, it sends
   a request to the server and returns True .

   XkbChangeMap can generate BadAlloc , BadLength , and BadValue
   protocol errors.

Tracking Changes to Map Components

   The Xkb extension reports XkbMapNotify events to clients
   wanting notification whenever a map component of the Xkb
   description for a device changes. There are many different
   types of Xkb keyboard map changes. Xkb uses an event detail
   mask to identify each type of change. The event detail masks
   are identical to the masks listed in Table 14.1.

   To receive XkbMapNotify events under all possible conditions,
   use XkbSelectEvents (see section 4.3) and pass XkbMapNotifyMask
   in both bits_to_change and values_for_bits .

   To receive XkbMapNotify events only under certain conditions,
   use XkbSelectEventDetails using XkbMapNotify as the event_type
   and specifying the desired map changes in bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits using mask bits from Table 14.1.

   The structure for XkbMapNotify events is:
typedef struct {
      int            type;         /* Xkb extension base event code */
      unsigned long  serial;       /* X server serial number for event *
/
      Bool           send_event;   /* True => synthetically generated */
      Display *      display;      /* server connection where event gene
rated */
      Time           time;         /* server time when event generated *
/
      int            xkb_type;     /*  XkbMapNotify */
      int            device;       /* Xkb device ID, will not be XkbUseC
oreKbd */
      unsigned int   changed;      /* identifies valid fields in rest of
 event */
      unsigned int   resized;      /* reserved */
      int            first_type;   /* index of first key  type modified
*/
      int            num_types     /* # types modified */
      KeyCode        min_key_code; /* minimum keycode for device */
      KeyCode        max_key_code; /* maximum keycode for device */
      KeyCode        first_key_sym; /* first key whose key_sym_map chang
ed */
      KeyCode        first_key_act; /* first key whose  key_acts entry c
hanged */
      KeyCode        first_key_behavior; /* first key whose  behaviors c
hanged */
      KeyCode        first_key_explicit; /* first key whose  explicit  e
ntry changed */
      KeyCode        first_modmap_key;   /* first key whose  modmap entr
y changed */
      KeyCode        first_vmodmap_key;  /* #  modmap entries changed */
      int            num_key_syms;       /* # key_sym_map entries change
d */
      int            num_key_acts;       /* #  key_acts entries changed
*/
      int            num_key_behaviors;  /* #  behaviors entries changed
 */
      int            num_key_explicit;   /* #  explicit entries changed
*/
      int            num_modmap_keys;    /* #  modmap entries changed */
      int            num_vmodmap_keys;   /* #  vmodmap entries changed *
/
      unsigned in      t      vmods;     /* mask indicating which  vmods
 changed */
} XkbMapNotifyEvent;

   The changed field specifies the map components that have
   changed and is the bitwise inclusive OR of the mask bits
   defined in Table 14.1. The other fields in this event are
   interpreted as the like-named fields in an XkbMapChangesRec
   (see section 14.3.1). The XkbMapNotifyEvent structure also has
   an additional resized field that is reserved for future use.

Allocating and Freeing Client and Server Maps

   Calling XkbGetMap (see section 14.2) should be sufficient for
   most applications to get client and server maps. As a result,
   most applications do not need to directly allocate client and
   server maps.

   If you change the number of key types or construct map
   components without loading the necessary components from the X
   server, do not allocate any map components directly using
   malloc or Xmalloc . Instead, use the Xkb allocators,
   XkbAllocClientMap, and XkbAllocServerMap .

   Similarly, use the Xkb destructors, XkbFreeClientMap, and
   XkbFreeServerMap instead of free or Xfree .

Allocating an Empty Client Map

   To allocate and initialize an empty client map description
   record, use XkbAllocClientMap.
   Status XkbAllocClientMap ( xkb, which, type_count )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description in which to allocate
   client map */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask selecting map components to
   allocate */
   unsigned int type_count ; /* value of num_types field in map to
   be allocated */

   XkbAllocClientMap allocates and initializes an empty client map
   in the map field of the keyboard description specified by xkb .
   The which parameter specifies the particular components of the
   client map structure to allocate and is a mask composed by a
   bitwise inclusive OR of one or more of the masks shown in Table
   14.3.

   Table 14.3. XkbAllocClientMap Masks
   Mask Effect
   XkbKeyTypesMask The type_count field specifies the number of
   entries to preallocate for the types field of the client map.
   If the type_count field is less than XkbNumRequiredTypes (see
   section 15.2.1), returns BadValue.
   XkbKeySymsMask The min_key_code and max_key_code fields of the
   xkb parameter are used to allocate the syms and key_sym_map
   fields of the client map. The fields are allocated to contain
   the maximum number of entries necessary for max_key_code -
   min_key_code + 1 keys.
   XkbModifierMapMask The min_key_code and max_key_code fields of
   the xkb parameter are used to allocate the modmap field of the
   client map. The field is allocated to contain the maximum
   number of entries necessary for max_key_code - min_key_code + 1
   keys.

Note

   The min_key_code and max_key_code fields of the xkb parameter
   must be legal values if the XkbKeySymsMask or
   XkbModifierMapMask masks are set in the which parameter. If
   they are not valid, XkbAllocClientMap returns BadValue .

   If the client map of the keyboard description is not NULL , and
   any fields are already allocated in the client map,
   XkbAllocClientMap does not overwrite the existing values; it
   simply ignores that part of the request. The only exception is
   the types array. If type_count is greater than the current
   num_types field of the client map, XkbAllocClientMap resizes
   the types array and resets the num_types field accordingly.

   If XkbAllocClientMap is successful, it returns Success .
   Otherwise, it can return either BadMatch , BadAlloc , or
   BadValue errors.

Freeing a Client Map

   To free memory used by the client map member of an XkbDescRec
   structure, use XkbFreeClientMap.
   void XkbFreeClientMap ( xkb, which, free_all )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description containing client map
   to free */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask identifying components of map to
   free */
   Bool free_all ; /* True => free all client components and map
   itself */

   XkbFreeClientMap frees the components of client map specified
   by which in the XkbDescRec structure specified by the xkb
   parameter and sets the corresponding structure component values
   to NULL . The which parameter specifies a combination of the
   client map masks shown in Table 14.3.

   If free_all is True , which is ignored; XkbFreeClientMap frees
   every non- NULL structure component in the client map, frees
   the XkbClientMapRec structure referenced by the map member of
   the xkb parameter, and sets the map member to NULL.

Allocating an Empty Server Map

   To allocate and initialize an empty server map description
   record, use XkbAllocServerMap.
   Status XkbAllocServerMap ( xkb, which, count_acts )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description in which to allocate
   server map */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask selecting map components to
   allocate */
   unsigned int count_acts ; /* value of num_acts field in map to
   be allocated */

   XkbAllocServerMap allocates and initializes an empty server map
   in the server field of the keyboard description specified by
   xkb . The which parameter specifies the particular components
   of the server map structure to allocate, as specified in Table
   14.4.

   Table 14.4. XkbAllocServerMap Masks
   Mask Effect
   XkbExplicitComponentsMask The min_key_code and max_key_code
   fields of the xkb parameter are used to allocate the explicit
   field of the server map.
   XkbKeyActionsMask The min_key_code and max_key_code fields of
   the xkb parameter are used to allocate the key_acts field of
   the server map. The count_acts parameter is used to allocate
   the acts field of the server map.
   XkbKeyBehaviorsMask The min_key_code and max_key_code fields of
   the xkb parameter are used to allocate the behaviors field of
   the server map.
   XkbVirtualModMapMask The min_key_code and max_key_code fields
   of the xkb parameter are used to allocate the vmodmap field of
   the server map.

Note

   The min_key_code and max_key_code fields of the xkb parameter
   must be legal values. If they are not valid, XkbAllocServerMap
   returns BadValue .

   If the server map of the keyboard description is not NULL and
   any fields are already allocated in the server map,
   XkbAllocServerMap does not overwrite the existing values. The
   only exception is with the acts array. If the count_acts
   parameter is greater than the current num_acts field of the
   server map, XkbAllocServerMap resizes the acts array and resets
   the num_acts field accordingly.

   If XkbAllocServerMap is successful, it returns Success .
   Otherwise, it can return either BadMatch or BadAlloc errors.

Freeing a Server Map

   To free memory used by the server member of an XkbDescRec
   structure, use XkbFreeServerMap.
   void XkbFreeServerMap ( xkb, which, free_all )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description containing server map
   to free */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask identifying components of map to
   free */
   Bool free_all ; /* True => free all server map components and
   server itself */

   The XkbFreeServerMap function frees the specified components of
   server map in the XkbDescRec structure specified by the xkb
   parameter and sets the corresponding structure component values
   to NULL . The which parameter specifies a combination of the
   server map masks and is a bitwise inclusive OR of the masks
   listed in Table 14.4. If free_all is True , which is ignored
   and XkbFreeServerMap frees every non- NULL structure component
   in the server map, frees the XkbServerMapRec structure
   referenced by the server member of the xkb parameter, and sets
   the server member to NULL.
   __________________________________________________________

   ^[6] The core implementation restricts the number of symbols
   per key to 255. With four groups, this allows for up to 63
   symbols (or shift levels) per group. Most keys will only have a
   few shift levels.

Chapter 15. Xkb Client Keyboard Mapping

   Table of Contents

   The XkbClientMapRec Structure
   Key Types

        The Canonical Key Types
        Getting Key Types from the Server
        Changing the Number of Levels in a Key Type
        Copying Key Types

   Key Symbol Map

        Per-Key Key Type Indices
        Per-Key Group Information
        Key Width
        Offset in to the Symbol Map
        Getting the Symbol Map for Keys from the Server
        Changing the Number of Groups and Types Bound to a Key
        Changing the Number of Symbols Bound to a Key

   The Per-Key Modifier Map

        Getting the Per-Key Modifier Map from the Server

   The Xkb client map for a keyboard is the collection of
   information a client needs to interpret key events from the
   keyboard. It contains a global list of key types and an array
   of key symbol maps, each of which describes the symbols bound
   to a key and the rules to be used to interpret those symbols.

   Figure 15.1 shows the relationships between elements in the
   client map:
   Xkb Client Map

The XkbClientMapRec Structure

   The map field of the complete Xkb keyboard description (see
   section 6.1) is a pointer to the Xkb client map, which is of
   type XkbClientMapRec :
typedef struct {                        /* Client Map */
      unsigned char      size_types;    /* # occupied entries in  types
*/
      unsigned char      num_types;     /* # entries in types */
      XkbKeyTypePtr      types;         /* vector of key types used by t
his keymap */
      unsigned short     size_syms;     /* length of the syms array */
      unsigned short     num_syms;      /* # entries in syms */
      KeySym *           syms;          /* linear 2d tables of keysyms,
1 per key */
      XkbSymMapPtr       key_sym_map;   /* 1 per keycode, maps keycode t
o syms */
      unsigned char *    modmap;        /* 1 per keycode, real mods boun
d to key */
} XkbClientMapRec, *XkbClientMapPtr;

   The following sections describe each of the elements of the
   XkbClientMapRec structure in more detail.

Key Types

   Key types are used to determine the shift level of a key given
   the current state of the keyboard. The set of all possible key
   types for the Xkb keyboard description are held in the types
   field of the client map, whose total size is stored in
   size_types , and whose total number of valid entries is stored
   in num_types . Key types are defined using the following
   structures:
typedef struct {                       /* Key Type */
      XkbModsRec        mods;          /* modifiers used to compute shif
t
                                          level */
      unsigned char     num_levels;    /* total # shift levels, do not
                                          modify directly */
      unsigned char     map_count;     /* # entries in map,
                                           preserve
                                          (if non- NULL) */
      XkbKTMapEntryPtr  map;           /* vector of modifiers for each
                                          shift level */
      XkbModsPtr        preserve;      /* mods to preserve for correspon
ding
                                          map entry */
      Atom              name;          /* name of key type */
      Atom *            level_names;   /* array of names of each shift l
evel */
} XkbKeyTypeRec, *XkbKeyTypePtr;

typedef struct {                   /* Modifiers for a key type */
      Bool            active;      /*  True => entry
                                      active when determining shift leve
l */
      unsigned char   level;       /* shift level if modifiers match  mo
ds */
      XkbModsRec      mods;        /* mods needed for this level to be
                                      selected */
} XkbKTMapEntryRec,*XkbKTMapEntryPtr;

   The mods field of a key type is an XkbModsRec (see section 7.2)
   specifying the modifiers the key type uses when calculating the
   shift level, and can be composed of both the core modifiers and
   virtual modifiers. To set the modifiers associated with a key
   type, modify the real_mods and vmods fields of the mods
   XkbModsRec accordingly. The mask field of the XkbModsRec is
   reserved for use by Xkb and is calculated from the real_mods
   and vmods fields.

   The num_levels field holds the total number of shift levels for
   the key type. Xkb uses num_levels to ensure the array of
   symbols bound to a key is large enough. Do not modify
   num_levels directly to change the number if shift levels for a
   key type. Instead, use XkbResizeKeyType (see section 15.2.3).

   The map field is a vector of XkbKTMapEntryRec structures, with
   map_count entries, that specify the modifier combinations for
   each possible shift level. Each map entry contains an active
   field, a mods field, and a level field. The active field
   determines whether the modifier combination listed in the mods
   field should be considered when determining shift level. If
   active is False , this map entry is ignored. If active is True
   , the level field of the map entry specifies the shift level to
   use when the current modifier combination matches the
   combination specified in the mods field of the map entry.

   Any combination of modifiers not explicitly listed somewhere in
   the map yields shift level one. In addition, map entries
   specifying unbound virtual modifiers are not considered.

   Any modifiers specified in mods are normally consumed by
   XkbTranslateKeyCode (see section 12.1.3). For those rare
   occasions a modifier should be considered despite having been
   used to look up a symbol, key types include an optional
   preserve field. If a preserve member of a key type is not NULL
   , it represents a list of modifiers where each entry
   corresponds directly to one of the key type's map . Each entry
   lists the modifiers that should not be consumed if the matching
   map entry is used to determine shift level.

   Each shift level has a name and these names are held in the
   level_names array, whose length is num_levels . The type itself
   also has a name, which is held in the name field.

   For example, consider how the server handles the following
   possible symbolic description of a possible key type (note that
   the format used to specify keyboard mappings in the server
   database is not specified by the Xkb extension, although this
   format is one possible example):

   Table 15.1. Example Key Type
   Symbolic Description               Key Type Data Structure
   type "ALPHATHREE" {                Xkb->map->types[i].name
   modifiers = Shift+Lock+LevelThree; Xkb->map->types[i].mods
   map[None]= Level1;                 Xkb->map->types[i].map[0]
   map[Lock]= Level1;                 Xkb->map->types[i].map[1]
   map[Shift]= Level2;                Xkb->map->types[i].map[2]
   map[LevelThree]= Level3;           Xkb->map->types[i].map[3]
   map[Shift+LevelThree]= Level3;     Xkb->map->types[i].map[4]
   preserve[None]= None;              Xkb->map->types[i].perserve[0]
   preserve[Lock]= Lock;              Xkb->map->types[i].preserve[1]
   preserve[Shift]= None;             Xkb->map->types[i].preserve[2]
   preserve[LevelThree]= None;        Xkb->map->types[i].preserve[3]
   preserve[Shift+Level3]= None;      Xkb->map->types[i].preserve[4]
   level_name[Level1]= "Base";        Xkb->map->types[i].level_names[0]
   level_name[Level2]= "Caps";        Xkb->map->types[i].level_names[1]
   level_name[Level3]= "Level3";      Xkb->map->types[i].level_names[2]
   };

   The name of the example key type is "ALPHATHREE," and the
   modifiers it pays attention to are Shift , Lock , and the
   virtual modifier LevelThree . There are three shift levels. The
   name of shift level one is "Base," the name of shift level two
   is "Caps," and the name of shift level three is "Level3."

   Given the combination of the map and preserve specifications,
   there are five map entries. The first map entry specifies that
   shift level one is to be used if no modifiers are set. The
   second entry specifies the Lock modifier alone also yields
   shift level one. The third entry specifies the Shift modifier
   alone yields shift level two. The fourth and fifth entries
   specify that the virtual LevelThree modifier alone, or in
   combination with the Shift modifier, yields shift level three.

Note

   Shift level three can be reached only if the virtual modifier
   LevelThree is bound to a real modifier (see section 16.4). If
   LevelThree is not bound to a real modifier, the map entries
   associated with it are ignored.

   Because the Lock modifier is to be preserved for further event
   processing, the preserve list is not NULL and parallels the map
   list. All preserve entries, except for the one corresponding to
   the map entry that specifies the Lock modifier, do not list any
   modifiers. For the map entry that specifies the Lock modifier,
   the corresponding preserve list entry lists the Lock modifier,
   meaning do not consume the Lock modifier. In this particular
   case, the preserved modifier is passed to Xlib translation
   functions and causes them to notice that the Lock modifier is
   set; consequently, the Xlib functions apply the appropriate
   capitalization rules to the symbol. Because this preserve entry
   is set only for a modifier that yields shift level one, the
   capitalization occurs only for level-one symbols.

The Canonical Key Types

   Xkb allows up to XkbMaxKeyTypes (255) key types to be defined,
   but requires at least XkbNumRequiredTypes (4) predefined types
   to be in a key map. These predefined key types are referred to
   as the canonical key types and describe the types of keys
   available on most keyboards. The definitions for the canonical
   key types are held in the first XkbNumRequiredTypes entries of
   the types field of the client map and are indexed using the
   following constants:
     XkbOneLevelIndex
     XkbTwoLevelIndex
     XkbAlphabeticIndex
     XkbKeypadIndex

ONE_LEVEL

   The ONE_LEVEL key type describes groups that have only one
   symbol. The default ONE_LEVEL key type has no map entries and
   does not pay attention to any modifiers. A symbolic
   representation of this key type could look like the following:

   type "ONE_LEVEL" {
         modifiers = None;
         map[None]= Level1;
         level_name[Level1]= "Any";
   };

   The description of the ONE_LEVEL key type is stored in the
   types [ XkbOneLevelIndex ] entry of the client key map.

TWO_LEVEL

   The TWO_LEVEL key type describes groups that consist of two
   symbols but are neither alphabetic nor numeric keypad keys. The
   default TWO_LEVEL type uses only the Shift modifier. It returns
   shift level two if Shift is set, and level one if it is not. A
   symbolic representation of this key type could look like the
   following:

   type "TWO_LEVEL" {
         modifiers = Shift;
         map[Shift]= Level2;
         level_name[Level1]= "Base";
         level_name[Level2]= "Shift";
   };

   The description of the TWO_LEVEL key type is stored in the
   types [ XkbTwoLevelIndex ] entry of the client key map.

ALPHABETIC

   The ALPHABETIC key type describes groups consisting of two
   symbols: the lowercase form of a symbol followed by the
   uppercase form of the same symbol. The default ALPHABETIC type
   implements locale-sensitive "Shift cancels CapsLock" behavior
   using both the Shift and Lock modifiers as follows:
     * If Shift and Lock are both set, the default ALPHABETIC type
       yields level one.
     * If Shift alone is set, it yields level two.
     * If Lock alone is set, it yields level one, but preserves
       the Lock modifier so Xlib notices and applies the
       appropriate capitalization rules. The Xlib functions are
       locale-sensitive and apply different capitalization rules
       for different locales.
     * If neither Shift nor Lock is set, it yields level one.

   A symbolic representation of this key type could look like the
   following:

   type "ALPHABETIC" {
         modifiers = Shift+Lock;
         map[Shift]= Level2;
         preserve[Lock]= Lock;
         level_name[Level1]= "Base";
         level_name[Level2]= "Caps";
   };

   The description of the ALPHABETIC key type is stored in the
   types [ XkbAlphabeticIndex ] entry of the client key map.

KEYPAD

   The KEYPAD key type describes groups that consist of two
   symbols, at least one of which is a numeric keypad symbol. The
   numeric keypad symbol is assumed to reside at level two. The
   default KEYPAD key type implements "Shift cancels NumLock"
   behavior using the Shift modifier and the real modifier bound
   to the virtual modifier named "NumLock," known as the NumLock
   modifier, as follows:
     * If Shift and NumLock are both set, the default KEYPAD type
       yields level one.
     * If Shift alone is set, it yields level two.
     * If NumLock alone is set, it yields level two.
     * If neither Shift nor NumLock is set, it yields level one.

   A symbolic representation of this key type could look like the
   following:

   type "KEYPAD" {
         modifiers = Shift+NumLock;
         map[None]= Level1;
         map[Shift]= Level2;
         map[NumLock]= Level2;
         map[Shift+NumLock]= Level1;
         level_name[Level1]= "Base";
         level_name[Level2]= "Caps";
   };

   The description of the KEYPAD key type is stored in the types [
   XkbKeypadIndex ] entry of the client key map.

Initializing the Canonical Key Types in a New Client Map

   To set the definitions of the canonical key types in a client
   map to their default values, use XkbInitCanonicalKeyTypes.
   Status XkbInitCanonicalKeyTypes ( xkb, which, keypadVMod )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description containing client map
   to initialize */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of types to initialize */
   int keypadVMod ; /* index of NumLock virtual modifier */

   XkbInitCanonicalKeyTypes initializes the first
   XkbNumRequiredTypes key types of the keyboard specified by the
   xkb parameter to their default values. The which parameter
   specifies what canonical key types to initialize and is a
   bitwise inclusive OR of the following masks: XkbOneLevelMask ,
   XkbTwoLevelMask , XkbAlphabeticMask , and XkbKeypadMask . Only
   those canonical types specified by the which mask are
   initialized.

   If XkbKeypadMask is set in the which parameter,
   XkbInitCanonicalKeyTypes looks up the NumLock named virtual
   modifier to determine which virtual modifier to use when
   initializing the KEYPAD key type. If the NumLock virtual
   modifier does not exist, XkbInitCanonicalKeyTypes creates it.

   XkbInitCanonicalKeyTypes normally returns Success. It returns
   BadAccess if the Xkb extension has not been properly
   initialized, and BadAccess if the xkb parameter is not valid.

Getting Key Types from the Server

   To obtain the list of available key types in the server's
   keyboard mapping, use XkbGetKeyTypes .
   Status XkbGetKeyTypes ( dpy , first , num , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int first ; /* index to first type to get, 0 => 1st
   type */
   unsigned int num ; /* number of key types to be returned */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description containing client map
   to update */

Note

   XkbGetKeyTypes is used to obtain descriptions of the key types
   themselves, not the key types bound to individual keys. To
   obtain the key types bound to an individual key, refer to the
   key_sym_map field of the client map (see section 15.3.1).

   XkbGetKeyTypes queries the server for the desired types, waits
   for a reply, and returns the desired types in the
   xkb->map->types . If successful, it returns Success.

   XkbGetKeyTypes returns BadAccess if the Xkb extension has not
   been properly initialized and BadValue if the combination of
   first and num results in numbers out of valid range.

Changing the Number of Levels in a Key Type

   To change the number of levels in a key type, use
   XkbResizeKeyType .
   Status XkbResizeKeyType ( xkb , type_ndx , map_count ,
   want_preserve , new_num_lvls )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description containing client map
   to update */
   int type_ndx ; /* index in xkb->map->types of type to change */
   int map_count ; /* total # of map entries needed for the type
   */
   Bool want_preserve ; /* True => list of preserved modifiers is
   necessary */
   int new_num_lvls ; /* new max # of levels for type */

   XkbResizeKeyType changes the type specified by xkb ->
   map->types [ type_ndx ], and reallocates the symbols and
   actions bound to all keys that use the type, if necessary.
   XkbResizeKeyType updates only the local copy of the types in
   xkb ; to update the server's copy for the physical device, use
   XkbSetMap or XkbChangeMap after calling XkbResizeKeyType .

   The map_count parameter specifies the total number of map
   entries needed for the type, and can be zero or greater. If
   map_count is zero, XkbResizeKeyType frees the existing map and
   preserve entries for the type if they exist and sets them to
   NULL .

   The want_preserve parameter specifies whether a preserve list
   for the key should be created. If want_preserve is True , the
   preserve list with map_count entries is allocated or
   reallocated if it already exists. Otherwise, if want_preserve
   is False , the preserve field is freed if necessary and set to
   NULL .

   The new_num_lvls parameter specifies the new maximum number of
   shift levels for the type and is used to calculate and resize
   the symbols and actions bound to all keys that use the type.

   If type_ndx does not specify a legal type, new_num_lvls is less
   than 1, or the map_count is less than zero, XkbResizeKeyType
   returns BadValue . If XkbResizeKeyType encounters any problems
   with allocation, it returns BadAlloc . Otherwise, it returns
   Success .

Copying Key Types

   Use XkbCopyKeyType and XkbCopyKeyTypes to copy one or more
   XkbKeyTypeRec structures.
   Status XkbCopyKeyType ( from , into )
   XkbKeyTypePtr from ; /* pointer to XkbKeyTypeRec to be copied
   */
   XkbKeyTypePtr into ; /* pointer to XkbKeyTypeRec to be changed
   */

   XkbCopyKeyType copies the key type specified by from to the key
   type specified by into . Both must point to legal XkbKeyTypeRec
   structures. Xkb assumes from and into point to different
   places. As a result, overlaps can be fatal. XkbCopyKeyType
   frees any existing map , preserve , and level_names in into
   prior to copying. If any allocation errors occur while copying
   from to into , XkbCopyKeyType returns BadAlloc . Otherwise,
   XkbCopyKeyType copies from to into and returns Success .
   Status XkbCopyKeyTypes ( from , into , num_types )
   XkbKeyTypePtr from ; /* pointer to array of XkbKeyTypeRecs to
   copy */
   XkbKeyTypePtr into ; /* pointer to array of XkbKeyTypeRecs to
   change */
   int num_types ; /* number of types to copy */

   XkbCopyKeyTypes copies num_types XkbKeyTypeRec structures from
   the array specified by from into the array specified by into .
   It is intended for copying between, rather than within,
   keyboard descriptions, so it doesn't check for overlaps. The
   same rules that apply to the from and into parameters in
   XkbCopyKeyType apply to each entry of the from and into arrays
   of XkbCopyKeyTypes . If any allocation errors occur while
   copying from to into , XkbCopyKeyTypes returns BadAlloc .
   Otherwise, XkbCopyKeyTypes copies from to into and returns
   Success .

Key Symbol Map

   The entire list of key symbols for the keyboard mapping is held
   in the syms field of the client map. Whereas the core keyboard
   mapping is a two-dimensional array of KeySyms whose rows are
   indexed by keycode, the syms field of Xkb is a linear list of
   KeySyms that needs to be indexed uniquely for each key. This
   section describes the key symbol map and the methods for
   determining the symbols bound to a key.

   The reason the syms field is a linear list of KeySyms is to
   reduce the memory consumption associated with a keymap; because
   Xkb allows individual keys to have multiple shift levels and a
   different number of groups per key, a single two-dimensional
   array of KeySyms would potentially be very large and sparse.
   Instead, Xkb provides a small two-dimensional array of KeySyms
   for each key. To store all of these individual arrays, Xkb
   concatenates each array together in the syms field of the
   client map.

   In order to determine which KeySyms in the syms field are
   associated with each keycode, the client map contains an array
   of key symbol mappings, held in the key_sym_map field. The
   key_sym_map field is an array of XkbSymMapRec structures
   indexed by keycode. The key_sym_map array has min_key_code
   unused entries at the start to allow direct indexing using a
   keycode. All keycodes falling between the minimum and maximum
   legal keycodes, inclusive, have key_sym_map arrays, whether or
   not any key actually yields that code. The KeySymMapRec
   structure is defined as follows:
#define XkbNumKbdGroups            4
#define XkbMaxKbdGroup            (XkbNumKbdGroups-1)

typedef struct {                                   /* map to keysyms for
 a single keycode */
      unsigned char     kt_index[XkbNumKbdGroups]; /* key type index for
 each group */
      unsigned char     group_info;                /* # of groups and ou
t of range group handling */
      unsigned char     width;                     /* max # of shift lev
els for key */
      unsigned short    offset;                    /* index to keysym ta
ble in  syms array */
} XkbSymMapRec, *XkbSymMapPtr;

   These fields are described in detail in the following sections.

Per-Key Key Type Indices

   The kt_index array of the XkbSymMapRec structure contains the
   indices of the key types (see section 15.2) for each possible
   group of symbols associated with the key. To obtain the index
   of a key type or the pointer to a key type, Xkb provides the
   following macros, to access the key types:

Note

   The array of key types is of fixed width and is large enough to
   hold key types for the maximum legal number of groups (
   XkbNumKbdGroups , currently four); if a key has fewer than
   XkbNumKbdGroups groups, the extra key types are reported but
   ignored.
   int XkbKeyTypeIndex ( xkb, keycode, group ) /* macro*/
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */
   int group ; /* group index */

   XkbKeyTypeIndex computes an index into the types vector of the
   client map in xkb from the given keycode and group index.
   XkbKeyTypePtr XkbKeyType ( xkb, keycode, group ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */
   int group ; /* group index */

   XkbKeyType returns a pointer to the key type in the types
   vector of the client map in xkb corresponding to the given
   keycode and group index.

Per-Key Group Information

   The group_info field of an XkbSymMapRec is an encoded value
   containing the number of groups of symbols bound to the key as
   well as the specification of the treatment of out-of-range
   groups. It is legal for a key to have zero groups, in which
   case it also has zero symbols and all events from that key
   yield NoSymbol . To obtain the number of groups of symbols
   bound to the key, use XkbKeyNumGroups . To change the number of
   groups bound to a key, use XkbChangeTypesOfKey (see section
   15.3.6). To obtain a mask that determines the treatment of
   out-of-range groups, use XkbKeyGroupInfo and
   XkbOutOfRangeGroupInfo .

   The keyboard controls (see Chapter 10) contain a groups_wrap
   field specifying the handling of illegal groups on a global
   basis. That is, when the user performs an action causing the
   effective group to go out of the legal range, the groups_wrap
   field specifies how to normalize the effective keyboard group
   to a group that is legal for the keyboard as a whole, but there
   is no guarantee that the normalized group will be within the
   range of legal groups for any individual key. The per-key
   group_info field specifies how a key treats a legal effective
   group if the key does not have a type specified for the group
   of concern. For example, the Enter key usually has just one
   group defined. If the user performs an action causing the
   global keyboard group to change to Group2 , the group_info
   field for the Enter key describes how to handle this situation.

   Out-of-range groups for individual keys are mapped to a legal
   group using the same options as are used for the overall
   keyboard group. The particular type of mapping used is
   controlled by the bits set in the group_info flag, as shown in
   Table 15.2. See section 10.7.1 for more details on the
   normalization methods in this table.

   Table 15.2. group_info Range Normalization
   Bits set in group_info Normalization method
   XkbRedirectIntoRange   XkbRedirectIntoRange
   XkbClampIntoRange      XkbClampIntoRange
   none of the above      XkbWrapIntoRange

   Xkb provides the following macros to access group information:
   int XkbKeyNumGroups ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeyNumGroups returns the number of groups of symbols bound
   to the key corresponding to keycode .
   unsigned char XkbKeyGroupInfo ( xkb, keycode ) /*macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeyGroupInfo returns the group_info field from the
   XkbSymMapRec structure associated with the key corresponding to
   keycode .
   unsigned char XkbOutOfRangeGroupInfo ( grp_inf ) /* macro */
   unsigned char grp_inf ; /* group_info field of XkbSymMapRec */

   XkbOutOfRangeGroupInfo returns only the out-of-range processing
   information from the group_info field of an XkbSymMapRec
   structure.
   unsigned char XkbOutOfRangeGroupNumber ( grp_inf ) /* macro */
   unsigned char grp_inf ; /* group_info field of XkbSymMapRec */

   XkbOutOfRangeGroupNumber returns the out-of-range group number,
   represented as a group index, from the group_info field of an
   XkbSymMapRec structure.

Key Width

   The maximum number of shift levels for a type is also referred
   to as the width of a key type. The width field of the
   key_sym_map entry for a key contains the width of the widest
   type associated with the key. The width field cannot be
   explicitly changed; it is updated automatically whenever the
   symbols or set of types bound to a key are changed.

Offset in to the Symbol Map

   The key width and number of groups associated with a key are
   used to form a small two-dimensional array of KeySyms for a
   key. This array may be different sizes for different keys. The
   array for a single key is stored as a linear list, in row-major
   order. The arrays for all of the keys are stored in the syms
   field of the client map. There is one row for each group
   associated with a key and one column for each level. The index
   corresponding to a given group and shift level is computed as:

        idx = group_index * key_width + shift_level

   The offset field of the key_sym_map entry for a key is used to
   access the beginning of the array.

   Xkb provides the following macros for accessing the width and
   offset for individual keys, as well as macros for accessing the
   two-dimensional array of symbols bound to the key:
   int XkbKeyGroupsWidth ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeyGroupsWidth computes the maximum width associated with
   the key corresponding to keycode .
   int XkbKeyGroupWidth ( xkb, keycode, grp ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */
   int grp ; /* group of interest */

   XkbKeyGroupWidth computes the width of the type associated with
   the group grp for the key corresponding to keycode .
   int XkbKeySymsOffset ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeySymsOffset returns the offset of the two-dimensional
   array of keysyms for the key corresponding to keycode .
   int XkbKeyNumSyms ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeyNumSyms returns the total number of keysyms for the key
   corresponding to keycode .
   KeySym * XkbKeySymsPtr ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeySymsPtr returns the pointer to the two-dimensional array
   of keysyms for the key corresponding to keycode .
   KeySym XkbKeySymEntry ( xkb, keycode, shift, grp ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */
   int shift ; /* shift level of interest */
   int grp ; /* group of interest */

   XkbKeySymEntry returns the keysym corresponding to shift level
   shift and group grp from the two-dimensional array of keysyms
   for the key corresponding to keycode

Getting the Symbol Map for Keys from the Server

   To obtain the symbols for a subset of the keys in a keyboard
   description, use XkbGetKeySyms :
   Status XkbGetKeySyms ( dpy , first , num , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int first ; /* keycode of first key to get */
   unsigned int num ; /* number of keycodes for which syms desired
   */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description to be updated */

   XkbGetKeySyms sends a request to the server to obtain the set
   of keysyms bound to num keys starting with the key whose
   keycode is first . It waits for a reply and returns the keysyms
   in the map.syms field of xkb . If successful, XkbGetKeySyms
   returns Success . The xkb parameter must be a pointer to a
   valid Xkb keyboard description.

   If the client map in the xkb parameter has not been allocated,
   XkbGetKeySyms allocates and initializes it before obtaining the
   symbols.

   If a compatible version of Xkb is not available in the server
   or the Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetKeySyms returns BadAccess . If num is less than 1 or
   greater than XkbMaxKeyCount , XkbGetKeySyms returns BadValue .
   If any allocation errors occur, XkbGetKeySyms returns BadAlloc
   .

Changing the Number of Groups and Types Bound to a Key

   To change the number of groups and the types bound to a key,
   use XkbChangeTypesOfKey .

   Status XkbChangeTypesOfKey ( xkb , key , n_groups , groups ,
   new_types_in , p_changes )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to be changed */
   int key ; /* keycode for key of interest */
   int n_groups ; /* new number of groups for key */
   unsigned int groups ; /* mask indicating groups to change */
   int * new_types_in ; /* indices for new groups specified in
   groups */
   XkbMapChangesPtr p_changes ; /* notes changes made to xkb */

   XkbChangeTypesOfKey reallocates the symbols and actions bound
   to the key, if necessary, and initializes any new symbols or
   actions to NoSymbol or NoAction , as appropriate. If the
   p_changes parameter is not NULL , XkbChangeTypesOfKey adds the
   XkbKeySymsMask to the changes field of p_changes and modifies
   the first_key_sym and num_key_syms fields of p_changes to
   include the key that was changed. See section 14.3.1 for more
   information on the XkbMapChangesPtr structure. If successful,
   XkbChangeTypesOfKey returns Success .

   The n_groups parameter specifies the new number of groups for
   the key. The groups parameter is a mask specifying the groups
   for which new types are supplied and is a bitwise inclusive OR
   of the following masks: XkbGroup1Mask , XkbGroup2Mask ,
   XkbGroup3Mask , and XkbGroup4Mask .

   The new_types_in parameter is an integer array of length
   n_groups . Each entry represents the type to use for the
   associated group and is an index into xkb -> map->types . The
   new_types_in array is indexed by group index; if n_groups is
   four and groups only has Group1Mask and Group3Mask set,
   new_types_in looks like this:

        new_types_in[0] = type for Group1
        new_types_in[1] = ignored
        new_types_in[2] = type for Group3
        new_types_in[3] = ignored

   For convenience, Xkb provides the following constants to use as
   indices to the groups:

   Table 15.3. Group Index Constants
   Constant Name  Value
   XkbGroup1Index 0
   XkbGroup2Index 1
   XkbGroup3Index 2
   XkbGroup4Index 3

   If the Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbChangeTypesOfKey returns BadAccess . If the xkb parameter it
   not valid (that is, it is NULL or it does not contain a valid
   client map), XkbChangeTypesOfKey returns Bad Match. If the key
   is not a valid keycode, n_groups is greater than
   XkbNumKbdGroups , or the groups mask does not contain any of
   the valid group mask bits, XkbChangeTypesOfKey returns BadValue
   . If it is necessary to resize the key symbols or key actions
   arrays and any allocation errors occur, XkbChangeTypesOfKey
   returns BadAlloc .

Changing the Number of Symbols Bound to a Key

   To change the number of symbols bound to a key, use
   XkbResizeKeySyms .
   KeySym * XkbResizeKeySyms ( xkb , key , needed )
   XkbDescRec * xkb ; /* keyboard description to be changed */
   int key ; /* keycode for key to modify */
   int needed ; /* new number of keysyms required for key */

   XkbResizeKeySyms reserves the space needed for needed keysyms
   and returns a pointer to the beginning of the new array that
   holds the keysyms. It adjusts the offset field of the
   key_sym_map entry for the key if necessary and can also change
   the syms , num_syms , and size_syms fields of xkb - >map if it
   is necessary to reallocate the syms array. XkbResizeKeySyms
   does not modify either the width or number of groups associated
   with the key.

   If needed is greater than the current number of keysyms for the
   key, XkbResizeKeySyms initializes all new keysyms in the array
   to NoSymbol .

   Because the number of symbols needed by a key is normally
   computed as width * number of groups, and XkbResizeKeySyms does
   not modify either the width or number of groups for the key, a
   discrepancy exists upon return from XkbResizeKeySyms between
   the space allocated for the keysyms and the number required.
   The unused entries in the list of symbols returned by
   XkbResizeKeySyms are not preserved across future calls to any
   of the map editing functions, so you must update the key symbol
   mapping (which updates the width and number of groups for the
   key) before calling another allocator function. A call to
   XkbChangeTypesOfKey will update the mapping.

   If any allocation errors occur while resizing the number of
   symbols bound to the key, XkbResizeKeySyms returns NULL .

Note

   A change to the number of symbols bound to a key should be
   accompanied by a change in the number of actions bound to a
   key. Refer to section 16.1.16 for more information on changing
   the number of actions bound to a key.

The Per-Key Modifier Map

   The modmap entry of the client map is an array, indexed by
   keycode, specifying the real modifiers bound to a key. Each
   entry is a mask composed of a bitwise inclusive OR of the legal
   real modifiers: ShiftMask , LockMask , ControlMask , Mod1Mask ,
   Mod2Mask , Mod3Mask , Mod4Mask , and Mod5Mask . If a bit is set
   in a modmap entry, the corresponding key is bound to that
   modifier.

   Pressing or releasing the key bound to a modifier changes the
   modifier set and unset state. The particular manner in which
   the modifier set and unset state changes is determined by the
   behavior and actions assigned to the key (see Chapter 16).

Getting the Per-Key Modifier Map from the Server

   To update the modifier map for one or more of the keys in a
   keyboard description, use XkbGetKeyModifierMap .
   Status XkbGetKeyModifierMap ( dpy , first , num , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int first ; /* keycode of first key to get */
   unsigned int num ; /* number of keys for which information is
   desired */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to update */

   XkbGetKeyModifierMap sends a request to the server for the
   modifier mappings for num keys starting with the key whose
   keycode is first . It waits for a reply and places the results
   in the xkb ->map->modmap array. If successful,
   XkbGetKeyModifier returns Success .

   If the map component of the xkb parameter has not been
   allocated, XkbGetKeyModifierMap allocates and initializes it.

   If a compatible version of Xkb is not available in the server
   or the Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetKeySyms returns BadAccess . If any allocation errors
   occur while obtaining the modifier map, XkbGetKeyModifierMap
   returns BadAlloc .

Chapter 16. Xkb Server Keyboard Mapping

   Table of Contents

   Key Actions

        The XkbAction Structure
        The XkbAnyAction Structure
        Actions for Changing Modifiers' State
        Actions for Changing Group State
        Actions for Moving the Pointer
        Actions for Simulating Pointer Button Press and Release
        Actions for Changing the Pointer Button Simulated
        Actions for Locking Modifiers and Group
        Actions for Changing the Active Screen
        Actions for Changing Boolean Controls State
        Actions for Generating Messages
        Actions for Generating a Different Keycode
        Actions for Generating DeviceButtonPress and
                DeviceButtonRelease

        Actions for Simulating Events from Device Valuators
        Obtaining Key Actions for Keys from the Server
        Changing the Number of Actions Bound to a Key

   Key Behavior

        Radio Groups
        The XkbBehavior Structure
        Obtaining Key Behaviors for Keys from the Server

   Explicit Components--Avoiding Automatic Remapping by the Server

        Obtaining Explicit Components for Keys from the Server

   Virtual Modifier Mapping

        Obtaining Virtual Modifier Bindings from the Server
        Obtaining Per-Key Virtual Modifier Mappings from the
                Server

   The server field of the complete Xkb keyboard description (see
   section 6.1) is a pointer to the Xkb server map.

   Figure 16.1 shows the relationships between elements in the
   server map:
   Server Map Relationships

   The Xkb server map contains the information the server needs to
   interpret key events and is of type XkbServerMapRec :
#define XkbNumVirtualMods            16

typedef struct {                         /* Server Map */
      unsigned short     num_acts;       /* # of occupied entries in  ac
ts */
      unsigned short     size_acts;      /* # of entries in  acts */
      XkbAction *        acts;           /* linear 2d tables of key acti
ons, 1 per keycode */
      XkbBehavior *      behaviors;      /* key behaviors,1 per keycode
*/
      unsigned short *   key_acts;       /* index into  acts , 1 per key
code */
      unsigned char *    explicit;       /* explicit overrides of core r
emapping, 1 per key */
      unsigned char      vmods[XkbNumVirtualMods];  /* real mods bound t
o virtual mods */
      unsigned short *   vmodmap;        /* virtual mods bound to key, 1
 per keycode*/
} XkbServerMapRec, *XkbServerMapPtr;

   The num_acts , size_acts , acts , and key_acts fields specify
   the key actions, defined in section 16.1. The behaviors field
   describes the behavior for each key and is defined in section
   16.2. The explicit field describes the explicit components for
   a key and is defined in section 16.3. The vmods and the vmodmap
   fields describe the virtual modifiers and the per-key virtual
   modifier mapping and are defined in section 16.4.

Key Actions

   A key action defines the effect key presses and releases have
   on the internal state of the server. For example, the expected
   key action associated with pressing the Shift key is to set the
   Shift modifier. There is zero or one key action associated with
   each keysym bound to each key.

   Just as the entire list of key symbols for the keyboard mapping
   is held in the syms field of the client map, the entire list of
   key actions for the keyboard mapping is held in the acts array
   of the server map. The total size of acts is specified by
   size_acts , and the number of entries is specified by num_acts.

   The key_acts array, indexed by keycode, describes the actions
   associated with a key. The key_acts array has min_key_code
   unused entries at the start to allow direct indexing using a
   keycode. If a key_acts entry is zero , it means the key does
   not have any actions associated with it. If an entry is not
   zero , the entry represents an index into the acts field of the
   server map, much as the offset field of a KeySymMapRec
   structure is an index into the syms field of the client map.

   The reason the acts field is a linear list of XkbAction s is to
   reduce the memory consumption associated with a keymap. Because
   Xkb allows individual keys to have multiple shift levels and a
   different number of groups per key, a single two-dimensional
   array of KeySyms would potentially be very large and sparse.
   Instead, Xkb provides a small two-dimensional array of
   XkbAction s for each key. To store all of these individual
   arrays, Xkb concatenates each array together in the acts field
   of the server map.

   The key action structures consist only of fields of type char
   or unsigned char. This is done to optimize data transfer when
   the server sends bytes over the wire. If the fields are
   anything but bytes, the server has to sift through all of the
   actions and swap any nonbyte fields. Because they consist of
   nothing but bytes, it can just copy them out.

   Xkb provides the following macros, to simplify accessing
   information pertaining to key actions:
   Bool XkbKeyHasActions ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeyHasActions returns True if the key corresponding to
   keycode has any actions associated with it; otherwise, it
   returns False .
   int XkbKeyNumActions ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeyNumActions computes the number of actions associated with
   the key corresponding to keycode . This should be the same
   value as the result of XkbKeyNumSyms (see section 15.3.3).
   XkbKeyActionPtr XkbKeyActionsPtr ( xkb, keycode ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */

   XkbKeyActionsPtr returns a pointer to the two-dimensional array
   of key actions associated with the key corresponding to keycode
   . Use XkbKeyActionsPtr only if the key actually has some
   actions associated with it, that is, XkbKeyNumActions (xkb,
   keycode) returns something greater than zero.
   XkbAction XkbKeyAction ( xkb, keycode, idx ) /* macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */
   int idx ; /* index for group and shift level */

   XkbKeyAction returns the key action indexed by idx in the
   two-dimensional array of key actions associated with the key
   corresponding to keycode . idx may be computed from the group
   and shift level of interest as follows:

        idx = group_index * key_width + shift_level
   XkbAction XkbKeyActionEntry ( xkb, keycode, shift, grp ) /*
   macro */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description of interest */
   KeyCode keycode ; /* keycode of interest */
   int shift ; /* shift level within group */
   int grp ; /* group index for group of interest */

   XkbKeyActionEntry returns the key action corresponding to group
   grp and shift level lvl from the two-dimensional table of key
   actions associated with the key corresponding to keycode .

The XkbAction Structure

   The description for an action is held in an XkbAction
   structure, which is a union of all possible Xkb action types:
typedef union _XkbAction {
      XkbAnyAction              any;
      XkbModAction              mods;
      XkbGroupAction            group;
      XkbISOAction              iso;
      XkbPtrAction              ptr;
      XkbPtrBtnAction           btn;
      XkbPtrDfltAction          dflt;
      XkbSwitchScreenAction     screen;
      XkbCtrlsAction            ctrls;
      XkbMessageAction          msg;
      XkbRedirectKeyAction      redirect;
      XkbDeviceBtnAction        devbtn;
      XkbDeviceValuatorAction   devval;
      unsigned char             type;
} XkbAction;

   The type field is provided for convenience and is the same as
   the type field in the individual structures. The following
   sections describe the individual structures for each action in
   detail.

The XkbAnyAction Structure

   The XkbAnyAction structure is a convenience structure that
   refers to any of the actions:
#define      XkbAnyActionDataSize       7

typedef struct _XkbAnyAction {
   unsigned char    type;            /* type of action; determines inter
pretation for data */
   unsigned char    data[XkbAnyActionDataSize];
} XkbAnyAction;

   The data field represents a structure for an action, and its
   interpretation depends on the type field. The valid values for
   the type field, and the data structures associated with them
   are shown in Table 16.1:

   Table 16.1. Action Types
   Type Structure for Data XkbAction Union Member Section
   XkbSA_NoAction XkbSA_NoAction means the server does not perform
   an action for the key; this action does not have an associated
   data structure. any

   XkbSA_SetMods

   XkbSA_LatchMods

   XkbSA_LockMods

   XkbModAction
   mods 16.1.3

   XkbSA_SetGroup

   XkbSA_LatchGroup

   XkbSA_LockGroup
   XkbGroupAction group 16.1.4
   XkbSA_MovePtr XkbPtrAction ptr 16.1.5

   XKbSA_PtrBtn

   XkbSA_LockPtrBtn
   XkbPtrBtnAction btn 16.1.6
   XkbSA_SetPtrDflt XkbPtrDfltAction dflt 16.1.7
   XkbSA_ISOLock XkbISOAction iso 16.1.8
   XkbSA_SwitchScreen XkbSwitchScreenAction screen 16.1.9

   XkbSA_SetControls

   XkbSA_LockControls
   XkbCtrlsAction ctrls 16.1.10
   XkbSA_ActionMessage XkbMessgeAction msg 16.1.11
   XkbSA_RedirectKey XkbRedirectKeyAction redirect 16.1.12

   XkbSA_DeviceBtn

   XKbSA_LockDeviceBtn
   XkbDeviceBtnAction devbtn 16.1.13
   XkbSA_DeviceValuator XkbDeviceValuatorAction devval 16.1.14

Actions for Changing Modifiers' State

   Actions associated with the XkbModAction structure change the
   state of the modifiers when keys are pressed and released (see
   Chapter 7 for a discussion of modifiers):
typedef struct _XkbModAction {
      unsigned char     type;         /*  XkbSA_{Set|Latch|Lock}Mods */
      unsigned char     flags;        /* with  type , controls the effec
t on modifiers */
      unsigned char     mask;         /* same as  mask field of a modifi
er description */
      unsigned char     real_mods;    /* same as  real_mods field of a m
odifier description */
      unsigned char     vmods1;       /* derived from  vmods field of a
modifier description */
      unsigned char     vmods2;       /* derived from  vmods field of a
modifier description */
} XkbModAction;

   In the following description, the term action modifiers means
   the real modifier bits associated with this action. Depending
   on the value of flags (see Table 16.3), these are designated
   either in the mask field of the XkbModAction structure itself
   or the real modifiers bound to the key for which the action is
   being used. In the latter case, this is the client map ->
   modmap [ keycode ] field.

   The type field can have any of the values shown in Table 16.2.

   Table 16.2. Modifier Action Types
   Type            Effect
   XkbSA_SetMods
     * A key press adds any action modifiers to the keyboard's
       base modifiers.
     * A key release clears any action modifiers in the keyboard's
       base modifiers, provided no other key affecting the same
       modifiers is logically down.
     * If no other keys are physically depressed when this key is
       released, and XkbSA_ClearLocks is set in the flags field,
       the key release unlocks any action modifiers.

   XkbSA_LatchMods
     * Key press and key release events have the same effect as
       for XkbSA_SetMods ; if no keys are physically depressed
       when this key is released, key release events have the
       following additional effects:
     * Modifiers unlocked due to XkbSA_ClearLocks have no further
       effect.
     * If XkbSA_LatchToLock is set in the flags field, a key
       release locks and then unlatches any remaining action
       modifiers that are already latched.
     * A key release latches any action modifiers not used by the
       XkbSA_ClearLocks and XkbSA_LatchToLock flags.

   XkbSA_LockMods
     * A key press sets the base state of any action modifiers. If
       XkbSA_LockNoLock is set in the flags field, a key press
       also sets the locked state of any action modifiers.
     * A key release clears any action modifiers in the keyboard's
       base modifiers, provided no other key that affects the same
       modifiers is down. If XkbSA_LockNoUnlock is not set in the
       flags field, and any of the action modifiers were locked
       before the corresponding key press occurred, a key release
       unlocks them.

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks shown in Table 16.3. A general meaning is given in the
   table, but the exact meaning depends on the action type.

   Table 16.3. Modifier Action Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_UseModMapMods If set, the action modifiers are determined
   by the modifiers bound by the modifier mapping of the key.
   Otherwise, the action modifiers are set to the modifiers
   specified by the mask , real_mods , vmod1 , and vmod2 fields.
   XkbSA_ClearLocks If set and no keys are physically depressed
   when this key transition occurs, the server unlocks any action
   modifiers.
   XkbSA_LatchToLock If set, and the action type is
   XkbSA_LatchMods , the server locks the action modifiers if they
   are already latched.
   XkbSA_LockNoLock If set, and the action type is XkbSA_LockMods
   , the server only unlocks the action modifiers.
   XkbSA_LockNoUnlock If set, and the action is XkbSA_LockMods ,
   the server only locks the action modifiers.

   If XkbSA_UseModMapMods is not set in the flags field, the mask
   , real_mods , vmods1 , and vmods2 fields are used to determine
   the action modifiers. Otherwise they are ignored and the
   modifiers bound to the key (client map -> modmap [ keycode ])
   are used instead.

   The mask , real_mods , vmods1 , and vmods2 fields represent the
   components of an Xkb modifier description (see section 7.2).
   While the mask and real_mods fields correspond directly to the
   mask and real_mods fields of an Xkb modifier description, the
   vmods1 and vmods2 fields are combined to correspond to the
   vmods field of an Xkb modifier description. Xkb provides the
   following macros, to convert between the two formats:
   unsigned short XkbModActionVMods ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbAction act ; /* action from which to extract virtual mods */

   XkbModActionVMods returns the vmods1 and vmods2 fields of act
   converted to the vmods format of an Xkb modifier description.
   void XkbSetModActionVMods ( act, vmods ) /* macro */
   XkbAction act ; /* action in which to set vmods */
   unsigned short vmods ; /* virtual mods to set */

   XkbSetModActionVMods sets the vmods1 and vmods2 fields of act
   using the vmods format of an Xkb modifier description.

Note

   Despite the fact that the first parameter of these two macros
   is of type XkbAction, these macros may be used only with
   Actions of type XkbModAction and XkbISOAction .

Actions for Changing Group State

   Actions associated with the XkbGroupAction structure change the
   current group state when keys are pressed and released (see
   Chapter 5 for a description of groups and keyboard state):
typedef struct _XkbGroupAction {
      unsigned char   type;       /*  XkbSA_{Set|Latch|Lock}Group */
      unsigned char   flags;      /* with  type , controls the effect on
 groups */
      char            group_XXX;  /* represents a group index or delta *
/
} XkbGroupAction;

   The type field can have any of the following values:

   Table 16.4. Group Action Types
   Type             Effect
   XkbSA_SetGroup
     * If the XkbSA_GroupAbsolute bit is set in the flags field,
       key press events change the base keyboard group to the
       group specified by the group_XXX field. Otherwise, key
       press events change the base keyboard group by adding the
       group_XXX field to the base keyboard group. In either case,
       the resulting effective keyboard group is brought back into
       range depending on the value of the groups_wrap field of
       the controls structure (see section 10.7.1).
     * If a key with an XkbSA_ISOLock action (see section 16.1.8)
       is pressed while this key is down, the key release of this
       key has no effect. Otherwise, the key release cancels the
       effects of the key press.
     * If the XkbSA_ClearLocks bit is set in the flags field, and
       no keys are physically depressed when this key is released,
       the key release also sets the locked keyboard group to
       Group1 .

   XkbSA_LatchGroup
     * Key press and key release events have the same effect as
       for XkbSA_SetGroup ; if no keys are physically depressed
       when this key is released, key release events have the
       following additional effects.
     * If the XkbSA_LatchToLock bit is set in the flags field and
       the latched keyboard group index is nonzero, the key
       release adds the delta applied by the corresponding key
       press to the locked keyboard group and subtracts it from
       the latched keyboard group. The locked and effective
       keyboard group are brought back into range according to the
       value of the groups_wrap field of the controls structure.
     * Otherwise, the key press adds the key press delta to the
       latched keyboard group.

   XkbSA_LockGroup
     * If the XkbSA_GroupAbsolute is set in the flags field, key
       press events set the locked keyboard group to the group
       specified by the group_XXX field. Otherwise, key press
       events add the group specified by the group_XXX field to
       the locked keyboard group. In either case, the resulting
       locked and effective keyboard groups are brought back into
       range depending on the value of the groups_wrap field of
       the controls structure.
     * A key release has no effect.

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks shown in Table 16.5. A general meaning is given in the
   table, but the exact meaning depends on the action type .

   Table 16.5. Group Action Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_ClearLocks If set and no keys are physically depressed
   when this key transition occurs, the server sets the locked
   keyboard group to Group1 on a key release.
   XkbSA_LatchToLock If set, and the action type is SA_LatchGroup
   , the server locks the action group if it is already latched.
   XkbSA_GroupAbsolute If set, the group_XXX field represents an
   absolute group number. Otherwise, it represents a group delta
   to be added to the current group to determine the new group
   number.

   The group_XXX field represents a signed character. Xkb provides
   the following macros to convert between a signed integer value
   and a signed character:
   int XkbSAGroup ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbAction act ; /* action from which to extract group */

   XkbSAGroup returns the group_XXX field of act converted to a
   signed int.
   void XkbSASetGroup ( act, grp ) /* macro */
   XkbAction act ; /* action from which to set group */
   int grp ; /* group index to set in group_XXX */

   XkbSASetGroup sets the group_XXX field of act from the group
   index grp .

Note

   Despite the fact that the first parameter of these two macros
   is of type XkbAction, these macros may only be used with
   Actions of type XkbGroupAction and XkbISOAction .

Actions for Moving the Pointer

   Actions associated with the XkbPtrAction structure move the
   pointer when keys are pressed and released:
typedef struct _XkbPtrAction {
      unsigned char      type;      /*  XkbSA_MovePtr */
      unsigned char      flags;     /* determines type of pointer motion
 */
      unsigned char      high_XXX;  /* x coordinate, high bits*/
      unsigned char      low_XXX;   /* y coordinate, low bits */
      unsigned char      high_YYY;  /* x coordinate, high bits */
      unsigned char      low_YYY;   /* y coordinate, low bits */
} XkbPtrAction;

   If the MouseKeys control is not enabled (see section 10.5.1),
   KeyPress and KeyRelease events are treated as though the action
   is XkbSA_NoAction.

   If the MouseKeys control is enabled, a server action of type
   XkbSA_MovePtr instructs the server to generate core pointer
   MotionNotify events rather than the usual KeyPress event, and
   the corresponding KeyRelease event disables any mouse keys
   timers that were created as a result of handling the
   XkbSA_MovePtr action.

   The type field of the XkbPtrAction structure is always
   XkbSA_MovePtr .

   The flags field is a bitwise inclusive OR of the masks shown in
   Table 16.6.

   Table 16.6. Pointer Action Types
   Action Type Meaning
   XkbSA_NoAcceleration If not set, and the MouseKeysAccel control
   is enabled (see section 10.5.2), the KeyPress initiates a mouse
   keys timer for this key; every time the timer expires, the
   cursor moves.
   XkbSA_MoveAbsoluteX If set, the X portion of the structure
   specifies the new pointer X coordinate. Otherwise, the X
   portion is added to the current pointer X coordinate to
   determine the new pointer X coordinate.
   XkbSA_MoveAbsoluteY If set, the Y portion of the structure
   specifies the new pointer Y coordinate. Otherwise, the Y
   portion is added to the current pointer Y coordinate to
   determine the new pointer Y coordinate.

   Each of the X and Y coordinantes of the XkbPtrAction structure
   is composed of two signed 16-bit values, that is, the X
   coordinate is composed of high_XXX and low_XXX , and similarly
   for the Y coordinate. Xkb provides the following macros, to
   convert between a signed integer and two signed 16-bit values
   in XkbPtrAction structures:
   int XkbPtrActionX ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbPtrAction act ; /* action from which to extract X */

   XkbPtrActionX returns the high_XXX and low_XXX fields of act
   converted to a signed int.
   int XkbPtrActionY ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbPtrAction act ; /* action from which to extract Y */

   XkbPtrActionY returns the high_YYY and low_YYY fields of act
   converted to a signed int.
   void XkbSetPtrActionX ( act , x ) /* macro */
   XkbPtrAction act ; /* action in which to set X */
   int x; /* new value to set */

   XkbSetPtrActionX sets the high_XXX and low_XXX fields of act
   from the signed integer value x .
   void XkbSetPtrActionY ( act, y ) /* macro */
   XkbPtrAction act ; /* action in which to set Y */
   int y ; /* new value to set */

   XkbSetPtrActionX sets the high_YYY and low_YYY fields of act
   from the signed integer value y .

Actions for Simulating Pointer Button Press and Release

   Actions associated with the XkbPtrBtnAction structure simulate
   the press and release of pointer buttons when keys are pressed
   and released:
typedef struct _XkbPtrBtnAction {
      unsigned char   type;     /* XkbSA_PtrBtn, XkbSA_LockPtrBtn */
      unsigned char   flags;    /* with  type , controls the effect on p
ointer buttons*/
      unsigned char   count;    /* controls number of ButtonPress and Bu
ttonRelease events */
      unsigned char   button;   /* pointer button to simulate */
} XkbPtrBtnAction;

   If the MouseKeys (see section 10.5.1) control is not enabled,
   KeyPress and KeyRelease events are treated as though the action
   is XkbSA_NoAction .

   The type field can have any one of the values shown in Table
   16.7.

   Table 16.7. Pointer Button Action Types
   Type             Effect
   XkbSA_PtrBtn
     * If XkbSA_UseDfltButton is set in the flags field, the event
       is generated for the pointer button specified by the
       mk_dflt_btn attribute of the MouseKeys control (see section
       10.5.1). Otherwise, the event is generated for the button
       specified by the button field.
     * If the mouse button specified for this action is logically
       down, the key press and corresponding key release are
       ignored and have no effect. Otherwise, a key press causes
       one or more core pointer button events instead of the usual
       KeyPress event. If count is zero , a key press generates a
       single ButtonPress event; if count is greater than zero , a
       key press generates count pairs of ButtonPress and
       ButtonRelease events.
     * If count is zero , a key release generates a core pointer
       ButtonRelease that matches the event generated by the
       corresponding KeyPress ; if count is nonzero, a key release
       does not cause a ButtonRelease event. A key release never
       generates a key KeyRelease event.

   XkbSA_LockPtrBtn
     * If the button specified by the MouseKeys default button or
       button is not locked, a key press causes a ButtonPress
       event instead of a KeyPress event and locks the button. If
       the button is already locked or if XkbSA_LockNoUnlock is
       set in the flags field, a key press is ignored and has no
       effect.
     * If the corresponding key press was ignored, and if
       XkbSA_LockNoLock is not set in the flags field, a key
       release generates a ButtonRelease event instead of a
       KeyRelease event and unlocks the specified button. If the
       corresponding key press locked a button, the key release is
       ignored and has no effect.

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks shown in Table 16.8. A general meaning is given in the
   table, but the exact meaning depends on the action type. :

   Table 16.8. Pointer Button Action Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_UseDfltButton If set, the action uses the pointer button
   specified by the mk_dflt_btn attribute of the MouseKeys control
   (see section 10.5.1). Otherwise, the action uses the pointer
   button specified by the button field.
   XkbSA_LockNoLock If set, and the action type is
   XkbSA_LockPtrBtn , the server only unlocks the pointer button.
   XkbSA_LockNoUnlock If set, and the action type is
   XkbSA_LockPtrBtn , the server only locks the pointer button.

Actions for Changing the Pointer Button Simulated

   Actions associated with the XkbPtrDfltAction structure change
   the mk_dflt_btn attribute of the MouseKeys control (see section
   10.5.1):
typedef struct _XkbPtrDfltAction {
      unsigned char   type;      /*  XkbSA_SetPtrDflt */
      unsigned char   flags;     /* controls the pointer button number *
/
      unsigned char   affect;    /*  XkbSA_AffectDfltBtn */
      char            valueXXX;  /* new default button member */
} XkbPtrDfltAction;

   If the MouseKeys control is not enabled, KeyPress and
   KeyRelease events are treated as though the action is
   XkbSA_NoAction . Otherwise, this action changes the mk_dflt_btn
   attribute of the MouseKeys control.

   The type field of the XkbPtrDfltAction structure should always
   be XkbSA_SetPtrDflt .

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   values shown in Table 16.9 (currently there is only one value
   defined).

   Table 16.9. Pointer Default Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_DfltBtnAbsolute If set, the value field represents an
   absolute pointer button. Otherwise, the value field represents
   the amount to be added to the current default button.

   The affect field specifies what changes as a result of this
   action. The only valid value for the affect field is
   XkbSA_AffectDfltBtn.

   The valueXXX field is a signed character that represents the
   new button value for the mk_dflt_btn attribute of the MouseKeys
   control (see section 10.5.1). If XkbSA_DfltBtnAbsolute is set
   in flags , valueXXX specifies the button to be used; otherwise,
   valueXXX specifies the amount to be added to the current
   default button. In either case, illegal button choices are
   wrapped back around into range. Xkb provides the following
   macros, to convert between the integer and signed character
   values in XkbPtrDfltAction structures:
   int XkbSAPtrDfltValue ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbAction act ; /* action from which to extract group */

   XkbSAPtrDfltValue returns the valueXXX field of act converted
   to a signed int.
   void XkbSASetPtrDfltValue ( act, val ) /* macro */
   XkbPtrDfltAction act ; /* action in which to set valueXXX */
   int val ; /* value to set in valueXXX */

   XkbSASetPtrDfltValue sets the valueXXX field of act from val .

Actions for Locking Modifiers and Group

   Actions associated with the XkbISOAction structure lock
   modifiers and the group according to the ISO9995 specification.

   Operated by itself, the XkbISOAction is just a caps lock.
   Operated simultaneously with another modifier key, it
   transforms the other key into a locking key. For example, press
   ISO_Lock , press and release Control_L , release ISO_Lock ends
   up locking the Control modifier.

   The default behavior is to convert:

        {Set,Latch}Mods to: LockMods
        {Set,Latch}Group to: LockGroup
        SetPtrBtn to: LockPtrBtn
        SetControls to: LockControls

   The affects field allows you to turn those effects on or off
   individually. Set XkbSA_ISONoAffectMods to disable the first,
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectGroup to disable the second, and so forth.
typedef struct _XkbISOAction {
      unsigned char   type;        /* XkbSA_ISOLock */
      unsigned char   flags;       /* controls changes to group or modif
ier state */
      unsigned char   mask;        /* same as mask field of a modifier d
escription */
      unsigned char   real_mods;   /* same as real_mods field of a modif
ier description */
      char            group_XXX;   /* group index or delta group */
      unsigned char   affect;      /* specifies whether to affect mods,
group, ptrbtn, or controls*/
      unsigned char   vmods1;      /* derived from vmods field of a modi
fier description */
      unsigned char   vmods2;      /* derived from vmods field of a modi
fier description */
} XkbISOAction;

   The type field of the XkbISOAction structure should always be
   XkbSA_ISOLock .

   The interpretation of the flags field depends on whether the
   XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup is set in the flags field or not.

   If the XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup is set in the flags field, the
   action is used to change the group state. The remaining valid
   bits of the flags field are composed of a bitwise inclusive OR
   using the masks shown in Table 16.10.

   Table 16.10. ISO Action Flags when XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup is Set
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup

   If set, the action is used to change the base group state. Must
   be set for the remaining bits in this table to carry their
   interpretations.

   A key press sets the base group as specified by the group_XXX
   field and the XkbSA_GroupAbsolute bit of the flags field (see
   section Note). If no other actions are transformed by the
   XkbISO_Lock action, a key release locks the group. Otherwise, a
   key release clears group set by the key press.
   XkbSA_GroupAbsolute If set, the group_XXX field represents an
   absolute group number. Otherwise, it represents a group delta
   to be added to the current group to determine the new group
   number.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectMods If not set, any XkbSA_SetMods or
   XkbSA_LatchMods actions that occur simultaneously with the
   XkbSA_ISOLock action are treated as XkbSA_LockMod actions
   instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectGroup If not set, any XkbSA_SetGroup or
   XkbSA_LatchGroup actions that occur simultaneously with the
   XkbSA_ISOLock action are treated as XkbSA_LockGroup actions
   instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectPtr If not set, any XkbSA_PtrBtn actions that
   occur simultaneously with the XkbSA_ISOLock action are treated
   as XkbSA_LockPtrBtn actions instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectCtrls If not set, any XkbSA_SetControls
   actions that occur simultaneously with the XkbSA_ISOLock action
   are treated as XkbSA_LockControls actions instead.

   If the XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup is not set in the flags field, the
   action is used to change the modifier state and the remaining
   valid bits of the flags field are composed of a bitwise
   inclusive OR using the masks shown in Table 16.11.

   Table 16.11. ISO Action Flags when XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup is Not
   Set
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_ISODfltIsGroup

   If not set, action is used to change the base modifier state.
   Must not be set for the remaining bits in this table to carry
   their interpretations.

   A key press sets the action modifiers in the keyboard's base
   modifiers using the mask , real_mods , vmods1 , and vmods2
   fields (see section 16.1.3). If no other actions are
   transformed by the XkbISO_Lock action, a key release locks the
   action modifiers. Otherwise, a key release clears the base
   modifiers set by the key press.
   XkbSA_UseModMapMods If set, the action modifiers are determined
   by the modifiers bound by the modifier mapping of the key.
   Otherwise, the action modifiers are set to the modifiers
   specified by the mask , real_mods , vmod1 , and vmod2 fields.
   XkbSA_LockNoLock If set, the server only unlocks the action
   modifiers.
   XkbSA_LockNoUnlock If set, the server only locks the action
   modifiers.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectMods If not set, any XkbSA_SetMods or
   XkbSA_LatchMods actions that occur simultaneously with the
   XkbSA_ISOLock action are treated as XkbSA_LockMod actions
   instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectGroup If not set, any XkbSA_SetGroup or
   XkbSA_LatchGroup actions that occur simultaneously with the
   XkbSA_ISOLock action are treated as XkbSA_LockGroup actions
   instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectPtr If not set, any XkbSA_PtrBtn actions that
   occur simultaneously with the XkbSA_ISOLock action are treated
   as XkbSA_LockPtrBtn actions instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectCtrls If not set, any XkbSA_SetControls
   actions that occur simultaneously with the XkbSA_ISOLock action
   are treated as XkbSA_LockControls actions instead.

   The group_XXX field represents a signed character. Xkb provides
   macros to convert between a signed integer value and a signed
   character as shown in section Note.

   The mask , real_mods , vmods1 , and vmods2 fields represent the
   components of an Xkb modifier description (see section 7.2).
   While the mask and real_mods fields correspond directly to the
   mask and real_mods fields of an Xkb modifier description, the
   vmods1 and vmods2 fields are combined to correspond to the
   vmods field of an Xkb modifier description. Xkb provides macros
   to convert between the two formats as shown in section 16.1.3.

   The affect field is composed of a bitwise inclusive OR using
   the masks shown in Table 16.11.

   Table 16.12. ISO Action Affect Field Values
   Affect Meaning
   XkbSA_ISODNoAffectMods If XkbSA_ISONoAffectMods is not set, any
   SA_SetMods or SA_LatchMods actions occurring simultaneously
   with the XkbISOAction are treated as SA_LockMods instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectGroup If XkbSA_ISONoAffectGroup is not set,
   any SA_SetGroup or SA_LatchGroup actions occurring
   simultaneously with the XkbISOAction are treated as
   SA_LockGroup instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectPtr If XkbSA_ISONoAffectPtr is not set, any
   SA_PtrBtn actions occurring simultaneously with the
   XkbISOAction are treated as SA_LockPtrBtn instead.
   XkbSA_ISONoAffectCtrls If XkbSA_ISONoAffectCtrls is not set,
   any SA_SetControls actions occurring simultaneously with the
   XkbISOAction are treated as SA_LockControls instead.

Actions for Changing the Active Screen

   Actions associated with the XkbSwitchScreen action structure
   change the active screen on a multiscreen display:

Note

   This action is optional. Servers are free to ignore the action
   or any of its flags if they do not support the requested
   behavior. If the action is ignored, it behaves like
   XkbSA_NoAction . Otherwise, key press and key release events do
   not generate an event.
typedef struct _XkbSwitchScreenAction {
      unsigned char   type;        /*  XkbSA_SwitchScreen */
      unsigned char   flags;       /* controls screen switching */
      char            screenXXX;   /* screen number or delta */
} XkbSwitchScreenAction;

   The type field of the XkbSwitchScreenAction structure should
   always be XkbSA_SwitchScreen.

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks shown in Table 16.13.

   Table 16.13. Switch Screen Action Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_SwitchAbsolute If set, the screenXXX field represents the
   index of the new screen. Otherwise, it represents an offset
   from the current screen to the new screen.
   XkbSA_SwitchApplication If not set, the action should switch to
   another screen on the same server. Otherwise, it should switch
   to another X server or application that shares the same
   physical display.

   The screenXXX field is a signed character value that represents
   either the relative or absolute screen index, depending on the
   state of the XkbSA_SwitchAbsolute bit in the flags field. Xkb
   provides the following macros to convert between the integer
   and signed character value for screen numbers in
   XkbSwitchScreenAction structures:
   int XkbSAScreen ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbSwitchScreenAction act ; /* action from which to extract
   screen */

   XkbSAScreen returns the screenXXX field of act converted to a
   signed int.
   void XkbSASetScreen ( act, s ) /* macro */
   XkbSwitchScreenAction act ; /* action in which to set screenXXX
   */
   int s ; /* value to set in screenXXX */

   XkbSASetScreen sets the screenXXX field of act from s .

Actions for Changing Boolean Controls State

   Actions associated with the XkbCtrlsAction structure change the
   state of the boolean controls (see section 10.1):
typedef struct _XkbCtrlsAction {
      unsigned char     type;        /*  XkbSA_SetControls,
                                        XkbSA_LockControls */
      unsigned char     flags;       /* with  type,
                                        controls enabling and disabling
of controls */
      unsigned char     ctrls3;      /* ctrls0 through
                                         ctrls3 represent the boolean co
ntrols */
      unsigned char     ctrls2;      /* ctrls0 through
                                         ctrls3 represent the boolean co
ntrols */
      unsigned char     ctrls1;      /* ctrls0 through
                                         ctrls3 represent the boolean co
ntrols */
      unsigned char     ctrls0;      /* ctrls0 through
                                         ctrls3 represent the boolean co
ntrols */
} XkbCtrlsAction;

   The type field can have any one of the values shown in Table
   16.14.

   Table 16.14. Controls Action Types
   Type               Effect
   XkbSA_SetControls
     * A key press enables any boolean controls specified in the
       ctrls fields that were not already enabled at the time of
       the key press.
     * A key release disables any controls enabled by the key
       press.
     * This action can cause XkbControlsNotify events (see section
       10.1).

   XkbSA_LockControls
     * If the XkbSA_LockNoLock bit is not set in the flags field,
       a key press enables any controls specified in the ctrls
       fields that were not already enabled at the time of the key
       press.
     * If the XkbSA_LockNoUnlock bit is not set in the flags
       field, a key release disables any controls specified in the
       ctrls fields that were not already disabled at the time of
       the key press.
     * This action can cause XkbControlsNotify events (see section
       10.1).

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks shown in Table 16.15.

   Table 16.15. Control Action Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_LockNoLock If set, and the action type is
   XkbSA_LockControls , the server only disables controls.
   XkbSA_LockNoUnlock If set, and the action type is
   XkbSA_LockControls , the server only enables controls.

   The XkbSA_SetControls action implements a key that enables a
   boolean control when pressed and disables it when released. The
   XkbSA_LockControls action is used to implement a key that
   toggles the state of a boolean control each time it is pressed
   and released. The XkbSA_LockNoLock and XkbSA_LockNoUnlock flags
   allow modifying the toggling behavior to only unlock or only
   lock the boolean control.

   The ctrls0 , ctrls1 , ctrls2 , and ctrls3 fields represent the
   boolean controls in the enabled_ctrls field of the controls
   structure (see section 10.1). Xkb provides the following
   macros, to convert between the two formats:
   unsigned int XkbActionCtrls ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbCtrlsAction act ; /* action from which to extract controls
   */

   XkbActionCtrls returns the ctrls fields of act converted to an
   unsigned int.
   void XkbSAActionSetCtrls ( act, ctrls ) /* macro */
   XkbCtrlsAction act ; /* action in which to set ctrls0-ctrls3 */
   unsigned int ctrls ; /* value to set in ctrls0-ctrls3 */

   XkbSAActionSetCtrls sets the ctrls0 through ctrls3 fields of
   act from ctrls .

Actions for Generating Messages

   Actions associated with the XkbMessageAction structure generate
   XkbActionMessage events:
#define            XkbActionMessageLength                  6

typedef struct _XkbMessageAction {
      unsigned char   type;             /*  XkbSA_ActionMessage */
      unsigned char   flags;            /* controls event generation via
 key presses and releases */
      unsigned char   message[XkbActionMessageLength];    /* message */
} XkbMessageAction;

   The type field of the XkbMessageAction structure should always
   be XkbSA_ActionMessage .

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks shown in Table 16.16.

   Table 16.16. Message Action Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_MessageOnPress If set, key press events generate an
   XkbActionMessage event that reports the keycode, event type,
   and contents of the message field.
   XkbSA_MessageOnRelease If set, key release events generate an
   XkbActionMessage event that reports the keycode, event type,
   and contents of the message field.
   XkbSA_MessageGenKeyEvent If set, key press and key release
   events generate KeyPress and KeyRelease events, regardless of
   whether they generate XkbActionMessage events.

   The message field is an array of XkbActionMessageLength
   unsigned characters and may be set to anything the keymap
   designer wishes.

Detecting Key Action Messages

   To receive XkbActionMessage events by calling either
   XkbSelectEvents or XkbSelectEventDetails (see section 4.3).

   To receive XkbActionMessage events under all possible
   conditions, use XkbSelectEvents and pass XkbActionMessageMask
   in both bits_to_change and values_for_bits .

   The XkbActionMessage event has no event details. However, you
   can call XkbSelectEventDetails using XkbActionMessage as the
   event_type and specifying XkbAllActionMessageMask in
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits. This has the same effect as
   a call to XkbSelectEvents.

   The structure for the XkbActionMessage event is defined as
   follows:
typedef struct _XkbActionMessage {
      int            type;            /* Xkb extension base event code *
/
      unsigned long  serial;          /* X server serial number for even
t */
      Bool           send_event;      /* True => synthetically generated
 */
      Display *      display;         /* server connection where event g
enerated */
      Time           time;            /* server time when event generate
d */
      int            xkb_type;        /* XkbActionMessage */
      int            device;          /* Xkb device ID, will not be  Xkb
UseCoreKbd */
      KeyCode        keycode;         /* keycode of key triggering event
 */
      Bool           press;           /* True => key press,
                                         False => release */
      Bool           key_event_follows; /* True => KeyPress/KeyRelease f
ollows */
      char           message[XkbActionMessageLength+1];
      /* message text */
} XkbActionMessageEvent;

   The keycode is the keycode of the key that was pressed or
   released. The press field specifies whether the event was the
   result of a key press or key release.

   The key_event_follows specifies whether a KeyPress (if press is
   True ) or KeyRelease (if press is False ) event is also sent to
   the client. As with all other Xkb events, XkbActionMessageEvent
   s are delivered to all clients requesting them, regardless of
   the current keyboard focus. However, the KeyPress or KeyRelease
   event that conditionally follows an XkbActionMessageEvent is
   sent only to the client selected by the current keyboard focus.
   key_event_follows is True only for the client that is actually
   sent the following KeyPress or KeyRelease event.

   The message field is set to the message specified in the action
   and is guaranteed to be NULL -terminated; the Xkb extension
   forces a NULL into message [ XkbActionMessageLength ].

Actions for Generating a Different Keycode

   Actions associated with the XkbRedirectKeyAction structure
   generate KeyPress and KeyRelease events containing a keycode
   different from the key that was pressed or released:
typedef struct      _XkbRedirectKeyAction {
      unsigned char      type;          /*  XkbSA_RedirectKey */
      unsigned char      new_key;       /* keycode to be put in event */
      unsigned char      mods_mask;     /* mask of real mods to be reset
 */
      unsigned char      mods;          /* mask of real mods to take val
ues from */
      unsigned char      vmods_mask0;   /* first half of mask of virtual
 mods to be reset */
      unsigned char      vmods_mask1;   /* other half of mask of virtual
 mods to be reset */
      unsigned char      vmods0;        /* first half of mask of virtual
 mods to take values from */
      unsigned char      vmods1;        /* other half of mask of virtual
 mods to take values from */
} XkbRedirectKeyAction;

   The type field for the XkbRedirectKeyAction structure should
   always be XkbSA_RedirectKey .

   Key presses cause a KeyPress event for the key specified by the
   new_key field instead of the actual key. The state reported in
   this event reports the current effective modifiers changed as
   follows: any real modifiers selected by the mods_mask field are
   set to corresponding values from the mods field. Any real
   modifiers bound to the virtual modifiers specified by the
   vmods_mask0 and vmods_mask1 fields are either set or cleared,
   depending on the corresponding values in the vmods0 and vmods1
   fields. If the real and virtual modifier definitions specify
   conflicting values for a single modifier, the real modifier
   definition has priority.

   Key releases cause a KeyRelease event for the key specified by
   the new_key field instead of the actual key. The state for this
   event consists of the effective keyboard modifiers at the time
   of the release, changed as described previously.

   The XkbSA_RedirectKey action normally redirects to another key
   on the same device as the key that caused the event, unless
   that device does not belong to the input extension KeyClass ,
   in which case this action causes an event on the core keyboard
   device. (The input extension categorizes devices by breaking
   them into classes. Keyboards, and other input devices with
   keys, are classified as KeyClass devices by the input
   extension.)

   The vmods_mask0 and vmods_mask1 fields actually represent one
   vmods_mask value, as described in Chapter 7. Xkb provides the
   following macros, to convert between the two formats:
   unsigned int XkbSARedirectVModsMask ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbRedirectKeyAction act ; /* action from which to extract
   vmods */

   XkbSARedirectVModsMask returns the vmods_mask0 and vmods_mask1
   fields of act converted to an unsigned int.
   void XkbSARedirectSetVModsMask ( act, vm ) /* macro */
   XkbRedirectKeyAction act ; /* action in which to set vmods */
   unsigned int vm ; /* new value for virtual modifier mask */

   XkbSARedirectSetVModsMask sets the vmods_mask0 and vmods_mask1
   fields of act from vm .

   Similarly, the vmods0 and vmods1 fields actually represent one
   vmods value, as described in Chapter 7. To convert between the
   two formats, Xkb provides the following convenience macros:
   unsigned int XkbSARedirectVMods ( act ) /* macro */
   XkbRedirectKeyAction act ; /* action from which to extract
   vmods */

        XkbSARedirectVModsMask returns the vmods0
        and vmods1 fields of act
        converted to an unsigned int.
   void XkbSARedirectSetVMods ( act, vm ) /* macro */
   XkbRedirectKeyAction act ; /* action in which to set vmods */
   unsigned int v ; /* new value for virtual modifiers */

         XkbSARedirectSetVModsMask sets the vmods0
        and vmods1 of act from v.

Actions for Generating DeviceButtonPress and DeviceButtonRelease

   Actions associated with XkbDeviceBtnAction structures generate
   DeviceButtonPress and DeviceButtonRelease events instead of
   normal KeyPress and KeyRelease events:
typedef struct _XkbDeviceBtnAction {
      unsigned char    type;      /*  XkbSA_DeviceBtn, XkbSA_LockDeviceB
tn */
      unsigned char    flags;     /* with  type , specifies locking or u
nlocking */
      unsigned char    count;     /* controls number of DeviceButtonPres
s and Release events */
      unsigned char    button;    /* index of button on  device */
      unsigned char    device;    /* device ID of an X input extension d
evice */
} XkbDeviceBtnAction;

   The type field can have any one of the values shown in Table
   16.17.

   Table 16.17. Device Button Action Types
   Type                Effect
   XkbSA_DeviceBtn
     * If the button specified by this action is logically down,
       the key press and corresponding release are ignored and
       have no effect. If the device or button specified by this
       action are illegal, this action behaves like
       XkbSA_NoAction.
     * Otherwise, key presses cause one or more input extension
       device events instead of the usual key press event. If the
       count field is zero, a key press generates a single
       DeviceButtonPress event. If count is greater than zero, a
       key press event generates count pairs of DeviceButtonPress
       and DeviceButtonRelease events.
     * If count is zero, a key release generates an input
       extension DeviceButtonRelease event that matches the event
       generated by the corresponding key press. If count is
       nonzero, a key release does not cause a DeviceButtonRelease
       event. Key releases never cause KeyRelease events.

   XkbSA_LockDeviceBtn
     * If the device or button specified by this action are
       illegal, this action behaves like XkbSA_NoAction.
     * Otherwise, if the specified button is not locked and the
       XkbSA_LockNoLock bit is not set in the flags field, a key
       press generates an input extension DeviceButtonPress event
       instead of a KeyPress event and locks the button. If the
       button is already locked or if XkbSA_LockNoLock bit is set
       in the flags field, the key press is ignored and has no
       effect.
     * If the corresponding key press was ignored, and if the
       XkbSA_LockNoUnlock bit is not set in the flags field, a key
       release generates an input extension DeviceButtonRelease
       event instead of a KeyRelease event and unlocks the button.
       If the corresponding key press locked a button, the key
       release is ignored and has no effect.

   The flags field is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   masks shown in Table 16.18.

   Table 16.18. Device Button Action Flags
   Flag Meaning
   XkbSA_LockNoLock If set, and the action type is
   XkbSA_LockDeviceBtn , the server only unlocks the button.
   XkbSA_LockNoUnlock If set, and the action type is
   XkbSA_LockDeviceBtn , the server only locks the button.

Actions for Simulating Events from Device Valuators

   A valuator manipulates a range of values for some entity, like
   a mouse axis, a slider or a dial. Actions associated with
   XkbDeviceValuatorAction structures are used to simulate events
   from one or two input extension device valuators.
typedef struct _XkbDeviceValuatorAction {
      unsigned char    type;        /* XkbSA_DeviceValuator */
      unsigned char    device;      /* device ID */
      unsigned char    v1_what;     /* determines how valuator is to beh
ave for valuator 1 */
      unsigned char    v1_ndx;      /* specifies a real valuator */
      unsigned char    v1_value;    /* the value for valuator 1 */
      unsigned char    v2_what;     /* determines how valuator is to beh
ave for valuator 2 */
      unsigned char    v2_ndx;      /* specifies a real valuator */
      unsigned char    v2_value;    /* the value for valuator 1 */
} XkbDeviceValuatorAction;

   If device is illegal or if neither v1_ndx nor v2_ndx specifies
   a legal valuator, this action behaves like XkbSA_NoAction.

   The low four bits of v1_what and v2_what specify the
   corresponding scale value (denoted val<n>Scale in Table 16.17),
   if needed. The high four bits of v1_what and v2_what specify
   the operation to perform to set the values. The high four bits
   of v1_what and v2_what can have the values shown in Table
   16.17; the use of val<n>Scale is shown in that table also.

   Table 16.19. Device Valuator v<n>_what High Bits Values
   Value of high bits Effect
   XkbSA_IgnoreVal No action
   XkbSA_SetValMin v<n>_value is set to its minimum legal value.
   XkbSA_SetValCenter v<n>_valueis centered (to (max-min)/2).
   XkbSA_SetValMax v<n>_value is set to its maximum legal value.
   XkbSA_SetValRelative v<n>_value * (2 val<n>Scale) is added to
   v<n>_value.
   XkbSA_SetValAbsolute v<n>_value is set to (2 val<n>Scale).

   Illegal values for XkbSA_SetValRelative or XkbSA_SetValAbsolute
   are clamped into range. Note that all of these possibilities
   are legal for absolute valuators. For relative valuators, only
   XkbSA_SetValRelative is permitted. Part of the input extension
   description of a device is the range of legal values for all
   absolute valuators, whence the maximum and minimum legal values
   shown in Table 16.17.

   The following two masks are provided as a convenience to select
   either portion of v1_what or v2_what :

         #define XkbSA_ValOpMask      (0x70)
         #define XkbSA_ValScaleMask      (0x07)

   v1_ndx and v2_ndx specify valuators that actually exists. For
   example, most mice have two valuators (x and y axes) so the
   only legal values for a mouse would be 0 and 1. For a dial box
   with eight dials, any value in the range 0..7 would be correct.

Obtaining Key Actions for Keys from the Server

   To update the actions (the key_acts array) for a subset of the
   keys in a keyboard description, use XkbGetKeyActions .
   Status XkbGetKeyActions ( dpy , first , num , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int first ; /* keycode of first key of interest */
   unsigned int num ; /* number of keys desired */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* pointer to keyboard description where
   result is stored */

   XkbGetKeyActions sends a request to the server to obtain the
   actions for num keys on the keyboard starting with key first .
   It waits for a reply and returns the actions in the server ->
   key_acts field of xkb . If successful, XkbGetKeyActions returns
   Success . The xkb parameter must be a pointer to a valid Xkb
   keyboard description.

   If the server map in the xkb parameter has not been allocated,
   XkbGetKeyActions allocates and initializes it before obtaining
   the actions.

   If the server does not have a compatible version of Xkb, or the
   Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetKeyActions returns BadAccess . If num is less than 1 or
   greater than XkbMaxKeyCount , XkbGetKeyActions returns BadValue
   . If any allocation errors occur, XkbGetKeyActions returns
   BadAlloc .

Changing the Number of Actions Bound to a Key

   To change the number of actions bound to a key, use
   XkbResizeKeyAction .
   XkbAction * XkbResizeKeyActions ( xkb , key , needed )
   XkbDescRec * xkb ; /* keyboard description to change */
   int key ; /* keycode of key to change */
   int needed ; /* new number of actions required */

   The xkb parameter points to the keyboard description containing
   the key whose number of actions is to be changed. The key
   parameter is the keycode of the key to change, and needed
   specifies the new number of actions required for the key.

   XkbResizeKeyActions reserves the space needed for the actions
   and returns a pointer to the beginning of the new array that
   holds the actions. It can change the acts , num_acts , and
   size_acts fields of xkb -> server if it is necessary to
   reallocate the acts array.

   If needed is greater than the current number of keysyms for the
   key, XkbResizeKeyActions initializes all new actions in the
   array to NoAction .

   Because the number of actions needed by a key is normally
   computed as width * number of groups, and XkbResizeKeyActions
   does not modify either the width or number of groups for the
   key, a discrepancy exists on return from XkbResizeKeyActions
   between the space allocated for the actions and the number
   required. The unused entries in the list of actions returned by
   XkbResizeKeyActions are not preserved across future calls to
   any of the map editing functions, so you must update the key
   actions (which updates the width and number of groups for the
   key) before calling another allocator function. A call to
   XkbChangeTypesOfKey updates these.

   If any allocation errors occur while resizing the number of
   actions bound to the key, XkbResizeKeyActions returns NULL .

Note

   A change to the number of actions bound to a key should be
   accompanied by a change in the number of symbols bound to a
   key. Refer to section 15.3.7 for more information on changing
   the number of symbols bound to a key.

Key Behavior

   Key behavior refers to the demeanor of a key. For example, the
   expected behavior of the CapsLock key is that it logically
   locks when pressed, and then logically unlocks when pressed
   again.

Radio Groups

   Keys that belong to the same radio group have the
   XkbKB_RadioGroup type in the type field and the radio group
   index specified in the data field in the XkbBehavior structure.
   If the radio group has a name in the XkbNamesRec structure, the
   radio group index is the index into the radio_group array in
   the XkbNamesRec structure. A radio group key when pressed stays
   logically down until another key in the radio group is pressed,
   when the first key becomes logically up and the new key becomes
   logically down. Setting the XkbKB_RGAllowNone bit in the
   behavior for all of the keys of the radio group means that
   pressing the logically down member of the radio group causes it
   to logically release, in which case none of the keys of the
   radio group would be logically down. If XkbKB_RGAllowNone is
   not set, there is no way to release the logically down member
   of the group.

   The low five bits of the data field of the XkbBehavior
   structure are the group number, the high three bits are flags.
   The only flag currently defined is:
#define      XkbRG_AllowNone      0x80

The XkbBehavior Structure

   The behaviors field of the server map is an array of
   XkbBehavior structures, indexed by keycode, and contains the
   behavior for each key. The XkbBehavior structure is defined as
   follows:
typedef struct _XkbBehavior {
      unsigned char  type;                  /* behavior type + optional
                                                XkbKB_Permanent bit */
      unsigned char  data;
} XkbBehavior;

   The type field specifies the Xkb behavior, and the value of the
   data field depends on the type . Xkb supports the key behaviors
   shown in Table 16.20.

   Table 16.20. Key Behaviors
   Type Effect
   XkbKB_Default Press and release events are processed normally.
   The data field is unused.
   XkbKB_Lock If a key is logically up (that is, the corresponding
   bit of the core key map is cleared) when it is pressed, the key
   press is processed normally and the corresponding release is
   ignored. If the key is logically down when pressed, the key
   press is ignored but the corresponding release is processed
   normally. The data field is unused.
   XkbKB_RadioGroup

   If another member of the radio group is logically down (all
   members of the radio group have the same index, specified in
   data ) when a key is pressed, the server synthesizes a key
   release for the member that is logically down and then
   processes the new key press event normally.

   If the key itself is logically down when pressed, the key press
   event is ignored, but the processing of the corresponding key
   release depends on the value of the Xkb_RGAllowNone bit in
   flags . If it is set, the key release is processed normally;
   otherwise, the key release is also ignored.

   All other key release events are ignored.
   XkbKB_Overlay1 If the Overlay1 control is enabled (see section
   10.4), data is interpreted as a keycode, and events from this
   key are reported as if they came from data 's keycode.
   Otherwise, press and release events are processed normally.
   XkbKB_Overlay2 If the Overlay2 control is enabled (see section
   10.4), data is interpreted as a keycode, and events from this
   key are reported as if they came from data 's keycode.
   Otherwise, press and release events are processed normally.

   Xkb also provides the mask, XkbKB_Permanent to specify whether
   the key behavior type should be simulated by Xkb or whether the
   key behavior describes an unalterable physical, electrical, or
   software aspect of the keyboard. If the XkbKB_Permanent bit is
   not set in the type field, Xkb simulates the behavior in
   software. Otherwise, Xkb relies upon the keyboard to implement
   the behavior.

Obtaining Key Behaviors for Keys from the Server

   To obtain the behaviors (the behaviors array) for a subset of
   the keys in a keyboard description from the server, use
   XkbGetKeyBehaviors :
   Status XkbGetKeyBehaviors ( dpy , first , num , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to server */
   unsigned int first ; /* keycode of first key to get */
   unsigned int num ; /* number of keys for which behaviors are
   desired */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description to contain the result */

   XkbGetKeyBehaviors sends a request to the server to obtain the
   behaviors for num keys on the keyboard starting with the key
   whose keycode is first . It waits for a reply and returns the
   behaviors in the server -> behaviors field of xkb . If
   successful, XkbGetKeyBehaviors returns Success .

   If the server map in the xkb parameter has not been allocated,
   XkbGetKeyBehaviors allocates and initializes it before
   obtaining the actions.

   If the server does not have a compatible version of Xkb, or the
   Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetKeyBehaviors returns BadAccess . If num is less than 1 or
   greater than XkbMaxKeyCount , XkbGetKeyBehaviors returns
   BadValue . If any allocation errors occur, XkbGetKeyBehaviors
   returns BadAlloc .

Explicit Components--Avoiding Automatic Remapping by the Server

   Whenever a client remaps the keyboard using core protocol
   requests, Xkb examines the map to determine likely default
   values for the components that cannot be specified using the
   core protocol (see section 17.1.2 for more information on how
   Xkb chooses the default values).

   This automatic remapping might replace definitions explicitly
   requested by an application, so the Xkb keyboard description
   defines an explicit components mask for each key. Any aspects
   of the automatic remapping listed in the explicit components
   mask for a key are not changed by the automatic keyboard
   mapping.

   The explicit components masks are held in the explicit field of
   the server map, which is an array indexed by keycode. Each
   entry in this array is a mask that is a bitwise inclusive OR of
   the values shown in Table 16.21.

   Table 16.21. Explicit Component Masks
   Bit in Explicit Mask Value Protects Against
   ExplicitKeyType1 (1<<0) Automatic determination of the key type
   associated with Group1.
   ExplicitKeyType2 (1<<1) Automatic determination of the key type
   associated with Group2.
   ExplicitKeyType3 (1<<2) Automatic determination of the key type
   associated with Group3.
   ExplicitKeyType4 (1<<3) Automatic determination of the key type
   associated with Group4.
   ExplicitInterpret (1<<4) Application of any of the fields of a
   symbol interpretation to the key in question.
   ExplicitAutoRepeat (1<<5) Automatic determination of
   auto-repeat status for the key, as specified in a symbol
   interpretation.
   ExplicitBehavior (1<<6) Automatic assignment of the XkbKB_Lock
   behavior to the key, if the XkbSI_LockingKey flag is set in a
   symbol interpretation.
   ExplicitVModMap (1<<7) Automatic determination of the virtual
   modifier map for the key based on the actions assigned to the
   key and the symbol interpretations that match the key.

Obtaining Explicit Components for Keys from the Server

   To obtain the explicit components (the explicit array) for a
   subset of the keys in a keyboard description, use
   XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents.
   Status XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents ( dpy , first , num , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to server */
   unsigned int first ; /* keycode of first key to fetch */
   unsigned int num ; /* number of keys for which to get explicit
   info */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description in which to put results */

   XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents sends a request to the server to
   obtain the explicit components for num keys on the keyboard
   starting with key first . It waits for a reply and returns the
   explicit components in the server -> explicit array of xkb . If
   successful, XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents returns Success . The
   xkb parameter must be a pointer to a valid Xkb keyboard
   description.

   If the server map in the xkb parameter has not been allocated,
   XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents allocates and initializes it before
   obtaining the actions.

   If the server does not have a compatible version of Xkb, or the
   Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents returns BadMatch . If num is less
   than 1 or greater than XkbMaxKeyCount ,
   XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents returns BadValue . If any
   allocation errors occur, XkbGetKeyExplicitComponents returns
   BadAlloc .

Virtual Modifier Mapping

   The vmods member of the server map is a fixed-length array
   containing XkbNumVirtualMods entries. Each entry corresponds to
   a virtual modifier and provides the binding of the virtual
   modifier to the real modifier bits. Each entry in the vmods
   array is a bitwise inclusive OR of the legal modifier masks:

        ShiftMask
        LockMask
        ControlMask
        Mod1Mask
        Mod2Mask
        Mod3Mask
        Mod4Mask
        Mod5Mask

   The vmodmap member of the server map is similar to the modmap
   array of the client map (see section 15.4), but is used to
   define the virtual modifier mapping for each key. Like the
   modmap member, it is indexed by keycode, and each entry is a
   mask representing the virtual modifiers bound to the
   corresponding key:
     * Each of the bits in a vmodmap entry represents an index
       into the vmods member. That is, bit 0 of a vmodmap entry
       refers to index 0 of the vmods array, bit 1 refers to index
       1, and so on.
     * If a bit is set in the vmodmap entry for a key, that key is
       bound to the corresponding virtual modifier in the vmods
       array.

   The vmodmap and vmods members of the server map are the
   "master" virtual modifier definitions. Xkb automatically
   propagates any changes to these fields to all other fields that
   use virtual modifier mappings.

   The overall relationship of fields dealing with virtual
   modifiers in an Xkb keyboard description are shown in Figure
   16.2.
   Virtual Modifier Relationships

Obtaining Virtual Modifier Bindings from the Server

   To obtain a subset of the virtual modifier bindings (the vmods
   array) in a keyboard description, use XkbGetVirtualMods :
   Status XkbGetVirtualMods ( dpy , which , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask indicating virtual modifier
   bindings to get */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description where results will be
   placed */

   XkbGetVirtualMods sends a request to the server to obtain the
   vmods entries for the virtual modifiers specified in the mask,
   which , and waits for a reply. See section 7.1 for a
   description of how to determine the virtual modifier mask. For
   each bit set in which , XkbGetVirtualMods updates the
   corresponding virtual modifier definition in the server->vmods
   array of xkb . The xkb parameter must be a pointer to a valid
   Xkb keyboard description. If successful, XkbGetVirtualMods
   returns Success .

   If the server map has not been allocated in the xkb parameter,
   XkbGetVirtualMods allocates and initializes it before obtaining
   the virtual modifier bindings.

   If the server does not have a compatible version of Xkb, or the
   Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetVirtualMods returns BadMatch . Any errors in allocation
   cause XkbGetVirtualMods to return BadAlloc.

Obtaining Per-Key Virtual Modifier Mappings from the Server

   To obtain the virtual modifier map (the vmodmap array) for a
   subset of the keys in a keyboard description, use
   XkbGetKeyVirtualModMap :
   Status XkbGetKeyVirtualModMap ( dpy , first , num , xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to server */
   unsigned int first ; /* keycode of first key to fetch */
   unsigned int num ; /* # keys for which virtual mod maps are
   desired */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description where results will be
   placed */

   XkbGetKeyVirutalModmap sends a request to the server to obtain
   the virtual modifier mappings for num keys on the keyboard
   starting with key first . It waits for a reply and returns the
   virtual modifier mappings in the server -> vmodmap array of xkb
   . If successful, XkbGetKeyVirtualModMap returns Success . The
   xkb parameter must be a pointer to a valid Xkb keyboard
   description

   If the server map in the xkb parameter has not been allocated,
   XkbGetKeyVirtualModMap allocates and initializes it before
   obtaining the virtual modifier mappings.

   If the server does not have a compatible version of Xkb, or the
   Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetKeyVirtualModMap returns BadMatch . If num is less than 1
   or greater than XkbMaxKeyCount , XkbGetKeyVirtualModMap returns
   BadValue . If any allocation errors occur,
   XkbGetKeyVirtualModMap returns BadAlloc .

Chapter 17. The Xkb Compatibility Map

   Table of Contents

   The XkbCompatMap Structure

        Xkb State to Core Protocol State Transformation
        Core Keyboard Mapping to Xkb Keyboard Mapping
                Transformation

        Xkb Keyboard Mapping to Core Keyboard Mapping
                Transformations

   Getting Compatibility Map Components From the Server
   Using the Compatibility Map
   Changing the Server's Compatibility Map
   Tracking Changes to the Compatibility Map
   Allocating and Freeing the Compatibility Map

   As shown in Figure 17.1, the X server is normally dealing with
   more than one client, each of which may be receiving events
   from the keyboard, and each of which may issue requests to
   modify the keyboard in some manner. Each client may be either
   Xkb-unaware, Xkb-capable, or Xkb-aware. The server itself may
   be either Xkb-aware or Xkb-unaware. If the server is
   Xkb-unaware, Xkb state and keyboard mappings are not involved
   in any manner, and Xkb-aware clients may not issue Xkb requests
   to the server. If the server is Xkb-aware, the server must be
   able to deliver events and accept requests in which the
   keyboard state and mapping are compatible with the mode in
   which the client is operating. Consequently, for some
   situations, conversions must be made between Xkb state /
   keyboard mappings and core protocol state / keyboard mappings,
   and vice versa.
   Server Interaction with Types of Clients

   In addition to these situations involving a single server,
   there are cases where a client that deals with multiple servers
   may need to configure keyboards on different servers to be
   similar and the different servers may not all be Xkb-aware.
   Finally, a client may be dealing with descriptions of keyboards
   (files, and so on) that are based on core protocol and
   therefore may need to be able to map these descriptions to Xkb
   descriptions.

   An Xkb-aware server maintains keyboard state and mapping as an
   Xkb keyboard state and an Xkb keyboard mapping plus a
   compatibility map used to convert from Xkb components to core
   components and vice versa. In addition, the server also
   maintains a core keyboard mapping that approximates the Xkb
   keyboard mapping. The core keyboard mapping may be updated
   piecemeal, on a per-key basis. When the server receives a core
   protocol ChangeKeyboardMapping or SetModifierMapping request,
   it updates its core keyboard mapping, then uses the
   compatibility map to update its Xkb keyboard mapping. When the
   server receives an XkbSetMap request, it updates those portions
   of its Xkb keyboard mapping specified by the request, then uses
   its compatibility map to update the corresponding parts of its
   core keyboard map. Consequently, the server's Xkb keyboard map
   and also its core keyboard map may contain components that were
   set directly and others that were computed. Figure 17.2
   illustrates these relationships.

Note

   The core keyboard map is contained only in the server, not in
   any client-side data structures.
   Server Derivation of State and Keyboard Mapping Components

   There are three kinds of compatibility transformations made by
   the server:
    1. Xkb State to Core State
       Keyboard state information reported to a client in the
       state field of various core events may be translated from
       the Xkb keyboard state maintained by the server, which
       includes a group number, to core protocol state, which does
       not.
       In addition, whenever the Xkb state is retrieved, the
       compat_state , compat_grab_mods , and compat_lookup_mods
       fields of the XkbStateRec returned indicate the result of
       applying the compatibility map to the current Xkb state in
       the server.
    2. Core Keyboard Mapping to Xkb Keyboard Mapping
       After core protocol requests received by the server to
       change the keyboard mapping ( ChangeKeyboardMapping and
       SetModifierMapping ) have been applied to the server's core
       keyboard map, the results must be transformed to achieve an
       equivalent change of the Xkb keyboard mapping maintained by
       the server.
    3. Xkb Keyboard Mapping to Core Keyboard Mapping
       After Xkb protocol requests received by the server to
       change the keyboard mapping ( XkbSetMap ) have been applied
       to the server's Xkb keyboard map, the results are
       transformed to achieve an approximately equivalent change
       to the core keyboard mapping maintained by the server.

   This chapter discusses how a client may modify the
   compatibility map so that subsequent transformations have a
   particular result.

The XkbCompatMap Structure

   All configurable aspects of mapping Xkb state and configuration
   to and from core protocol state and configuration are defined
   by a compatibility map, contained in an XkbCompatMap structure;
   plus a set of explicit override controls used to prevent
   particular components of type 2 (core-to-Xkb keyboard mapping)
   transformations from automatically occurring. These explicit
   override controls are maintained in a separate data structure
   discussed in section 16.3.

   The compat member of an Xkb keyboard description ( XkbDescRec )
   points to the XkbCompatMap structure:
typedef struct _XkbCompatMapRec {
      XkbSymInterpretPtr   sym_interpret;            /* symbol based key
 semantics*/
      XkbModsRec           groups[XkbNumKbdGroups];  /* group => modifie
r map */
      unsigned short       num_si;                   /* # structures use
d in
                                                        sym_interpret */
      unsigned short       size_si;                  /* # structures all
ocated in
                                                        sym_interpret */
} XkbCompatMapRec, *XkbCompatMapPtr;

   Xkb Compatibility Data Structures

   The subsections that follow discuss how the compatibility map
   and explicit override controls are used in each of the three
   cases where compatibility transformations are made.

Xkb State to Core Protocol State Transformation

   As shown in Figure 17.3, there are four group compatibility
   maps (contained in groups [0..3]) in the XkbCompatMapRec
   structure, one per possible Xkb group. Each group compatibility
   map is a modifier definition (see section 7.2 for a description
   of modifier definitions). The mask component of the definition
   specifies which real modifiers should be set in the core
   protocol state field when the corresponding group is active.
   Because only one group is active at any one time, only one of
   the four possible transformations is ever applied at any one
   point in time. If the device described by the XkbDescRec does
   not support four groups, the extra groups fields are present,
   but undefined.

   Normally, the Xkb-aware server reports keyboard state in the
   state member of events such as a KeyPress event and ButtonPress
   event, encoded as follows:
   bits  meaning
   15    0
   13-14 Group index
   8-12  Pointer Buttons
   0-7   Modifiers

   For Xkb-unaware clients, only core protocol keyboard
   information may be reported. Because core protocol does not
   define the group index, the group index is mapped to modifier
   bits as specified by the groups [group index] field of the
   compatibility map (the bits set in the compatibility map are
   ORed into bits 0-7 of the state), and bits 13-14 are reported
   in the event as zero.

Core Keyboard Mapping to Xkb Keyboard Mapping Transformation

   When a core protocol keyboard mapping request is received by
   the server, the server's core keyboard map is updated, and then
   the Xkb map maintained by the server is updated. Because a
   client may have explicitly configured some of the Xkb keyboard
   mapping in the server, this automatic regeneration of the Xkb
   keyboard mapping from the core protocol keyboard mapping should
   not modify any components of the Xkb keyboard mapping that were
   explicitly set by a client. The client must set explicit
   override controls to prevent this from happening (see section
   16.3). The core-to-Xkb mapping is done as follows:
    1. Map the symbols from the keys in the core keyboard map to
       groups and symbols on keys in the Xkb keyboard map. The
       core keyboard mapping is of fixed width, so each key in the
       core mapping has the same number of symbols associated with
       it. The Xkb mapping allows a different number of symbols to
       be associated with each key; those symbols may be divided
       into a different number of groups (1-4) for each key. For
       each key, this process therefore involves partitioning the
       fixed number of symbols from the core mapping into a set of
       variable-length groups with a variable number of symbols in
       each group. For example, if the core protocol map is of
       width five, the partition for one key might result in one
       group with two symbols and another with three symbols. A
       different key might result in two groups with two symbols
       plus a third group with one symbol. The core protocol map
       requires at least two symbols in each of the first two
       groups.
         a. For each changed key, determine the number of groups
            represented in the new core keyboard map. This results
            in a tentative group count for each key in the Xkb
            map.
         b. For each changed key, determine the number of symbols
            in each of the groups found in step 1a. There is one
            explicit override control associated with each of the
            four possible groups for each Xkb key,
            ExplicitKeyType1 through ExplicitKeyType4 . If no
            explicit override control is set for a group, the
            number of symbols used for that group from the core
            map is two. If the explicit override control is set
            for a group on the key, the number of symbols used for
            that Xkb group from the core map is the width of the
            Xkb group with one exception: because of the core
            protocol requirement for at least two symbols in each
            of groups one and two, the number of symbols used for
            groups one and two is the maximum of 2 or the width of
            the Xkb group.
         c. For each changed key, assign the symbols in the core
            map to the appropriate group on the key. If the total
            number of symbols required by the Xkb map for a
            particular key needs more symbols than the core
            protocol map contains, the additional symbols are
            taken to be NoSymbol keysyms appended to the end of
            the core set. If the core map contains more symbols
            than are needed by the Xkb map, trailing symbols in
            the core map are discarded. In the absence of an
            explicit override for group one or two, symbols are
            assigned in order by group; the first symbols in the
            core map are assigned to group one, in order, followed
            by group two, and so on. For example, if the core map
            contained eight symbols per key, and a particular Xkb
            map contained 2 symbols for G1 and G2 and three for
            G3, the symbols would be assigned as (G is group, L is
            shift level):
                      G1L1 G1L2 G2L1 G2L2 G3L1 G3L2 G3L3
            If an explicit override control is set for group one
            or two, the symbols are taken from the core set in a
            somewhat different order. The first four symbols from
            the core set are assigned to G1L1, G1L2, G2L1, G2L2,
            respectively. If group one requires more symbols, they
            are taken next, and then any additional symbols needed
            by group two. Group three and four symbols are taken
            in complete sequence after group two. For example, a
            key with four groups and three symbols in each group
            would take symbols from the core set in the following
            order:
            G1L1 G1L2 G2L1 G2L2 G1L3 G2L3 G3L1 G3L2 G3L3 G4L1 G4L2
             G4L3
            As previously noted, the core protocol map requires at
            lease two symbols in groups one and two. Because of
            this, if an explicit override control for an Xkb key
            is set and group one and / or group two is of width
            one, it is not possible to generate the symbols taken
            from the core protocol set and assigned to position
            G1L2 and / or G2L2.
         d. For each group on each changed key, assign a key type
            appropriate for the symbols in the group.
         e. For each changed key, remove any empty or redundant
            groups.
    2. At this point, the groups and their associated symbols have
       been assigned to the corresponding key definitions in the
       Xkb map.
    3. Apply symbol interpretations to modify key operation. This
       phase is completely skipped if the ExplicitInterpret
       override control bit is set in the explicit controls mask
       for the Xkb key (see section 16.3).
         a. For each symbol on each changed key, attempt to match
            the symbol and modifiers from the Xkb map to a symbol
            interpretation describing how to generate the symbol.
         b. When a match is found in step 2a, apply the symbol
            interpretation to change the semantics associated with
            the symbol in the Xkb key map. If no match is found,
            apply a default interpretation.

   The symbol interpretations used in step 2 are configurable and
   may be specified using XkbSymInterpretRec structures referenced
   by the sym_interpret field of an XkbCompatMapRec (see Figure
   17.3).

Symbol Interpretations -- the XkbSymInterpretRec Structure

   Symbol interpretations are used to guide the X server when it
   modifies the Xkb keymap in step 2. An initial set of symbol
   interpretations is loaded by the server when it starts. A
   client may add new ones using XkbSetCompatMap (see section
   17.4).

   Symbol interpretations result in key semantics being set. When
   a symbol interpretation is applied, the following components of
   server key event processing may be modified for the particular
   key involved:

         Virtual modifier map
         Auto repeat
         Key behavior (may be set to XkbKB_Lock)
         Key action (see section 16.1)

   The XkbSymInterpretRec structure specifies a symbol
   interpretation:
typedef struct {
      KeySym          sym;          /* keysym of interest or NULL */
      unsigned char   flags;        /* XkbSI_AutoRepeat, XkbSI_LockingKe
y */
      unsigned char   match;        /* specifies how mods is interpreted
 */
      unsigned char   mods;         /* modifier bits, correspond to eigh
t real modifiers */
      unsigned char   virtual_mod;  /* 1 modifier to add to key virtual
mod map */
      XkbAnyAction    act;          /* action to bind to symbol position
 on key */
} XkbSymInterpretRec,*XkbSymInterpretPtr;

   If sym is not NULL , it limits the symbol interpretation to
   keys on which that particular keysym is selected by the
   modifiers matching the criteria specified by mods and match .
   If sym is NULL , the interpretation may be applied to any
   symbol selected on a key when the modifiers match the criteria
   specified by mods and match .

   match must be one of the values shown in Table 17.1 and
   specifies how the real modifiers specified in mods are to be
   interpreted.

   Table 17.1. Symbol Interpretation Match Criteria
   Match Criteria Value Effect
   XkbSI_NoneOf (0) None of the bits that are on in mods can be
   set, but other bits can be.
   XkbSI_AnyOfOrNone (1) Zero or more of the bits that are on in
   mods can be set, as well as others.
   XkbSI_AnyOf (2) One or more of the bits that are on in mods can
   be set, as well as any others.
   XkbSI_AllOf (3) All of the bits that are on in mods must be
   set, but others may be set as well.
   XkbSI_Exactly (4) All of the bits that are on in mods must be
   set, and no other bits may be set.

   In addition to the above bits, match may contain the
   XkbSI_LevelOneOnly bit, in which case the modifier match
   criteria specified by mods and match applies only if sym is in
   level one of its group; otherwise, mods and match are ignored
   and the symbol matches a condition where no modifiers are set.
#define XkbSI_LevelOneOnly  (0x80)
/* use mods + match only if sym is level 1 */

   If no matching symbol interpretation is found, the server uses
   a default interpretation where:
   sym =         0
   flags =       XkbSI_AutoRepeat
   match =       XkbSI_AnyOfOrNone
   mods =        0
   virtual_mod = XkbNoModifier
   act =         SA_NoAction

   When a matching symbol interpretation is found in step 2a, the
   interpretation is applied to modify the Xkb map as follows.

   The act field specifies a single action to be bound to the
   symbol position; any key event that selects the symbol causes
   the action to be taken. Valid actions are defined in section
   16.1.

   If the Xkb keyboard map for the key does not have its
   ExplicitVModMap control set, the XkbSI_LevelOneOnly bit and
   symbol position are examined. If the XkbSI_LevelOneOnly bit is
   not set in match or the symbol is in position G1L1, the
   virtual_mod field is examined. If virtual_mod is not
   XkbNoModifier , virtual_mod specifies a single virtual modifier
   to be added to the virtual modifier map for the key.
   virtual_mod is specified as an index in the range [0..15].

   If the matching symbol is in position G1L1 of the key, two bits
   in the flags field potentially specify additional behavior
   modifications:
#define      XkbSI_AutoRepeat    (1<<0)
                                 /* key repeats if sym is in position G1
L1 */
#define      XkbSI_LockingKey    (1<<1)
                                 /* set  KB_Lock
                                    behavior if sym is in psn G1L1 */

   If the Xkb keyboard map for the key does not have its
   ExplicitAutoRepeat control set, its auto repeat behavior is set
   based on the value of the XkbSI_AutoRepeat bit. If the
   XkbSI_AutoRepeat bit is set, the auto-repeat behavior of the
   key is turned on; otherwise, it is turned off.

   If the Xkb keyboard map for the key does not have its
   ExplicitBehavior control set, its locking behavior is set based
   on the value of the XkbSI_LockingKey bit. If XkbSI_LockingKey
   is set, the key behavior is set to KB_Lock ; otherwise, it is
   turned off (see section 16.3).

Xkb Keyboard Mapping to Core Keyboard Mapping Transformations

   Whenever the server processes Xkb requests to change the
   keyboard mapping, it discards the affected portion of its core
   keyboard mapping and regenerates it based on the new Xkb
   mapping.

   When the Xkb mapping for a key is transformed to a core
   protocol mapping, the symbols for the core map are taken in the
   following order from the Xkb map:

   G1L1 G1L2 G2L1 G2L2 G1L3-n G2L3-n G3L1-n G4L1-n

   If group one is of width one in the Xkb map, G1L2 is taken to
   be NoSymbol; similarly, if group two is of width one in the Xkb
   map, G2L2 is taken to be NoSymbol.

   If the Xkb key map for a particular key has fewer groups than
   the core keyboard, the symbols for group one are repeated to
   fill in the missing core components. For example, an Xkb key
   with a single width-three group would be mapped to a core
   mapping counting three groups as:

   G1L1 G1L2 G1L1 G1L2 G1L3 G1L3 G1L1 G1L2 G1L3

   When a core keyboard map entry is generated from an Xkb
   keyboard map entry, a modifier mapping is generated as well.
   The modifier mapping contains all of the modifiers affected by
   any of the actions associated with the key combined with all of
   the real modifiers associated with any of the virtual modifiers
   bound to the key. In addition, if any of the actions associated
   with the key affect any component of the keyboard group, all of
   the modifiers in the mask field of all of the group
   compatibility maps are added to the modifier mapping as well.
   While an XkbSA_ISOLock action can theoretically affect any
   modifier, if the Xkb mapping for a key specifies an
   XkbSA_ISOLock action, only the modifiers or group that are set
   by default are added to the modifier mapping.

Getting Compatibility Map Components From the Server

   Use XkbGetCompatMap to fetch any combination of the current
   compatibility map components from the server. When another
   client modifies the compatibility map, you are notified if you
   have selected for XkbCompatMapNotify events (see section 17.5).
   XkbGetCompatMap is particularly useful when you receive an
   event of this type, as it allows you to update your program's
   version of the compatibility map to match the modified version
   now in the server. If your program is dealing with multiple
   servers and needs to configure them all in a similar manner,
   the updated compatibility map may be used to reconfigure other
   servers.

Note

   To make a complete matching configuration you must also update
   the explicit override components of the server state.
   Status XkbGetCompatMap ( display, which, xkb )
   Display * display ; /* connection to server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of compatibility map components to
   fetch */
   XkbDescRec * xkb ; /* keyboard description where results placed
   */

   XkbGetCompatMap fetches the components of the compatibility map
   specified in which from the server specified by display and
   places them in the compat structure of the keyboard description
   xkb . Valid values for which are an inclusive OR of the values
   shown in Table 17.2.

   Table 17.2. Compatibility Map Component Masks
   Mask               Value  Affecting
   XkbSymInterpMask   (1<<0) Symbol interpretations
   XkbGroupCompatMask (1<<1) Group maps
   XkbAllCompatMask   (0x3)  All compatibility map components

   If no compatibility map structure is allocated in xkb upon
   entry, XkbGetCompatMap allocates one. If one already exists,
   its contents are overwritten with the returned results.

   XkbGetCompatMap fetches compatibility map information for the
   device specified by the device_spec field of xkb . Unless you
   have specifically modified this field, it is the default
   keyboard device. XkbGetCompatMap returns Success if successful,
   BadAlloc if it is unable to obtain necessary storage for either
   the return values or work space, BadMatch if the dpy field of
   the xkb argument is non- NULL and does not match the display
   argument, and BadLength under certain conditions caused by
   server or Xkb implementation errors.

Using the Compatibility Map

   Xkb provides several functions that make it easier to apply the
   compatibility map to configure a client-side Xkb keyboard
   mapping, given a core protocol representation of part or all of
   a keyboard mapping. Obtain a core protocol representation of a
   keyboard mapping from an actual server (by using
   XGetKeyboardMapping , for example), a data file, or some other
   source.

   To update a local Xkb keyboard map to reflect the mapping
   expressed by a core format mapping by calling the function
   XkbUpdateMapFromCore .
   Bool XkbUpdateMapFromCore ( xkb , first_key , num_keys ,
   map_width , core_keysyms , changes )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to update */
   KeyCode first_key ; /* keycode of first key description to
   update */
   int num_keys ; /* number of key descriptions to update */
   int map_width ; /* width of core protocol keymap */
   KeySym * core_keysyms ; /* symbols in core protocol keymap */
   XkbChangesPtr changes ; /* backfilled with changes made to Xkb
   */

   XkbUpdateMapFromCore interprets input argument information
   representing a keyboard map in core format to update the Xkb
   keyboard description passed in xkb . Only a portion of the Xkb
   map is updated -- the portion corresponding to keys with
   keycodes in the range first_key through first_key + num_keys -
   1. If XkbUpdateMapFromCore is being called in response to a
   MappingNotify event , first_key and num_keys are reported in
   the MappingNotify event. core_keysyms contains the keysyms
   corresponding to the keycode range being updated, in core
   keyboard description order. map_width is the number of keysyms
   per key in core_keysyms . Thus, the first map_width entries in
   core_keysyms are for the key with keycode first_key , the next
   map_width entries are for key first_key + 1, and so on.

   In addition to modifying the Xkb keyboard mapping in xkb ,
   XkbUpdateMapFromCore backfills the changes structure whose
   address is passed in changes to indicate the modifications that
   were made. You may then use changes in subsequent calls such as
   XkbSetMap , to propagate the local modifications to a server.

   When dealing with core keyboard mappings or descriptions, it is
   sometimes necessary to determine the Xkb key types appropriate
   for the symbols bound to a key in a core keyboard mapping. Use
   XkbKeyTypesForCoreSymbols for this purpose:
   int XkbKeyTypesForCoreSymbols ( map_width , core_syms ,
   protected, types_inout, xkb_syms_rtrn )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description in which to place
   symbols*/
   int map_width ; /* width of core protocol keymap in
   xkb_syms_rtrn */
   KeySym * core_syms ; /* core protocol format array of KeySyms
   */
   unsigned int protected ; /* explicit key types */
   int * types_inout; /* backfilled with the canonical types bound
   to groups one and two for the key */
   KeySym * xkb_syms_rtrn ; /* backfilled with symbols bound to
   the key in the Xkb mapping */

   XkbKeyTypesForCoreSymbols expands the symbols in core_syms and
   types in types_inout according to the rules specified in
   section 12 of the core protocol, then chooses canonical key
   types (canonical key types are defined in section 15.2.1) for
   groups 1 and 2 using the rules specified by the Xkb protocol
   and places them in xkb_syms_rtrn , which will be non- NULL .

   A core keymap is a two-dimensional array of keysyms. It has
   map_width columns and max_key_code rows.
   XkbKeyTypesForCoreSymbols takes a single row from a core
   keymap, determines the number of groups associated with it, the
   type of each group, and the symbols bound to each group. The
   return value is the number of groups, types_inout has the types
   for each group, and xkb_syms_rtrn has the symbols in Xkb order
   (that is, groups are contiguous, regardless of size).

   protected contains the explicitly protected key types. There is
   one explicit override control associated with each of the four
   possible groups for each Xkb key, ExplicitKeyType1 through
   ExplicitKeyType4 ; protected is an inclusive OR of these
   controls. map_width is the width of the core keymap and is not
   dependent on any Xkb definitions. types_inout is an array of
   four type indices. On input, types_inout contains the indices
   of any types already assigned to the key, in case they are
   explicitly protected from change.

   Upon return, types_inout contains any automatically selected
   (that is, canonical) types plus any protected types. Canonical
   types are assigned to all four groups if there are enough
   symbols to do so. The four entries in types_inout correspond to
   the four groups for the key in question.

   If the groups mapping does not change, but the symbols assigned
   to an Xkb keyboard compatibility map do change, the semantics
   of the key may be modified. To apply the new compatibility
   mapping to an individual key to get its semantics updated, use
   XkbApplyCompatMapToKey .
   Bool XkbApplyCompatMapToKey ( xkb , key , changes )
   XkbDescPtr xkb; /* keyboard description to be updated */
   KeyCode key ; /* key to be updated */
   XkbChangesPtr changes ; /* notes changes to the Xkb keyboard
   description */

   XkbApplyCompatMapToKey essentially performs the operation
   described in section 17.1.2 to a specific key. This updates the
   behavior, actions, repeat status, and virtual modifier bindings
   of the key.

Changing the Server's Compatibility Map

   To modify the server's compatibility map, first modify a local
   copy of the Xkb compatibility map, then call XkbSetCompatMap .
   You may allocate a new compatibility map for this purpose using
   XkbAllocCompatMap (see section 17.6). You may also use a
   compatibility map from another server, although you need to
   adjust the device_spec field in the XkbDescRec accordingly.
   Note that symbol interpretations in a compatibility map (
   sym_interpret , the vector of XkbSymInterpretRec structures)
   are also allocated using this same function.
   Bool XkbSetCompatMap ( display, which, xkb, update_actions )
   Display * display ; /* connection to server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of compat map components to set */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* source for compat map components */
   Bool update_actions ; /* True => apply to server's keyboard map
   */

   XkbSetCompatMap copies compatibility map information from the
   keyboard description in xkb to the server specified in display
   's compatibility map for the device specified by the
   device_spec field of xkb . Unless you have specifically
   modified this field, it is the default keyboard device. which
   specifies the compatibility map components to be set, and is an
   inclusive OR of the bits shown in Table 17.2.

   After updating its compatibility map for the specified device,
   if update_actions is True, the server applies the new
   compatibility map to its entire keyboard for the device to
   generate a new set of key semantics, compatibility state, and a
   new core keyboard map. If update_actions is False , the new
   compatibility map is not used to generate any modifications to
   the current device semantics, state, or core keyboard map. One
   reason for not applying the compatibility map immediately would
   be if one server was being configured to match another on a
   piecemeal basis; the map should not be applied until everything
   is updated. To force an update at a later time, use
   XkbSetCompatMap specifying which as zero and update_actions as
   True .

   XkbSetCompatMap returns True if successful and False if
   unsuccessful. The server may report problems it encounters when
   processing the request subsequently via protocol errors.

   To add a symbol interpretation to the list of symbol
   interpretations in an XkbCompatRec , use XkbAddSymInterpret .
   XkbSymInterpretPtr XkbAddSymInterpret ( xkb, si, updateMap,
   changes )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to be updated */
   XkbSymInterpretPtr si ; /* symbol interpretation to be added */
   Bool updateMap ; /* True =>apply compatibility map to keys */
   XkbChangesPtr changes ; /* changes are put here */

   XkbAddSymInterpret adds si to the list of symbol
   interpretations in xkb . If updateMap is True , it (re)applies
   the compatibility map to all of the keys on the keyboard. If
   changes is non- NULL , it reports the parts of the keyboard
   that were affected (unless updateMap is True , not much
   changes). XkbAddSymInterpret returns a pointer to the actual
   new symbol interpretation in the list or NULL if it failed.

Tracking Changes to the Compatibility Map

   The server automatically generates MappingNotify events when
   the keyboard mapping changes. If you wish to be notified of
   changes to the compatibility map, you should select for
   XkbCompatMapNotify events. If you select for XkbMapNotify
   events, you no longer receive the automatically generated
   MappingNotify events. If you subsequently deselect
   XkbMapNotifyEvent delivery, you again receive MappingNotify
   events.

   To receive XkbCompatMapNotify events under all possible
   conditions, use XkbSelectEvents (see section 4.3) and pass
   XkbCompatMapNotifyMask in both bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits .

   To receive XkbCompatMapNotify events only under certain
   conditions, use XkbSelectEventDetails using XkbCompatMapNotify
   as the event_type and specifying the desired map changes in
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits using mask bits from Table
   17.2.

   Note that you are notified of changes you make yourself, as
   well as changes made by other clients.

   The structure for the XkbCompatMapNotifyEvent is:
typedef struct {
      int            type;          /* Xkb extension base event code */
      unsigned long  serial;        /* X server serial number for event
*/
      Bool           send_event;    /* True =>
                                       synthetically generated */
      Display *      display;       /* server connection where event gen
erated */
      Time           time;          /* server time when event generated
*/
      int            xkb_type;      /* XkbCompatMapNotify */
      int            device;        /* Xkb device ID, will not be
                                       XkbUseCoreKbd */
      unsigned int   changed_groups;/* number of group maps changed */
      int            first_si;      /* index to 1st changed symbol
                                       interpretation */
      int            num_si;        /* number of changed symbol
                                       interpretations */
      int            num_total_si;  /* total number of valid symbol
                                       interpretations */
} XkbCompatMapNotifyEvent;

   changed_groups is the number of group compatibility maps that
   have changed. If you are maintaining a corresponding copy of
   the compatibility map, or get a fresh copy from the server
   using XkbGetCompatMap , changed_groups references groups [0..
   changed_groups -1] in the XkbCompatMapRec structure.

   first_si is the index of the first changed symbol
   interpretation, num_si is the number of changed symbol
   interpretations, and num_total_si is the total number of valid
   symbol interpretations. If you are maintaining a corresponding
   copy of the compatibility map, or get a fresh copy from the
   server using XkbGetCompatMap , first_si , num_si , and
   num_total_si are appropriate for use with the
   compat.sym_interpret vector in this structure.

Allocating and Freeing the Compatibility Map

   If you are modifying the compatibility map, you need to
   allocate a new compatibility map if you do not already have one
   available. To do so, use XkbAllocCompatMap .
   Status XkbAllocCompatMap ( xkb, which, num_si )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description in which to allocate
   compat map */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of compatibility map components to
   allocate */
   unsigned int num_si ; /* number of symbol interpretations to
   allocate */

   xkb specifies the keyboard description for which compatibility
   maps are to be allocated. The compatibility map is the compat
   field in this structure.

   which specifies the compatibility map components to be
   allocated (see XkbGetCompatMap , in section 17.2). which is an
   inclusive OR of the bits shown in Table 17.2.

   num_si specifies the total number of entries to allocate in the
   symbol interpretation vector ( xkb.compat.sym_interpret ).

   Note that symbol interpretations in a compatibility map (the
   sym_interpret vector of XkbSymInterpretRec structures) are also
   allocated using this same function. To ensure that there is
   sufficient space in the symbol interpretation vector for
   entries to be added, use XkbAllocCompatMap specifying which as
   XkbSymInterpretMask and the number of free symbol
   interpretations needed in num_si .

   XkbAllocCompatMap returns Success if successful, BadMatch if
   xkb is NULL , or BadAlloc if errors are encountered when
   attempting to allocate storage.

   To free an entire compatibility map or selected portions of
   one, use XkbFreeCompatMap .
   void XkbFreeCompatMap ( xkb, which, free_map )
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* Xkb description in which to free
   compatibility map */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of compatibility map components to
   free */
   Bool free_map ; /* True => free XkbCompatMap structure itself
   */

   which specifies the compatibility map components to be freed
   (see XkbGetCompatMap , in section 17.2). which is an inclusive
   OR of the bits shown in Table 17.2

   free_map indicates whether the XkbCompatMap structure itself
   should be freed. If free_map is True , which is ignored, all
   non- NULL compatibility map components are freed, and the
   compat field in the XkbDescRec referenced by xkb is set to NULL
   .

Chapter 18. Symbolic Names

   Table of Contents

   The XkbNamesRec Structure
   Symbolic Names Masks
   Getting Symbolic Names From the Server
   Changing Symbolic Names on the Server

   Tracking Name Changes
   Allocating and Freeing Symbolic Names

   The core protocol does not provide any information to clients
   other than that actually used to interpret events. This makes
   it difficult to write an application that presents the keyboard
   to a user in an easy-to-understand way. Such applications have
   to examine the vendor string and keycodes to determine the type
   of keyboard connected to the server and then examine keysyms
   and modifier mappings to determine the effects of most
   modifiers (the Shift , Lock and Control modifiers are defined
   by the core protocol but no semantics are implied for any other
   modifiers).

   To make it easier for applications to present a keyboard to the
   user, Xkb supports symbolic names for most components of the
   keyboard extension. Most of these symbolic names are grouped
   into the names component of the keyboard description.

The XkbNamesRec Structure

   The names component of the keyboard description is defined as
   follows:
#define      XkbKeyNameLength      4
#define      XkbKeyNumVirtualMods  16
#define      XkbKeyNumIndicators   32
#define      XkbKeyNumKbdGroups    4
#define      XkbMaxRadioGroups     32

typedef struct {
      char      name[XkbKeyNameLength];      /* symbolic key names */
} XkbKeyNameRec,*XkbKeyNamePtr;

typedef struct {
      char      real[XkbKeyNameLength];
                /* this key name must be in the keys array */
      char      alias[XkbKeyNameLength];
                /* symbolic key name as alias for the key */
} XkbKeyAliasRec,*XkbKeyAliasPtr;

typedef struct _XkbNamesRec {
      Atom      keycodes;      /* identifies range and meaning of keycod
es */
      Atom      geometry;      /* identifies physical location, size, an
d shape of keys */
      Atom      symbols;       /* identifies the symbols logically bound
 to the keys */
      Atom      types;         /* identifies the set of key types */
      Atom      compat;        /* identifies actions for keys using core
 protocol */
      Atom      vmods[XkbNumVirtualMods]; /* symbolic names for virtual
modifiers */
      Atom      indicators[XkbNumIndicators];   /* symbolic names for in
dicators */
      Atom      groups[XkbNumKbdGroups]; /* symbolic names for keyboard
groups */
      XkbKeyNamePtr      keys;         /* symbolic key name array */
      XkbKeyAliasPtr     key_aliases;  /* real/alias symbolic name pairs
 array */
      Atom *    radio_groups;      /* radio group name array */
      Atom      phys_symbols;      /* identifies the symbols engraved on
 the keyboard */
      unsigned char      num_keys; /* number of keys in the  keys array
*/
      unsigned char      num_key_aliases;  /* number of keys in the
                                               key_aliases array */
      unsigned short     num_rg;      /* number of radio groups */
} XkbNamesRec,*XkbNamesPtr;      /*

   The keycodes name identifies the range and meaning of the
   keycodes returned by the keyboard in question. The geometry
   name, on the other hand, identifies the physical location, size
   and shape of the various keys on the keyboard. As an example to
   distinguish between these two names, consider function keys on
   PC-compatible keyboards. Function keys are sometimes above the
   main keyboard and sometimes to the left of the main keyboard,
   but the same keycode is used for the key that is logically F1
   regardless of physical position. Thus, all PC-compatible
   keyboards share a similar keycodes name but may have different
   geometry names.

Note

   The keycodes name is intended to be a very general description
   of the keycodes returned by a keyboard; a single keycodes name
   might cover keyboards with differing numbers of keys provided
   all keys have the same semantics when present. For example, 101
   and 102 key PC keyboards might use the same name. In these
   cases, applications can use the keyboard geometry name to
   determine which subset of the named keycodes is in use.

   The symbols name identifies the symbols logically bound to the
   keys. The symbols name is a human or application-readable
   description of the intended locale or usage of the keyboard
   with these symbols. The phys_symbols name, on the other hand,
   identifies the symbols actually engraved on the keyboard. Given
   this, the symbols name and phys_symbols names might be
   different. For example, the description for a keyboard that has
   English US engravings, but that is using Swiss German symbols
   might have a phys_symbols name of "en_US" and a symbols name of
   "de_CH."

   The types name provides some information about the set of key
   types (see section 15.2) that can be associated with the
   keyboard. In addition, each key type can have a name, and each
   shift level of a type can have a name. Although these names are
   stored in the map description with each of the types, they are
   accessed using the same methods as the other symbolic names.

   The compat name provides some information about the rules used
   to bind actions to keys that are changed using core protocol
   requests.

   Xkb provides symbolic names for each of the 4 keyboard groups,
   16 virtual modifiers, 32 keyboard indicators, and 4 keyboard
   groups. These names are held in the vmods , indicators , and
   groups fixed-length arrays.

   Each key has a four-byte symbolic name. All of the symbolic key
   names are held in the keys array, and num_keys reports the
   number of entries that are in the keys array. For each key, the
   key name links keys with similar functions or in similar
   positions on keyboards that report different keycodes. For
   example, the F1 key may emit keycode 23 on one keyboard and
   keycode 86 on another. By naming this key "FK01" on both
   keyboards, the keyboard layout designer can reuse parts of
   keyboard descriptions for different keyboards.

   Key aliases allow the keyboard layout designer to assign
   multiple key names to a single key. This allows the keyboard
   layout designer to refer to keys using either their position or
   their "function." For example, a keyboard layout designer may
   wish to refer to the left arrow key on a PC keyboard using the
   ISO9995-5 positional specification of A31 or using the
   functional specification of LEFT. The key_aliases field holds a
   variable-length array of real and alias key name pairs, and the
   total number of entries in the key_aliases array is held in
   num_key_aliases . For each real and alias key name pair, the
   real field refers to the a name in the keys array, and the
   alias field refers to the alias for that key. Using the
   previous example, the keyboard designer may use the name A31 in
   the keys array, but also define the name LEFT as an alias for
   A31 in the key_aliases array.

Note

   Key aliases defined in the geometry component of a keyboard
   mapping (see Chapter 13) override those defined in the keycodes
   component of the server database, which are stored in the
   XkbNamesRec ( xkb->names ). Therefore, consider the key aliases
   defined by the geometry before considering key aliases supplied
   by the XkbNamesRec .

   A radio group is a set of keys whose behavior simulates a set
   of radio buttons. Once a key in a radio group is pressed, it
   stays logically depressed until another key in the group is
   pressed, at which point the previously depressed key is
   logically released. Consequently, at most one key in a radio
   group can be logically depressed at one time.

   Each radio group in the keyboard description can have a name.
   These names are held in the variable-length array radio_groups
   , and num_rg tells how many elements are in the radio_groups
   array.

Symbolic Names Masks

   Xkb provides several functions that work with symbolic names.
   Each of these functions uses a mask to specify individual
   fields of the structures described above. These masks and their
   relationships to the fields in a keyboard description are shown
   in Table 18.1.

   Table 18.1. Symbolic Names Masks
   Mask Bit Value Keyboard Component Field
   XkbKeycodesNameMask (1<<0) Xkb->names keycodes
   XkbGeometryNameMask (1<<1) Xkb->names geometry
   XkbSymbolsNameMask (1<<2) Xkb->names symbols
   XkbPhysSymbolsNameMask (1<<3) Xkb->names phys_symbols
   XkbTypesNameMask (1<<4) Xkb->names type
   XkbCompatNameMask (1<<5) Xkb->names compat
   XkbKeyTypeNamesMask (1<<6) Xkb->map type[*].name
   XkbKTLevelNamesMask (1<<7) Xkb->map type[*].lvl_names[*]
   XkbIndicatorNamesMask (1<<8) Xkb->names indicators[*]
   XkbKeyNamesMask (1<<9) Xkb->names keys[*], num_keys
   XkbKeyAliasesMask (1<<10) Xkb->names key_aliases[*],
   num_key_aliases
   XkbVirtualModNamesMask (1<<11) Xkb->names vmods[*]
   XkbGroupNamesMask (1<<12) Xkb->names groups[*]
   XkbRGNamesMask (1<<13) Xkb->names radio_groups[*], num_rg
   XkbComponentNamesMask (0x3f) Xkb->names

   keycodes,

   geometry,

   symbols,

   physical symbols,

   types, and

   compatibility map
   XkbAllNamesMask (0x3fff) Xkb->names all name components

Getting Symbolic Names From the Server

   To obtain symbolic names from the server, use XkbGetNames .
   Status XkbGetNames ( dpy, which, Xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of names or map components to be
   updated */
   XkbDescPtr xkb /* keyboard description to be updated */

   XkbGetNames retrieves symbolic names for the components of the
   keyboard extension from the X server. The which parameter
   specifies the name components to be updated in the xkb
   parameter, and is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid names
   mask bits defined in Table 18.1.

   If the names field of the keyboard description xkb is NULL ,
   XkbGetNames allocates and initializes the names component of
   the keyboard description before obtaining the values specified
   by which . If the names field of xkb is not NULL , XkbGetNames
   obtains the values specified by which and copies them into the
   keyboard description Xkb .

   If the map component of the xkb parameter is NULL , XkbGetNames
   does not retrieve type or shift level names, even if
   XkbKeyTypeNamesMask or XkbKTLevelNamesMask are set in which .

   XkbGetNames can return Success , or BadAlloc , BadLength ,
   BadMatch , and BadImplementation errors.

   To free symbolic names, use XkbFreeNames (see section 18.6)

Changing Symbolic Names on the Server

   To change the symbolic names in the server, first modify a
   local copy of the keyboard description and then use either
   XkbSetNames, or, to save network traffic, use a
   XkbNameChangesRec structure and call XkbChangeNames to download
   the changes to the server. XkbSetNames and XkbChangeNames can
   generate BadAlloc , BadAtom , BadLength , BadMatch, and
   BadImplementation errors.
   Bool XkbSetNames ( dpy, which, first_type, num_types, xkb )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of names or map components to be
   changed */
   unsigned int first_type ; /* first type whose name is to be
   changed */
   unsigned int num_types ; /* number of types for which names are
   to be changed */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description from which names are
   to be taken */

   Use XkbSetNames to change many names at the same time. For each
   bit set in which , XkbSetNames takes the corresponding value
   (or values in the case of arrays) from the keyboard description
   xkb and sends it to the server.

   The first_type and num_types arguments are used only if
   XkbKeyTypeNamesMask or XkbKTLevelNamesMask is set in which and
   specify a subset of the types for which the corresponding names
   are to be changed. If either or both of these mask bits are set
   but the specified types are illegal, XkbSetNames returns False
   and does not update any of the names specified in which . The
   specified types are illegal if xkb does not include a map
   component or if first_type and num_types specify types that are
   not defined in the keyboard description.

The XkbNameChangesRec Structure

   The XkbNameChangesRec allows applications to identify small
   modifications to the symbolic names and effectively reduces the
   amount of traffic sent to the server:
typedef struct _XkbNameChanges {
      unsigned int      changed;            /* name components that have
                                               changed */
      unsigned char      first_type;        /* first key type with a new
                                               name */
      unsigned char      num_types;         /* number of types with new
                                               names */
      unsigned char      first_lvl;         /* first key type with new l
evel
                                               names */
      unsigned char      num_lvls;          /* number of key types with
new
                                               level names */
      unsigned char      num_aliases;       /* if key aliases changed,
                                               total number of key alias
es */
      unsigned char      num_rg;            /* if radio groups changed,
total
                                               number of radio groups */
      unsigned char      first_key;         /* first key with a new name
 */
      unsigned char      num_keys;          /* number of keys with new n
ames
                                               */
      unsigned short      changed_vmods;    /* mask of virtual
                                               modifiers for which names
 have changed */
      unsigned long      changed_indicators;  /* mask of indicators
                                                 for which names were ch
anged */
      unsigned char       changed_groups;   /* mask of groups for
                                               which names were changed
*/
} XkbNameChangesRec, *XkbNameChangesPtr

   The changed field specifies the name components that have
   changed and is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid names mask
   bits defined in Table 18.1. The rest of the fields in the
   structure specify the ranges that have changed for the various
   kinds of symbolic names, as shown in Table 18.2.

   Table 18.2. XkbNameChanges Fields
   Mask                   Fields              Component  Field
   XkbKeyTypeNamesMask

   first_type,

   num_types
   Xkb->map               type[*].name
   XkbKTLevelNamesMask

   first_lvl,

   num_lvls
   Xkb->map               type[*].lvl_names[*]
   XkbKeyAliasesMask      num_aliases         Xkb->names key_aliases[*]
   XkbRGNamesMask         num_rg              Xkb->names radio_groups[*]
   XkbKeyNamesMask

   first_key,

   num_keys
   Xkb->names             keys[*]
   XkbVirtualModNamesMask changed_vmods       Xkb->names vmods[*]
   XkbIndicatorNamesMask  changed_indicators  Xkb->names
   indicators[*]
   XkbGroupNamesMask      changed_groups      Xkb->names groups[*]

   XkbChangeNames provides a more flexible method for changing
   symbolic names than XkbSetNames and requires the use of an
   XkbNameChangesRec structure.
   Bool XkbChangeNames ( dpy, xkb, changes )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description from which names are
   to be taken */
   XkbNameChangesPtr changes ; /* names map components to be
   updated on the server */

   XkbChangeNames copies any names specified by changes from the
   keyboard description, xkb , to the X server specified by dpy .
   XkbChangeNames aborts and returns False if any illegal type
   names or type shift level names are specified by changes .

Tracking Name Changes

   Whenever a symbolic name changes in the server's keyboard
   description, the server sends a XkbNamesNotify event to all
   interested clients. To receive name notify events, use
   XkbSelectEvents (see section 4.3) with XkbNamesNotifyMask in
   both the bits_to_change and values_for_bits parameters.

   To receive events for only specific names, use
   XkbSelectEventDetails . Set the event_type parameter to
   XkbNamesNotify , and set both the bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits detail parameter to a mask composed of a
   bitwise OR of masks in Table 18.1.

   The structure for the XkbNamesNotify event is defined as
   follows:
typedef struct {
      int      type;                  /* Xkb extension base event code *
/
      unsigned long      serial;      /* X server serial number for
                                         event */
      Bool      send_event;           /* True
                                         => synthetically generated */
      Display *      display;         /* server connection where event
                                         generated */
      Time      time;                 /* server time when event generate
d */
      int      xkb_type;              /* XkbNamesNotify */
      int      device;                /* Xkb device ID, will not be
                                         XkbUseCoreKbd */
      unsigned int      changed;      /* mask of name components
that have changed */
      int      first_type;            /* first key type with a new name
*/
      int      num_types;             /* number of types with new names
*/
      int      first_lvl;             /* first key type with new level n
ames */
      int      num_lvls;              /* number of key types with new le
vel names */
      int      num_aliases;           /* if key aliases changed, total n
umber
                                         of key aliases */
      int      num_radio_groups;      /* if radio groups changed,
                                         total number of radio groups */
      unsigned int      changed_vmods;  /* mask of virtual modifiers for
                                           which names have changed */
      unsigned int      changed_groups; /* mask of groups for
                                           which names were changed */
      unsigned int      changed_indicators;  /* mask of indicators for w
hich
                                                names were changed */
      int      first_key;             /* first key with a new name */
      int      num_keys;              /* number of keys with new names *
/
} XkbNamesNotifyEvent;

   The changed field specifies the name components that have
   changed and is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid names mask
   bits defined in Table 18.1. The other fields in this event are
   interpreted as the like-named fields in an XkbNameChangesRec ,
   as previously defined.

   When your application receives a X kbNamesNotify event, you can
   note the changed names in a changes structure using
   XkbNoteNameChanges .
   void XkbNoteNameChanges ( old , new , wanted )
   XkbNameChangesPtr old ; /* XkbNameChanges structure to be
   updated */
   XkbNamesNotifyEvent * new ; /* event from which changes are to
   be copied */
   unsigned int wanted ; /* types of names for which changes are
   to be noted */

   The wanted parameter is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid
   names mask bits shown in Table 18.1. XkbNoteNameChanges copies
   any changes that are reported in new and specified in wanted
   into the changes record specified by old .

   To update the local copy of the keyboard description with the
   actual values, pass to XkbGetNameChanges the results of one or
   more calls to XkbNoteNameChanges .
   Status XkbGetNameChanges ( dpy , xkb , changes )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to the X server */
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description to which names are
   copied */
   XkbNameChangesPtr changes ; /* names components to be obtained
   from the server */

   XkbGetNameChanges examines the changes parameter, retrieves the
   necessary information from the server, and places the results
   into the xkb keyboard description.

   XkbGetNamesChanges can generate BadAlloc , BadImplementation,
   and BadMatch errors.

Allocating and Freeing Symbolic Names

   Most applications do not need to directly allocate symbolic
   names structures. Do not allocate a names structure directly
   using malloc or Xmalloc if your application changes the number
   of key aliases or radio groups or constructs a symbolic names
   structure without loading the necessary components from the X
   server. Instead use XkbAllocNames .
   Status XkbAllocNames ( xkb, which, num_rg, num_key_aliases)
   XkbDescPtr xkb; /* keyboard description for which names are to
   be allocated */
   unsigned int which; /* mask of names to be allocated */
   int num_rg; /* total number of radio group names needed */
   int num_key_aliases; /* total number of key aliases needed */

   XkbAllocNames can return BadAlloc , BadMatch, and BadValue
   errors. The which parameter is the bitwise inclusive OR of the
   valid names mask bits defined in Table 18.1.

   Do not free symbolic names structures directly using free or
   XFree . Use XkbFreeNames instead.
   void XkbFreeNames ( xkb, which, free_map)
   XkbDescPtr xkb ; /* keyboard description for which names are to
   be freed */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of names components to be freed */
   Bool free_map ; /* True => XkbNamesRec structure itself should
   be freed */

   The which parameter is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid
   names mask bits defined in Table 18.1.

Chapter 19. Replacing a Keyboard "On the Fly"

   Some operating system and X server implementations allow "hot
   plugging" of input devices. When using these implementations,
   input devices can be unplugged and new ones plugged in without
   restarting the software that is using those devices. There is
   no provision in the standard X server for notification of
   client programs if input devices are unplugged and/or new ones
   plugged in. In the case of the X keyboard, this could result in
   the X server having a keymap that does not match the new
   keyboard.

   If the X server implementation supports the X input device
   extension, a client program may also change the X keyboard
   programmatically. The XChangeKeyboardDevice input extension
   request allows a client to designate an input extension
   keyboard device as the X keyboard, in which case the old X
   keyboard device becomes inaccessible except via the input
   device extension. In this case, core protocol XMappingNotify
   and input extension XChangeDeviceNotify events are generated to
   notify all clients that a new keyboard with a new keymap has
   been designated.

   When a client opens a connection to the X server, the server
   reports the minimum and maximum keycodes. The server keeps
   track of the minimum and maximum keycodes last reported to each
   client. When delivering events to a particular client, the
   server filters out any events that fall outside of the valid
   range for the client.

   Xkb provides an XkbNewKeyboardNotify event that reports a
   change in keyboard geometry and/or the range of supported
   keycodes. The server can generate an XkbNewKeyboardNotify event
   when it detects a new keyboard or in response to an
   XkbGetKeyboardByName request that loads a new keyboard
   description. Selecting for XkbNewKeyboardNotify events allows
   Xkb-aware clients to be notified whenever a keyboard change
   occurs that may affect the keymap.

   When a client requests XkbNewKeyboardNotify events, the server
   compares the range of keycodes for the current keyboard to the
   range of keycodes that are valid for the client. If they are
   not the same, the server immediately sends the client an
   XkbNewKeyboardNotify event. Even if the "new" keyboard is not
   new to the server, it is new to this particular client.

   When the server sends an XkbNewKeyboardNotify event to a client
   to inform it of a new keycode range, it resets the stored range
   of legal keycodes for the client to the keycode range reported
   in the event; it does not reset this range for the client if it
   does not sent an XkbNewKeyboardNotify event to a client.
   Because Xkb-unaware clients and Xkb-aware clients that do not
   request XkbNewKeyboardNotify events are never sent these
   events, the server's notion of the legal keycode range never
   changes, and these clients never receive events from keys that
   fall outside of their notion of the legal keycode range.

   Clients that have not selected to receive XkbNewKeyboardNotify
   events do, however, receive the XkbNewKeyboardNotify event when
   a keyboard change occurs. Clients that have not selected to
   receive this event also receive numerous other events detailing
   the individual changes that occur when a keyboard change
   occurs.

   Clients wishing to track changes in min_key_code and
   max_key_code must watch for both XkbNewKeyboardNotify and
   XkbMapNotify events, because a simple mapping change causes an
   XkbMapNotify event and may change the range of valid keycodes,
   but does not cause an XkbNewKeyboardNotify event. If a client
   does not select for XkbNewKeyboardNotify events, the server
   restricts the range of keycodes reported to the client.

   In addition to filtering out-of-range key events, Xkb:
     * Adjusts core protocol MappingNotify events to refer only to
       keys that match the stored legal range.
     * Reports keyboard mappings for keys that match the stored
       legal range to clients that issue a core protocol
       GetKeyboardMapping request.
     * Reports modifier mappings only for keys that match the
       stored legal range to clients that issue a core protocol
       GetModifierMapping request.
     * Restricts the core protocol ChangeKeyboardMapping and
       SetModifierMapping requests to keys that fall inside the
       stored legal range.

   In short, Xkb does everything possible to hide from Xkb-unaware
   clients the fact that the range of legal keycodes has changed,
   because such clients cannot be expected to deal with them. Xkb
   events and requests are not modified in this manner; all Xkb
   events report the full range of legal keycodes. No requested
   Xkb events are discarded, and no Xkb requests have their
   keycode range clamped.

   The structure for the XkbNewKeyboardNotify event is defined as
   follows:
typedef struct _XkbNewKeyboardNotify {
      int            type;         /* Xkb extension base event code */
      unsigned long  serial;       /* X server serial number for event*/
      Bool           send_event;   /* True
                                      => synthetically generated */
      Display *      display;      /* server connection where event gene
rated */
      Time           time;         /* server time when event generated *
/
      int            xkb_type;  /* XkbNewKeyboardNotify */
      int            device;       /* device ID of new keyboard */
      int            old_device;   /* device ID of old keyboard */
      int            min_key_code; /* min keycode of new keyboard */
      int            max_key_code; /* max keycode of new keyboard */
      int            old_min_key_code; /* min keycode of old keyboard */
      int            old_max_key_code; /* max keycode of old keyboard */
      unsigned int            changed; /* changed aspects - see masks be
low */
      char            req_major;   /* major request that caused change *
/
      char            req_minor;   /* minor request that caused change *
/
} XkbNewKeyboardNotifyEvent;

   To receive name notify events, use XkbSelectEvents (see section
   4.3) with XkbNewKeyboardNotifyMask in both the bits_to_change
   and values_for_bits parameters. To receive events for only
   specific names, use XkbSelectEventDetails . Set the event_type
   parameter to XkbNewKeyboardNotify , and set both the
   bits_to_change and values_for_bits detail parameter to a mask
   composed of a bitwise OR of masks in Table 19.1.

   Table 19.1. XkbNewKeyboardNotifyEvent Details
   XkbNewKeyboardNotify Event Details Value Circumstances
   XkbNKN_KeycodesMask (1L<<0) Notification of keycode range
   changes wanted
   XkbNKN_GeometryMask (1L<<1) Notification of geometry changes
   wanted
   XkbNKN_DeviceIDMask (1L<<2) Notification of device ID changes
   wanted
   XkbNKN_AllChangesMask (0x7) Includes all of the above masks

   The req_major and req_minor fields indicate what type of
   keyboard change has occurred.

   If req_major and req_minor are zero, the device change was not
   caused by a software request to the server -- a spontaneous
   change has occurred, such as hot-plugging a new device. In this
   case, device is the device identifier for the new, current X
   keyboard device, but no implementation-independent guarantee
   can be made about old_device . old_device may be identical to
   device (an implementor is permitted to reuse the device
   specifier when the device changes); or it may be different.
   Note that req_major and req_minor being zero do not necessarily
   mean that the physical keyboard device has changed; rather,
   they only imply a spontaneous change outside of software
   control (some systems have keyboards that can change
   personality at the press of a key).

   If the keyboard change is the result of an X Input Extension
   ChangeKeyboardDevice request, req_major contains the input
   extension major opcode, and req_minor contains the input
   extension request number for X_ChangeKeyboardDevice . In this
   case, device and old_device are different, with device being
   the identifier for the new, current X keyboard device, and
   old_device being the identifier for the former device.

   If the keyboard change is the result of an XkbGetKeyboardByName
   function call, which generates an X_kbGetKbdByName request,
   req_major contains the Xkb extension base event code (see
   section 2.4), and req_minor contains the event code for the Xkb
   extension request X_kbGetKbdByName . device contains the device
   identifier for the new device, but nothing definitive can be
   said for old_device ; it may be identical to device , or it may
   be different, depending on the implementation.

Chapter 20. Server Database of Keyboard Components

   Table of Contents

   Component Names
   Listing the Known Keyboard Components
   Component Hints
   Building a Keyboard Description Using the Server Database

   The X server maintains a database of keyboard components,
   identified by component type. The database contains all the
   information necessary to build a complete keyboard description
   for a particular device, as well as to assemble partial
   descriptions. Table 20.1 identifies the component types and the
   type of information they contain.

   Table 20.1. Server Database Keyboard Components
   Component Type Component Primary Contents May also contain
   Keymap

   Complete keyboard description

   Normally assembled using a complete component from each of the
   other types

   Keycodes

   Symbolic name for each key

   Minimum and maximum legal keycodes

   Aliases for some keys

   Symbolic names for indicators

   Description of indicators physically present
   Types Key types Real modifier bindings and symbolic names for
   some virtual modifiers
   Compatibility Rules used to assign actions to keysyms

   Maps for some indicators

   Real modifier bindings and symbolic names for some virtual
   modifiers
   Symbols

   Symbol mapping for keyboard keys

   Modifier mapping

   Symbolic names for groups

   Explicit actions and behaviors for some keys

   Real modifier bindings and symbolic names for some virtual
   modifiers
   Geometry Layout of the keyboard

   Aliases for some keys; overrides keycodes component aliases

   Symbolic names for some indicators

   Description of indicators physically present

   While a keymap is a database entry for a complete keyboard
   description, and therefore logically different from the
   individual component database entries, the rules for processing
   keymap entries are identical to those for the individual
   components. In the discussion that follows, the term component
   is used to refer to either individual components or a keymap.

   There may be multiple entries for each of the component types.
   An entry may be either complete or partial . Partial entries
   describe only a piece of the corresponding keyboard component
   and are designed to be combined with other entries of the same
   type to form a complete entry.

   For example, a partial symbols map might describe the
   differences between a common ASCII keyboard and some national
   layout. Such a partial map is not useful on its own because it
   does not include those symbols that are the same on both the
   ASCII and national layouts (such as function keys). On the
   other hand, this partial map can be used to configure any ASCII
   keyboard to use a national layout.

   When a keyboard description is built, the components are
   processed in the order in which they appear in Table 20.1;
   later definitions override earlier ones.

Component Names

   Component names have the form " class(member) " where class
   describes a subset of the available components for a particular
   type and the optional member identifies a specific component
   from that subset. For example, the name "atlantis(acme)" for a
   symbols component might specify the symbols used for the
   atlantis national keyboard layout by the vendor "acme." Each
   class has an optional default member -- references that specify
   a class but not a member refer to the default member of the
   class, if one exists. Xkb places no constraints on the
   interpretation of the class and member names used in component
   names.

   The class and member names are both specified using characters
   from the Latin-1 character set. Xkb implementations must accept
   all alphanumeric characters, minus (`-') and underscore (`_')
   in class or member names, and must not accept parentheses,
   plus, vertical bar, percent sign, asterisk, question mark, or
   white space. The use of other characters is
   implementation-dependent.

Listing the Known Keyboard Components

   You may ask the server for a list of components for one or more
   component types. The request takes the form of a set of
   patterns, one pattern for each of the component types,
   including a pattern for the complete keyboard description. To
   obtain this list, use XkbListComponents .
   XkbComponentListPtr XkbListComponents ( dpy , device_spec ,
   ptrns , max_inout )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   XkbComponentNamesPtr ptrns ; /* namelist for components of
   interest */
   int * max_inout ; /* max # returned names, # left over */

   XkbListComponents queries the server for a list of component
   names matching the patterns specified in ptrns . It waits for a
   reply and returns the matching component names in an
   XkbComponentListRec structure. When you are done using the
   structure, you should free it using XkbFreeComponentList .
   device_spec indicates a particular device in which the caller
   is interested. A server is allowed (but not required) to
   restrict its reply to portions of the database that are
   relevant for that particular device.

   ptrns is a pointer to an XkbComponentNamesRec , described
   below. Each of the fields in ptrns contains a pattern naming
   the components of interest. Each of the patterns is composed of
   characters from the ISO Latin1 encoding, but can contain only
   parentheses, the wildcard characters ` ? ' and ` * ', and
   characters permitted in a component class or member name (see
   section 20.1). A pattern may be NULL , in which case no
   components for that type is returned. Pattern matches with
   component names are case sensitive. The ` ? ' wildcard matches
   any single character, except a left or right parenthesis; the `
   * ' wildcard matches any number of characters, except a left or
   right parenthesis. If an implementation allows additional
   characters in a component class or member name other than those
   required by the Xkb extension (see section 20.1), the result of
   comparing one of the additional characters to either of the
   wildcard characters is implementation-dependent.

   If a pattern contains illegal characters, the illegal
   characters are ignored. The matching process is carried out as
   if the illegal characters were omitted from the pattern.

   max_inout is used to throttle the amount of data passed to and
   from the server. On input, it specifies the maximum number of
   names to be returned (the total number of names in all
   component categories). Upon return from XkbListComponents ,
   max_inout contains the number of names that matched the request
   but were not returned because of the limit.

   The component name patterns used to describe the request are
   passed to XkbListComponents using an XkbComponentNamesRec
   structure. This structure has no special allocation constraints
   or interrelationships with other structures; allocate and free
   this structure using standard malloc and free calls or their
   equivalent:
typedef struct _XkbComponentNames {
      char *       keymap;    /* keymap names */
      char *       keycodes;  /* keycode names */
      char *       types;     /* type names */
      char *       compat;    /* compatibility map names */
      char *       symbols;   /* symbol names */
      char *       geometry;  /* geometry names */
} XkbComponentNamesRec, *XkbComponentNamesPtr;

   XkbListComponents returns a pointer to an XkbComponentListRec :
typedef struct _XkbComponentList {
      int                  num_keymaps;     /* number of entries in keym
ap */
      int                  num_keycodes;    /* number of entries in keyc
odes */
      int                  num_types;       /* number of entries in type
s */
      int                  num_compat;      /* number of entries in comp
at */
      int                  num_symbols;     /* number of entries in symb
ols */
      int                  num_geometry;    /* number of entries in geom
etry;
      XkbComponentNamePtr  keymap;          /* keymap names */
      XkbComponentNamePtr  keycodes;        /* keycode names */
      XkbComponentNamePtr  types;           /* type names */
      XkbComponentNamePtr  compat;          /* compatibility map names *
/
      XkbComponentNamePtr  symbols;         /* symbol names */
      XkbComponentNamePtr  geometry;        /* geometry names */
} XkbComponentListRec, *XkbComponentListPtr;

typedef struct _XkbComponentName {
      unsigned short         flags;     /* hints regarding component nam
e */
      char *                 name;      /* name of component */
} XkbComponentNameRec, *XkbComponentNamePtr;

   Note that the structure used to specify patterns on input is an
   XkbComponentNamesRec , and that used to hold the individual
   component names upon return is an XkbComponentNameRec (no
   trailing `s' in Name).

   When you are done using the structure returned by
   XkbListComponents , free it using XkbFreeComponentList .
   void XkbFreeComponentList (list)
   XkbComponentListPtr list; /* pointer to XkbComponentListRec to
   free */

Component Hints

   A set of flags is associated with each component; these flags
   provide additional hints about the component's use. These hints
   are designated by bit masks in the flags field of the
   XkbComponentNameRec structures contained in the
   XkbComponentListRec returned from XkbListComponents . The least
   significant byte of the flags field has the same meaning for
   all types of keyboard components; the interpretation of the
   most significant byte is dependent on the type of component.
   The flags bits are defined in Table 20.2. The symbols hints in
   Table 20.2 apply only to partial symbols components (those with
   XkbLC_Partial also set); full symbols components are assumed to
   specify all of the pieces.

   The alphanumeric, modifier, keypad or function keys symbols
   hints should describe the primary intent of the component
   designer and should not be simply an exhaustive list of the
   kinds of keys that are affected. For example, national keyboard
   layouts affect primarily alphanumeric keys, but many affect a
   few modifier keys as well; such mappings should set only the
   XkbLC_AlphanumericKeys hint. In general, symbols components
   should set only one of the four flags ( XkbLC_AlternateGroup
   may be combined with any of the other flags).

   Table 20.2. XkbComponentNameRec Flags Bits
   Component Type Component Hints (flags) Meaning Value
   All Components

   XkbLC_Hidden
   Do not present to user (1L<<0)
     XkbLC_Default Default member of class (1L<<1)
     XkbLC_Partial Partial component (1L<<2)
   Keymap none
   Keycodes none
   Types none
   Compatibility none
   Symbols XkbLC_AlphanumericKeys Bindings primarily for
   alphanumeric keyboard section (1L<<8)
     XkbLC_ModifierKeys Bindings primarily for modifier keys
   (1L<<9)
     XkbLC_KeypadKeys Bindings primarily for numeric keypad keys
   (1L<<10)
     XkbLC_FunctionKeys Bindings primarily for function keys
   (1L<<11)
     XkbLC_AlternateGroup Bindings for an alternate group (1L<<12)
   Geometry none

Building a Keyboard Description Using the Server Database

   A client may request that the server fetch one or more
   components from its database and use those components to build
   a new server keyboard description. The new keyboard description
   may be built from scratch, or it may be built starting with the
   current keyboard description for a particular device. Once the
   keyboard description is built, all or part of it may be
   returned to the client. The parts returned to the client need
   not include all of the parts used to build the description. At
   the time it requests the server to build a new keyboard
   description, a client may also request that the server use the
   new description internally to replace the current keyboard
   description for a specific device, in which case the behavior
   of the device changes accordingly.

   To build a new keyboard description from a set of named
   components, and to optionally have the server use the resulting
   description to replace an active one, use XkbGetKeyboardByName
   .
   XkbDescPtr XkbGetKeyboardByName ( dpy , device_spec , names ,
   want , need , load )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   XkbComponentNamesPtr names ; /* names of components to fetch */
   unsigned int want ; /* desired structures in returned record */
   unsigned int need ; /* mandatory structures in returned record
   */
   Bool load ; /* True => load into device_spec */

   names contains a set of expressions describing the keyboard
   components the server should use to build the new keyboard
   description. want and need are bit fields describing the parts
   of the resulting keyboard description that should be present in
   the returned XkbDescRec .

   The individual fields in names are component expressions
   composed of keyboard component names (no wildcarding as may be
   used in XkbListComponents ), the special component name symbol
   `%', and the special operator characters ` + ' and ` | '. A
   component expression is parsed left to right, as follows:
     * The special component name " computed " may be used in
       keycodes component expressions and refers to a component
       consisting of a set of keycodes computed automatically by
       the server as needed.
     * The special component name " canonical " may be used in
       types component expressions and refers to a partial
       component defining the four standard key types: ALPHABETIC
       , ONE_LEVEL , TWO_LEVEL , and KEYPAD .
     * The special component name ` % ' refers to the keyboard
       description for the device specified in device_spec or the
       keymap names component. If a keymap names component is
       specified that does not begin with `+' or `|' and does not
       contain ` % ', then ` % ' refers to the description
       generated by the keymap names component. Otherwise, it
       refers to the keyboard description for device_spec .
     * The ` + ' operator specifies that the following component
       should override the currently assembled description; any
       definitions that are present in both components are taken
       from the second.
     * The ` | ' operator specifies that the next specified
       component should augment the currently assembled
       description; any definitions that are present in both
       components are taken from the first.
     * If the component expression begins with an operator, a
       leading ` % ' is implied.
     * If any unknown or illegal characters appear anywhere in the
       expression, the entire expression is invalid and is
       ignored.

   For example, if names->symbols contained the expression "+de",
   it specifies that the default member of the "de" class of
   symbols should be applied to the current keyboard mapping,
   overriding any existing definitions (it could also be written
   "+de(default)").

   Here is a slightly more involved example: the expression
   "acme(ascii)+de(basic)|iso9995-3" constructs a German (de)
   mapping for the ASCII keyboard supplied by the "acme" vendor.
   The new definition begins with the symbols for the ASCII
   keyboard for Acme ( acme(ascii) ), overrides them with
   definitions for the basic German keyboard ( de(basic) ), and
   then applies the definitions from the default iso9995-3
   keyboard ( iso9995-3 ) to any undefined keys or groups of keys
   (part three of the iso9995 standard defines a common set of
   bindings for the secondary group, but allows national layouts
   to override those definitions where necessary).

Note

   The interpretation of the above expression components (acme,
   ascii, de, basic, iso9995-3) is not defined by Xkb; only the
   operations and their ordering are.

   Note that the presence of a keymap names component that does
   not contain ` % ' (either explicit or implied by virtue of an
   expression starting with an operator) indicates a description
   that is independent of the keyboard description for the device
   specified in device_spec . The same is true of requests in
   which the keymap names component is empty and all five other
   names components contain expressions void of references to ` %
   '. Requests of this form allow you to deal with keyboard
   definitions independent of any actual device.

   The server parses all non- NULL fields in names and uses them
   to build a keyboard description. However, before parsing the
   expressions in names , the server ORs the bits in want and need
   together and examines the result in relationship to the
   expressions in names . Table 20.3 identifies the components
   that are required for each of the possible bits in want or need
   . If a required component has not been specified in the names
   structure (the corresponding field is NULL ), the server
   substitutes the expression " % ", resulting in the component
   values being taken from device_spec . In addition, if load is
   True , the server modifies names if necessary (again using a "
   % " entry) to ensure all of the following fields are non- NULL
   : types , keycodes , symbols , and compat .

   Table 20.3. Want and Need Mask Bits and Required Names
   Components
   want or need mask bit Required names Components value
   XkbGBN_TypesMask Types (1L<<0)
   XkbGBN_CompatMapMask Compat (1L<<1)
   XkbGBN_ClientSymbolsMask Types + Symbols + Keycodes (1L<<2)
   XkbGBN_ServerSymbolsMask Types + Symbols + Keycodes (1L<<3)
   XkbGBN_SymbolsMask Symbols (1L<<1)
   XkbGBN_IndicatorMapMask Compat (1L<<4)
   XkbGBN_KeyNamesMask Keycodes (1L<<5)
   XkbGBN_GeometryMask Geometry (1L<<6)
   XkbGBN_OtherNamesMask Types + Symbols + Keycodes + Compat +
   Geometry (1L<<7)
   XkbGBN_AllComponentsMask   (0xff)

   need specifies a set of keyboard components that the server
   must be able to resolve in order for XkbGetKeyboardByName to
   succeed; if any of the components specified in need cannot be
   successfully resolved, XkbGetKeyboardByName fails.

   want specifies a set of keyboard components that the server
   should attempt to resolve, but that are not mandatory. If the
   server is unable to resolve any of these components,
   XkbGetKeyboardByName still succeeds. Bits specified in want
   that are also specified in need have no effect in the context
   of want .

   If load is True , the server updates its keyboard description
   for device_spec to match the result of the keyboard description
   just built. If load is False , the server's description for
   device device_spec is not updated. In all cases, the parts
   specified by want and need from the just-built keyboard
   description are returned.

   The names structure in an XkbDescRec keyboard description
   record (see Chapter 18) contains one field for each of the five
   component types used to build a keyboard description. When a
   keyboard description is built from a set of database
   components, the corresponding fields in this names structure
   are set to match the expressions used to build the component.

   The entire process of building a new keyboard description from
   the server database of components and returning all or part of
   it is diagrammed in Figure 20.1:
   Building a New Keyboard Description from the Server Database

   The information returned to the client in the XkbDescRec is
   essentially the result of a series of calls to extract
   information from a fictitious device whose description matches
   the one just built. The calls corresponding to each of the mask
   bits are summarized in Table 20.4, together with the XkbDescRec
   components that are filled in.

   Table 20.4. XkbDescRec Components Returned for Values of Want &
   Needs
   Request (want+need) Fills in Xkb components Equivalent Function
   Call
   XkbGBN_TypesMask map.types XkbGetUpdatedMap(dpy, XkbTypesMask,
   Xkb)
   XkbGBN_ServerSymbolsMask server XkbGetUpdatedMap(dpy,
   XkbAllClientInfoMask, Xkb)
   XkbGBN_ClientSymbolsMask map, including map.types
   XkbGetUpdatedMap(dpy, XkbAllServerInfoMask, Xkb)
   XkbGBN_IndicatorMaps indicators XkbGetIndicatorMap(dpy,
   XkbAllIndicators, Xkb)
   XkbGBN_CompatMapMask compat XkbGetCompatMap(dpy,
   XkbAllCompatMask, Xkb)
   XkbGBN_GeometryMask geom XkbGetGeometry(dpy, Xkb)
   XkbGBN_KeyNamesMask

   names.keys

   names.key_aliases
   XkbGetNames(dpy, XkbKeyNamesMask | XkbKeyAliasesMask, Xkb)
   XkbGBN_OtherNamesMask

   names.keycodes

   names.geometry

   names.symbols

   names.types

   map.types[*].lvl_names[*]

   names.compat

   names.vmods

   names.indicators

   names.groups

   names.radio_groups

   names.phys_symbols

   XkbGetNames(dpy, XkbAllNamesMask &

   ~(XkbKeyNamesMask | XkbKeyAliasesMask),

   Xkb)

   There is no way to determine which components specified in want
   (but not in need ) were actually fetched, other than breaking
   the call into successive calls to XkbGetKeyboardByName and
   specifying individual components.

   XkbGetKeyboardByName always sets min_key_code and max_key_code
   in the returned XkbDescRec structure.

   XkbGetKeyboardByName is synchronous; it sends the request to
   the server to build a new keyboard description and waits for
   the reply. If successful, the return value is non-NULL.
   XkbGetKeyboardByName generates a BadMatch protocol error if
   errors are encountered when building the keyboard description.

   If you simply want to obtain information about the current
   keyboard device, rather than generating a new keyboard
   description from elements in the server database, use
   XkbGetKeyboard (see section 6.2).
   XkbDescPtr XkbGetKeyboard ( dpy , which , device_spec )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of components of XkbDescRec of
   interest */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID */

   XkbGetKeyboard is used to read the current description for one
   or more components of a keyboard device. It calls
   XkbGetKeyboardByName as follows:

   XkbGetKeyboardByName ( dpy , device_spec , NULL , which , which
   , False ).

Chapter 21. Attaching Xkb Actions to X Input Extension Devices

   Table of Contents

   XkbDeviceInfoRec
   Querying Xkb Features for Non-KeyClass Input Extension Devices
   Allocating, Initializing, and Freeing the XkbDeviceInfoRec
          Structure

   Setting Xkb Features for Non-KeyClass Input Extension Devices
   XkbExtensionDeviceNotify Event
   Tracking Changes to Extension Devices

   The X input extension allows an X server to support multiple
   keyboards, as well as other input devices, in addition to the
   core X keyboard and pointer. The input extension categorizes
   devices by grouping them into classes. Keyboards and other
   input devices with keys are classified as KeyClass devices by
   the input extension. Other types of devices supported by the
   input extension include, but are not limited to: mice, tablets,
   touchscreens, barcode readers, button boxes, trackballs,
   identifier devices, data gloves, and eye trackers. Xkb provides
   additional control over all X input extension devices, whether
   they are KeyClass devices or not, as well as the core keyboard
   and pointer.

   If an X server implements support for both the input extension
   and Xkb, the server implementor determines whether interaction
   between Xkb and the input extension is allowed. Implementors
   are free to restrict the effects of Xkb to only the core X
   keyboard device or allow interaction between Xkb and the input
   extension.

   Several types of interaction between Xkb and the input
   extension are defined by Xkb. Some or all may be allowed by the
   X server implementation.

   Regardless of whether the server allows interaction between Xkb
   and the input extension, the following access is provided:
     * Xkb functionality for the core X keyboard device and its
       mapping is accessed via the functions described in the
       other chapters of this specification.
     * Xkb functionality for the core X pointer device is accessed
       via the XkbGetDeviceInfo and XkbSetDeviceInfo functions
       described in this chapter.

   If all types of interaction are allowed between Xkb and the
   input extension, the following additional access is provided:
     * If allowed, Xkb functionality for additional KeyClass
       devices supported by the input extension is accessed via
       those same functions.
     * If allowed, Xkb functionality for non- KeyClass devices
       supported by the input extension is also accessed via the
       XkbGetDeviceInfo and XkbSetDeviceInfo functions described
       in this chapter.

   Each device has an X Input Extension device ID. Each device may
   have several classes of feedback. For example, there are two
   types of feedbacks that can generate bells: bell feedback and
   keyboard feedback ( BellFeedbackClass and KbdFeedbackClass ). A
   device can have more than one feedback of each type; the
   feedback ID identifies the particular feedback within its
   class.

   A keyboard feedback has:
     * Auto-repeat status (global and per key)
     * 32 LEDs
     * A bell

   An indicator feedback has:
     * Up to 32 LEDs

   If the input extension is present and the server allows
   interaction between the input extension and Xkb, then the core
   keyboard, the core keyboard indicators, and the core keyboard
   bells may each be addressed using an appropriate device spec,
   class, and ID. The constant XkbXIDfltID may be used as the
   device ID to specify the core keyboard indicators for the core
   indicator feedback. The particular device ID corresponding to
   the core keyboard feedback and the core indicator feedback may
   be obtained by calling XkbGetDeviceInfo and specifying
   XkbUseCoreKbd as the device_spec ; the values will be returned
   in dflt_kbd_id and dflt_led_id .

   If the server does not allow Xkb access to input extension
   KeyClass devices, attempts to use Xkb requests with those
   devices fail with a Bad Keyboard error. Attempts to access non-
   KeyClass input extension devices via XkbGetDeviceInfo and
   XkbSetDeviceInfo fail silently if Xkb access to those devices
   is not supported by the X server.

XkbDeviceInfoRec

   Information about X Input Extension devices is transferred
   between a client program and the Xkb extension in an
   XkbDeviceInfoRec structure:
typedef struct {
      char *          name;          /* name for device */
      Atom            type;          /* name for class of devices */
      unsigned short  device_spec;   /* device of interest */
      Bool            has_own_state; /*  True =>this
                                        device has its own state */
      unsigned short  supported;     /* bits indicating supported capabi
lities */
      unsigned short  unsupported;   /* bits indicating unsupported capa
bilities */
      unsigned short  num_btns;      /* number of entries in  btn_acts *
/
      XkbAction *     btn_acts;      /* button actions */
      unsigned short  sz_leds;       /* total number of entries in LEDs
vector */
      unsigned short  num_leds;      /* number of valid entries in LEDs
vector */
      unsigned short  dflt_kbd_fb;   /* input extension ID of default (c
ore kbd) indicator */
      unsigned short  dflt_led_fb;   /* input extension ID of default in
dicator feedback */
      XkbDeviceLedInfoPtr  leds;     /* LED descriptions */
} XkbDeviceInfoRec, *XkbDeviceInfoPtr;

typedef struct {
      unsigned short   led_class;         /* class for this LED device*/
      unsigned short   led_id;            /* ID for this LED device */
      unsigned int     phys_indicators;   /* bits for which LEDs physica
lly
                                             present */
      unsigned int     maps_present;      /* bits for which LEDs have ma
ps in
                                             maps */
      unsigned int     names_present;     /* bits for which LEDs are in
                                              names */
      unsigned int     state;            /* 1 bit => corresponding LED i
s on */
      Atom             names[XkbNumIndicators];  /* names for LEDs */
      XkbIndicatorMapRec  maps;          /* indicator maps for each LED
*/
} XkbDeviceLedInfoRec, *XkbDeviceLedInfoPtr;

   The type field is a registered symbolic name for a class of
   devices (for example, "TABLET"). If a device is a keyboard
   (that is, is a member of KeyClass ), it has its own state, and
   has_own_state is True . If has_own_state is False , the state
   of the core keyboard is used. The supported and unsupported
   fields are masks where each bit indicates a capability. The
   meaning of the mask bits is listed in Table 21.1, together with
   the fields in the XkbDeviceInfoRec structure that are
   associated with the capability represented by each bit. The
   same bits are used to indicate the specific information desired
   in many of the functions described subsequently in this
   section.

   Table 21.1. XkbDeviceInfoRec Mask Bits
   Name XkbDeviceInfoRec Fields Effected Value Capability If Set
   XkbXI_KeyboardsMask   (1L << 0) Clients can use all Xkb
   requests and events with KeyClass devices supported by the
   input device extension.
   XkbXI_ButtonActionsMask

   num_btns

   btn_acts
   (1L <<1) Clients can assign key actions to buttons on non-
   KeyClass input extension devices.
   XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask leds->names (1L <<2) Clients can
   assign names to indicators on non- KeyClass input extension
   devices.
   XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask leds->maps (1L <<3) Clients can assign
   indicator maps to indicators on non- KeyClass input extension
   devices.
   XkbXI_IndicatorStateMask leds->state (1L <<4) Clients can
   request the status of indicators on non- KeyClass input
   extension devices.
   XkbXI_IndicatorsMask

   sz_leds

   num_leds

   leds->*
   (0x1c)

   XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask |

   XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask |

   XkbXI_IndicatorStateMask
   XkbXI_UnsupportedFeaturesMask unsupported (1L <<15)
   XkbXI_AllDeviceFeaturesMask Those selected by Value column
   masks (0x1e)

   XkbXI_IndicatorsMask |

   XkbSI_ButtonActionsMask
   XkbXI_AllFeaturesMask Those selected by Value column masks
   (0x1f)

   XkbSI_AllDeviceFeaturesMask |

   XkbSI_KeyboardsMask
   XkbXI_AllDetailsMask Those selected by Value column masks
   (0x801f)

   XkbXI_AllFeaturesMask |

   XkbXI_UnsupportedFeaturesMask

   The name , type , has_own_state , supported , and unsupported
   fields are always filled in when a valid reply is returned from
   the server involving an XkbDeviceInfoRec . All of the other
   fields are modified only if the particular function asks for
   them.

Querying Xkb Features for Non-KeyClass Input Extension Devices

   To determine whether the X server allows Xkb access to
   particular capabilities of input devices other than the core X
   keyboard, or to determine the status of indicator maps,
   indicator names or button actions on a non- KeyClass extension
   device, use XkbGetDeviceInfo.
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr XkbGetDeviceInfo ( dpy , which, device_spec,
   ind_class, ind_id)
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int which; /* mask indicating information to return */
   unsigned int device_spec ; /* device ID, or XkbUseCoreKbd */
   unsigned int ind_class ; /* feedback class for indicator
   requests */
   unsigned int ind_id ; /* feedback ID for indicator requests */

   XkbGetDeviceInfo returns information about the input device
   specified by device_spec . Unlike the device_spec parameter of
   most Xkb functions, device_spec does not need to be a keyboard
   device. It must, however, indicate either the core keyboard or
   a valid X Input Extension device.

   The which parameter is a mask specifying optional information
   to be returned. It is an inclusive OR of one or more of the
   values from Table 21.1 and causes the returned XkbDeviceInfoRec
   to contain values for the corresponding fields specified in the
   table.

   The XkbDeviceInfoRec returned by XkbGetDeviceInfo always has
   values for name (may be a null string, ""), type , supported ,
   unsupported , has_own_state , dflt_kbd_fd , and dflt_kbd_fb .
   Other fields are filled in as specified by which .

   Upon return, the supported field will be set to the inclusive
   OR of zero or more bits from Table 21.1; each bit set indicates
   an optional Xkb extension device feature supported by the
   server implementation, and a client may modify the associated
   behavior.

   If the XkbButtonActionsMask bit is set in which , the
   XkbDeviceInfoRec returned will have the button actions (
   btn_acts field) filled in for all buttons.

   If which includes one of the bits in XkbXI_IndicatorsMask, the
   feedback class of the indicators must be specified in
   ind_class, and the feedback ID of the indicators must be
   specified in ind_id. If the request does not include any of the
   bits in XkbXI_IndicatorsMask, the ind_class and ind_id
   parameters are ignored. The class and ID can be obtained via
   the input device extension XListInputDevices request.

   If any of the XkbXI_IndicatorsMask bits are set in which , the
   XkbDeviceInfoRec returned will have filled in the portions of
   the leds structure corresponding to the indicator feedback
   identified by ind_class and ind_id . The leds vector of the
   XkbDeviceInfoRec is allocated if necessary and sz_leds and
   num_leds filled in. The led_class , led_id and phys_indicators
   fields of the leds entry corresponding to ind_class and ind_id
   are always filled in. If which contains
   XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask , the names_present and names fields
   of the leds structure corresponding to ind_class and ind_id are
   returned. If which contains XkbXI_IndicatorStateMask , the
   corresponding state field is updated. If which contains
   XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask , the maps_present and maps fields are
   updated.

   Xkb provides convenience functions to request subsets of the
   information available via XkbGetDeviceInfo . These convenience
   functions mirror some of the mask bits. The functions all take
   an XkbDeviceInfoPtr as an input argument and operate on the X
   Input Extension device specified by the device_spec field of
   the structure. Only the parts of the structure indicated in the
   function description are updated. The XkbDeviceInfo Rec
   structure used in the function call can be obtained by calling
   XkbGetDeviceInfo or can be allocated by calling
   XkbAllocDeviceInfo (see section 21.3).

   These convenience functions are described as follows.

   To query the button actions associated with an X Input
   Extension device, use XkbGetDeviceButtonActions.
   Status XkbGetDeviceButtonActions ( dpy, device_info,
   all_buttons, first_button, num_buttons )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* structure to update with
   results */
   Bool all_buttons ; /* True => get information for all buttons
   */
   unsigned int first_button; /* number of first button for which
   info is desired */
   unsigned int num_buttons; /* number of buttons for which info
   is desired */

   XkbGetDeviceButtonActions queries the server for the desired
   button information for the device indicated by the device_spec
   field of device_info and waits for a reply. If successful,
   XkbGetDeviceButtonActions backfills the button actions (
   btn_acts field of device_info ) for only the requested buttons,
   updates the name , type , supported , and unsupported fields,
   and returns Success .

   all_buttons , first_button and num_buttons specify the device
   buttons for which actions should be returned. Setting
   all_buttons to True requests actions for all device buttons; if
   all_buttons is False , first_button and num_buttons specify a
   range of buttons for which actions are requested.

   If a compatible version of Xkb is not available in the server
   or the Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetDeviceButtonActions returns BadAccess . If allocation
   errors occur, a BadAlloc status is returned. If the specified
   device ( device_info -> device_spec ) is invalid, a BadKeyboard
   status is returned. If the device has no buttons, a Bad Match
   status is returned. If first_button and num_buttons specify
   illegal buttons, a Bad Value status is returned.

   To query the indicator names, maps, and state associated with
   an LED feedback of an input extension device, use
   XkbGetDeviceLedInfo.
   Status XkbGetDeviceLedInfo ( dpy, device_i nfo, led_class,
   led_id, which)
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* structure to update with
   results */
   unsigned int led_class ; /* LED feedback class assigned by
   input extension */
   unsigned int led_id; /* LED feedback ID assigned by input
   extension */
   unsigned int which; /* mask indicating desired information */

   XkbGetDeviceLedInfo queries the server for the desired LED
   information for the feedback specified by led_class and led_id
   for the X input extension device indicated by device_spec ->
   device_info and waits for a reply. If successful,
   XkbGetDeviceLedInfo backfills the relevant fields of
   device_info as determined by which with the results and returns
   Success . Valid values for which are the inclusive OR of any of
   XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask , XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask , and
   XkbXI_IndicatorStateMask .

   The fields of device_info that are filled in when this request
   succeeds are name, type, supported , and unsupported , and
   portions of the leds structure corresponding to led_class and
   led_id as indicated by the bits set in which . The
   device_info->leds vector is allocated if necessary and sz_leds
   and num_leds filled in. The led_class , led_id and
   phys_indicators fields of the device_info -> leds entry
   corresponding to led_class and led_id are always filled in.

   If which contains XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask , the names_present
   and names fields of the device_info -> leds structure
   corresponding to led_class and led_id are updated, if which
   contains XkbXI_IndicatorStateMask , the corresponding state
   field is updated, and if which contains XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask
   , the maps_present and maps fields are updated.

   If a compatible version of Xkb is not available in the server
   or the Xkb extension has not been properly initialized,
   XkbGetDeviceLedInfo returns BadAccess . If allocation errors
   occur, a BadAlloc status is returned. If the device has no
   indicators, a BadMatch error is returned. If ledClass or ledID
   have illegal values, a Bad Value error is returned. If they
   have legal values but do not specify a feedback that contains
   LEDs and is associated with the specified device, a Bad Match
   error is returned.

Allocating, Initializing, and Freeing the XkbDeviceInfoRec Structure

   To obtain an XkbDeviceInfoRec structure, use XkbGetDeviceInfo
   or XkbAllocDeviceInfo.
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr XkbAllocDeviceInfo (device_spec, n_buttons,
   sz_leds)
   unsigned int device_spec; /* device ID with which structure
   will be used */
   unsigned int n_buttons ; /* number of button actions to
   allocate space for*/
   unsigned int sz_leds ; /* number of LED feedbacks to allocate
   space for */

   XkbAllocDeviceInfo allocates space for an XkbDeviceInfoRec
   structure and initializes that structure's device_spec field
   with the device ID specified by device_spec. If n_buttons is
   nonzero, n_buttons XkbActions are linked into the
   XkbDeviceInfoRec structure and initialized to zero. If sz_leds
   is nonzero, sz_leds XkbDeviceLedInfoRec structures are also
   allocated and linked into the XkbDeviceInfoRec structure. If
   you request XkbDeviceLedInfoRec structures be allocated using
   this request, you must initialize them explicitly.

   To obtain an XkbDeviceLedInfoRec structure, use
   XkbAllocDeviceLedInfo.
   Status XkbAllocDeviceLedInfo (devi, num_needed)
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info ; /* structure in which to
   allocate LED space */
   int num_needed ; /* number of indicators to allocate space for
   */

   XkbAllocDeviceLedInfo allocates space for an
   XkbDeviceLedInfoRec and places it in device_info . If
   num_needed is nonzero, num_needed XkbIndicatorMapRec structures
   are also allocated and linked into the XkbDeviceLedInfoRec
   structure. If you request XkbIndicatorMapRec structures be
   allocated using this request, you must initialize them
   explicitly. All other fields are initialized to zero.

   To initialize an XkbDeviceLedInfoRec structure, use
   XkbAddDeviceLedInfo.
   XkbDeviceLedInfoPtr XkbAddDeviceLedInfo (device_info,
   led_class, led_id)
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* structure in which to add LED
   info */
   unsigned int led_class ; /* input extension class for LED
   device of interest */
   unsigned int led_id ; /* input extension ID for LED device of
   interest */

   XkbAddDeviceLedInfo first checks to see whether an entry
   matching led_class and led_id already exists in the
   device_info->leds array. If it finds a matching entry, it
   returns a pointer to that entry. Otherwise, it checks to be
   sure there is at least one empty entry in device_info -> leds
   and extends it if there is not enough room. It then increments
   device_info -> num_leds and fills in the next available entry
   in device_info -> leds with led_class and led_id .

   If successful, XkbAddDeviceLedInfo returns a pointer to the
   XkbDeviceLedInfoRec structure that was initialized. If unable
   to allocate sufficient storage, or if device_info points to an
   invalid XkbDeviceInfoRec structure, or if led_class or led_id
   are inappropriate, XkbAddDeviceLedInfo returns NULL .

   To allocate additional space for button actions in an
   XkbDeviceInfoRec structure, use XkbResizeDeviceButtonActions.
   Status XkbResizeDeviceButtonActions (device_info, new_total)
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* structure in which to allocate
   button actions */
   unsigned int new_total ; /* new total number of button actions
   needed */

   XkbResizeDeviceButton reallocates space, if necessary, to make
   sure there is room for a total of new_total button actions in
   the device_info structure. Any new entries allocated are
   zeroed. If successful, XkbResizeDeviceButton returns Success.
   If new_total is zero, all button actions are deleted,
   device_info -> num_btns is set to zero, and device_info ->
   btn_acts is set to NULL . If device_info is invalid or
   new_total is greater than 255, BadValue is returned. If a
   memory allocation failure occurs, a BadAlloc is returned.

   To free an XkbDeviceInfoRec structure, use XkbFreeDeviceInfo.
   void XkbFreeDeviceInfo (device_info, which, free_all)
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* pointer to XkbDeviceInfoRec in
   which to free items */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask of components of device_info to
   free */
   Bool free_all ; /* True => free everything, including
   device_info */

   If free_all is True , the XkbFreeDeviceInfo frees all
   components of device_info and the XkbDeviceInfoRec structure
   pointed to by device_info itself. If free_all is False , the
   value of which determines which subcomponents are freed. which
   is an inclusive OR of one or more of the values from Table
   21.1. If which contains XkbXI_ButtonActionsMask, all button
   actions associated with device_info are freed, device_info ->
   btn_acts is set to NULL , and device_info -> num_btns is set to
   zero. If which contains all bits in XkbXI_IndicatorsMask, all
   XkbDeviceLedInfoRec structures associated with device_info are
   freed, device_info -> leds is set to NULL , and device_info ->
   sz_leds and device_info -> num_leds are set to zero. If which
   contains XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask, all indicator maps associated
   with device_info are cleared, but the number of LEDs and the
   leds structures themselves are preserved. If which contains
   XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask, all indicator names associated with
   device_info are cleared, but the number of LEDs and the leds
   structures themselves are preserved. If which contains
   XkbXI_IndicatorStateMask, the indicator state associated with
   the device_info leds are set to zeros but the number of LEDs
   and the leds structures themselves are preserved.

Setting Xkb Features for Non-KeyClass Input Extension Devices

   The Xkb extension allows clients to assign any key action to
   either core pointer or input extension device buttons. This
   makes it possible to control the keyboard or generate keyboard
   key events from extension devices or from the core pointer.

   Key actions assigned to core X pointer buttons or input
   extension device buttons cause key events to be generated as if
   they had originated from the core X keyboard.

   Xkb implementations are required to support key actions for the
   buttons of the core pointer device, but support for actions on
   extension devices is optional. Implementations that do not
   support button actions for extension devices must not set the
   XkbXI_ButtonActionsMask bit in the supported field of an
   XkbDeviceInfoRec structure.

   If a client attempts to modify valid characteristics of a
   device using an implementation that does not support
   modification of those characteristics, no protocol error is
   generated. Instead, the server reports a failure for the
   request; it also sends an XkbExtensionDeviceNotify event to the
   client that issued the request if the client has selected to
   receive these events.

   To change characteristics of an X Input Extension device in the
   server, first modify a local copy of the device structure and
   then use either XkbSetDeviceInfo, or, to save network traffic,
   use an XkbDeviceChangesRec structure (see section 21.6) and
   call XkbChangeDeviceInfo to download the changes to the server.

   To modify some or all of the characteristics of an X Input
   Extension device, use XkbSetDeviceInfo.
   Bool XkbSetDeviceInfo ( dpy , which, device_info)
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int which ; /* mask indicating characteristics to
   modify */
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* structure defining the device
   and modifications */

   XkbSetDeviceInfo sends a request to the server to modify the
   characteristics of the device specified in the device_info
   structure. The particular characteristics modified are
   identified by the bits set in which and take their values from
   the relevant fields in device_info (see Table 21.1).
   XkbSetDeviceInfo returns True if the request was successfully
   sent to the server. If the X server implementation does not
   allow interaction between the X input extension and the Xkb
   Extension, the function does nothing and returns False .

   The which parameter specifies which aspects of the device
   should be changed and is a bitmask composed of an inclusive OR
   or one or more of the following bits: XkbXI_ButtonActionsMask ,
   XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask , XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask . If the
   features requested to be manipulated in which are valid for the
   device, but the server does not support assignment of one or
   more of them, that particular portion of the request is
   ignored.

   If the device specified in device_info -> device_spec does not
   contain buttons and a request affecting buttons is made, or the
   device does not contain indicators and a request affecting
   indicators is made, a BadMatch protocol error results.

   If the XkbXI_ButtonActionsMask bit is set in the supported mask
   returned by XkbGetDeviceInfo, the Xkb extension allows
   applications to assign key actions to buttons on input
   extension devices other than the core keyboard device. If the
   XkbXI_ButtonActionsMask is set in which , the actions for all
   buttons specified in device_info are set to the XkbAction s
   specified in device_info -> btn_acts . If the number of buttons
   requested to be updated is not valid for the device,
   XkbSetDeviceInfo returns False and a BadValue protocol error
   results.

   If the XkbXI_IndicatorMaps and / or XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask
   bit is set in the supported mask returned by XkbGetDeviceInfo,
   the Xkb extension allows applications to assign maps and / or
   names to the indicators of nonkeyboard extension devices. If
   supported, maps and / or names can be assigned to all extension
   device indicators, whether they are part of a keyboard feedback
   or part of an indicator feedback.

   If the XkbXI_IndicatorMapsMask and / or
   XkbXI_IndicatorNamesMask flag is set in which , the indicator
   maps and / or names for all device_info -> num_leds indicator
   devices specified in device_info -> leds are set to the maps
   and / or names specified in device_info -> leds . device_info
   -> leds -> led_class and led_id specify the input extension
   class and device ID for each indicator device to modify; if
   they have invalid values, a BadValue protocol error results and
   XkbSetDeviceInfo returns False . If they have legal values but
   do not specify a keyboard or indicator class feedback for the
   device in question, a BadMatch error results. If any of the
   values in device_info -> leds -> names are not a valid Atom or
   None , a BadAtom protocol error results.

   Xkb provides convenience functions to modify subsets of the
   information accessible via XkbSetDeviceInfo . Only the parts of
   the structure indicated in the function description are
   modified. These convenience functions are described as follows.

   To change only the button actions for an input extension
   device, use XkbSetDeviceButtonActions.
   Bool XkbSetDeviceButtonActions ( dpy , device, first_button,
   num_buttons, actions)
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* structure defining the device
   and modifications */
   unsigned int first_button; /* number of first button to update,
   0 relative */
   unsigned int num_buttons; /* number of buttons to update */

   XkbSetDeviceButtonActions assigns actions to the buttons of the
   device specified in device_info-> device_spec . Actions are
   assigned to num_buttons buttons beginning with first_button and
   are taken from the actions specified in device_info -> btn_acts
   .

   If the server does not support assignment of Xkb actions to
   extension device buttons, XkbSetDeviceButtonActions has no
   effect and returns False . If the device has no buttons or if
   first_button or num_buttons specify buttons outside of the
   valid range as determined by device_info -> num_btns , the
   function has no effect and returns False . Otherwise,
   XkbSetDeviceButtonActions sends a request to the server to
   change the actions for the specified buttons and returns True .

   If the actual request sent to the server involved illegal
   button numbers, a BadValue protocol error is generated. If an
   invalid device identifier is specified in device_info->
   device_spec , a BadKeyboard protocol error results. If the
   actual device specified in device_info -> device_spec does not
   contain buttons and a request affecting buttons is made, a
   BadMatch protocol error is generated.

XkbExtensionDeviceNotify Event

   The Xkb extension generates XkbExtensionDeviceNotify events
   when the status of an input extension device changes or when an
   attempt is made to use an Xkb feature that is not supported by
   a particular device.

Note

   Events indicating an attempt to use an unsupported feature are
   delivered only to the client requesting the event.

   To track changes to the status of input extension devices or
   attempts to use unsupported features of a device, select to
   receive XkbExtensionDeviceNotify events by calling either
   XkbSelectEvents or XkbSelectEventDetails (see section 4.3).

   To receive XkbExtensionDeviceNotify events under all possible
   conditions, call XkbSelectEvents and pass
   XkbExtensionDeviceNotifyMask in both bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits .

   The XkbExtensionDeviceNotify event has no event details.
   However, you can call XkbSelectEventDetails using
   XkbExtensionDeviceNotify as the event_type and specifying
   XkbAllExtensionDeviceMask in bits_to_change and
   values_for_bits. This has the same effect as a call to
   XkbSelectEvents .

   The structure for XkbExtensionDeviceNotify events is:
typedef struct {
      int      type;           /* Xkb extension base event code */
      unsigned long  serial;   /* X server serial number for event */
      Bool     send_event;     /* True
                                  => synthetically generated*/
      Display *      display;  /* server connection where event generate
d */
      Time     time;           /* server time when event generated */
      int      xkb_type;  /* XkbExtensionDeviceNotifyEvent */
      int      device;         /* Xkb device ID, will not be
                                  XkbUseCoreKbd */
      unsigned int   reason;   /* reason for the event */
      unsigned int   supported;  /* mask of supported features */
      unsigned int   unsupported;  /* unsupported features this client
                                      attempted to use */
      int      first_btn;      /* first button that changed */
      int      num_btns;       /* number of buttons that changed */
      unsigned int   leds_defined;  /* indicators with names or maps */
      unsigned int       led_state; /* current state of the indicators *
/
      int       led_class;          /* feedback class for LED changes */
      int       led_id;             /* feedback ID for LED changes */
} XkbExtensionDeviceNotifyEvent;

   The XkbExtensionDeviceNotify event has fields enabling it to
   report changes in the state (on/off) of all of the buttons for
   a device, but only for one LED feedback associated with a
   device. You will get multiple events when more than one LED
   feedback changes state or configuration.

Tracking Changes to Extension Devices

   Changes to an Xkb extension device may be tracked by listening
   to XkbDeviceExtensionNotify events and accumulating the changes
   in an XkbDeviceChangesRec structure. The changes noted in the
   structure may then be used in subsequent operations to update
   either a server configuration or a local copy of an Xkb
   extension device configuration. The changes structure is
   defined as follows:
typedef struct _XkbDeviceChanges {
      unsigned int    changed;   /* bits indicating what has changed */
      unsigned short  first_btn; /* number of first button which changed
,
                                    if any */
      unsigned short  num_btns;  /* number of buttons that have changed
*/
      XkbDeviceLedChangesRec leds;
} XkbDeviceChangesRec,*XkbDeviceChangesPtr;

typedef struct _XkbDeviceLedChanges {
      unsigned short  led_class; /* class of this indicator feedback bun
dle */
      unsigned short  led_id;    /* ID of this indicator feedback bundle
 */
      unsigned int    names;     /* bits indicating which names have cha
nged */
      unsigned int    maps;      /* bits indicating which maps have chan
ged */
      struct _XkbDeviceLedChanges *next; /* link to indicator change rec
ord
                                            for next set */
} XkbDeviceLedChangesRec,*XkbDeviceLedChangesPtr;

   A local description of the configuration and state of a device
   may be kept in an XkbDeviceInfoRec structure. The actual state
   or configuration of the device may change because of
   XkbSetDeviceInfo and XkbSetButtonActions requests made by
   clients or by user interaction with the device. The X server
   sends an XkbExtensionDeviceNotify event to all interested
   clients when the state of any buttons or indicators or the
   configuration of the buttons or indicators on the core keyboard
   or any input extension device changes. The event reports the
   state of indicators for a single indicator feedback, and the
   state of up to 128 buttons. If more than 128 buttons or more
   than one indicator feedback are changed, the additional buttons
   and indicator feedbacks are reported in subsequent events. Xkb
   provides functions with which you can track changes to input
   extension devices by noting the changes that were made and then
   requesting the changed information from the server.

   To note device changes reported in an XkbExtensionDeviceNotify
   event, use XkbNoteDeviceChanges.
   void XkbNoteDeviceChanges ( old, new, wanted )
   XkbDeviceChangesPtr old ; /* structure tracking state changes
   */
   XkbExtensionDeviceNotifyEvent * new ; /* event indicating state
   changes */
   unsigned int wanted ; /* mask indicating changes to note */

   The wanted field specifies the changes that should be noted in
   old , and is composed of the bitwise inclusive OR of one or
   more of the masks from Table 21.1 . The reason field of the
   event in new indicates the types of changes the event is
   reporting. XkbNoteDeviceChanges updates the XkbDeviceChangesRec
   specified by old with the changes that are both specified in
   wanted and contained in new -> reason .

   To update a local copy of the state and configuration of an X
   input extension device with the changes previously noted in an
   XkbDeviceChangesRec structure, use XkbGetDeviceInfoChanges.

   To query the changes that have occurred in the button actions
   or indicator names and indicator maps associated with an input
   extension device, use XkbGetDeviceInfoChanges.
   Status XkbGetDeviceInfoChanges ( dpy , device_info , changes)
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info; /* structure to update with
   results */
   XkbDeviceChangesPtr changes ; /* contains notes of changes that
   have occurred */

   The changes->changed field indicates which attributes of the
   device specified in changes -> device have changed. The
   parameters describing the changes are contained in the other
   fields of changes . XkbGetDeviceInfoChanges uses that
   information to call XkbGetDeviceInfo to obtain the current
   status of those attributes that have changed. It then updates
   the local description of the device in device_info with the new
   information.

   To update the server's description of a device with the changes
   noted in an XkbDeviceChangesRec, use XkbChangeDeviceInfo.
   Bool XkbChangeDeviceInfo ( dpy, device_info, changes )
   Display * dpy ; /* connection to X server */
   XkbDeviceInfoPtr device_info ; /* local copy of device state
   and configuration */
   XkbDeviceChangesPtr changes ; /* note specifying changes in
   device_info */

   XkbChangeDeviceInfo updates the server's description of the
   device specified in device_info -> device_spec with the changes
   specified in changes and contained in device_info . The update
   is made by an XkbSetDeviceInfo request.

Chapter 22. Debugging Aids

   The debugging aids are intended for use primarily by Xkb
   implementors and are optional in any implementation.

   There are two bitmasks that may be used to control debugging.
   One bitmask controls the output of debugging information, and
   the other controls behavior. Both bitmasks are initially all
   zeros.

   To change the values of any of the debug controls, use
   XkbSetDebuggingFlags .
   Bool XkbSetDebuggingFlags ( display, mask, flags, msg,
   ctrls_mask, ctrls, ret_flags, ret_ctrls )
   Display * display ; /* connection to X server */
   unsigned int mask ; /* mask selecting debug output flags to
   change */
   unsigned int flags ; /* values for debug output flags selected
   by mask */
   char * msg ; /* message to print right now */
   unsigned int ctrls_mask ; /* mask selecting debug controls to
   change */
   unsigned int ctrls ; /* values for debug controls selected by
   ctrls_mask */
   unsigned int * ret_flags ; /* resulting state of all debug
   output flags */
   unsigned int * ret_ctrls ; /* resulting state of all debug
   controls */

   XkbSetDebuggingFlags modifies the debug output flags as
   specified by mask and flags , modifies the debug controls flags
   as specified by ctrls_mask and ctrls , prints the message msg ,
   and backfills ret_flags and ret_ctrls with the resulting debug
   output and debug controls flags.

   When bits are set in the debug output masks, mask and flags ,
   Xkb prints debug information corresponding to each bit at
   appropriate points during its processing. The device to which
   the output is written is implementation-dependent, but is
   normally the same device to which X server error messages are
   directed; thus the bits that can be set in mask and flags is
   implementation-specific. To turn on a debug output selection,
   set the bit for the output in the mask parameter and set the
   corresponding bit in the flags parameter. To turn off event
   selection for an event, set the bit for the output in the mask
   parameter and do not set the corresponding bit in the flags
   parameter.

   When bits are set in the debug controls masks, ctrls_mask and
   ctrls , Xkb modifies its behavior according to each controls
   bit. ctrls_mask and ctrls are related in the same way that mask
   and flags are. The valid controls bits are defined in Table
   22.1.

   Table 22.1. Debug Control Masks
   Debug Control Mask Value    Meaning
   XkbDF_DisableLocks (1 << 0) Disable actions that lock modifiers

   XkbSetDebuggingFlags returns True if successful and False
   otherwise. The only protocol error it may generate is BadAlloc
   , if for some reason it is unable to allocate storage.

   XkbSetDebuggingFlags is intended for developer use and may be
   disabled in production X servers. If it is disabled,
   XkbSetDebuggingFlags has no effect and does not generate any
   protocol errors.

   The message in msg is written immediately. The device to which
   it is written is implementation dependent but is normally the
   same device where X server error messages are directed.

Glossary

   Allocator
          Xkb provides functions, known as allocators, to create
          and initialize Xkb data structures.

   Audible Bell
          An audible bell is the sound generated by whatever bell
          is associated with the keyboard or input extension
          device, as opposed to any other audible sound generated
          elsewhere in the system.

   Autoreset Controls
          The autoreset controls configure the boolean controls to
          automatically be enabled or disabled at the time a
          program exits.

   Base Group
          The group in effect as a result of all actions other
          than a previous lock or latch request; the base group is
          transient. For example, the user pressing and holding a
          group shift key that shifts to Group2 would result in
          the base group being group 2 at that point in time.
          Initially, base group is always Group1.

   Base Modifiers
          Modifiers that are turned on as a result of some actions
          other than previous lock or latch requests; base
          modifiers are transient. For example, the user pressing
          and holding a key bound to the Shift modifier would
          result in Shift being a base modifier at that point in
          time.

   Base Event Code
          A number assigned by the X server at run time that is
          assigned to the extension to identify events from that
          extension.

   Base State
          The base group and base modifiers represent keys that
          are physically or logically down; these constitute the
          base state.

   Boolean Controls
          Global keyboard controls that may be selectively enabled
          and disabled under program control and that may be
          automatically set to an on or off condition upon client
          program exit.

   Canonical Key Types
          The canonical key types are predefined key types that
          describe the types of keys available on most keyboards.
          The definitions for the canonical key types are held in
          the first XkbNumRequiredTypes entries of the types field
          of the client map and are indexed using the following
          constants:

          + XkbOneLevelIndex
          + XkbTwoLevelIndex
          + XkbAlphabeticIndex
          + XkbKeypadIndex

   Client Map
          The key mapping information needed to convert arbitrary
          keycodes to symbols.

   Compat Name
          The compat name is a string that provides some
          information about the rules used to bind actions to keys
          that are changed using core protocol requests.

   Compatibility State
          When an Xkb-extended X server connects to an Xkb-unaware
          client, the compatibility state remaps the keyboard
          group into a core modifier whenever possible.

   Compatibility Grab State
          The grab state that results from applying the
          compatibility map to the Xkb grab state.

   Compatibility Map
          The definition of how to map core protocol keyboard
          state to Xkb keyboard state.

   Component Expression
          An expression used to describe server keyboard database
          components to be loaded. It describes the order in which
          the components should be loaded and the rules by which
          duplicate attributes should be resolved.

   Compose Processing
          The process of mapping a series of keysyms to a string
          is known as compose processing.

   Consumed Modifier
          Xkb normally consumes modifiers in determining the
          appropriate symbol for an event, that is, the modifiers
          are not considered during any of the later stages of
          event processing. For those rare occasions when a
          modifier should be considered despite having been used
          to look up a symbol, key types include an optional
          preserve field.

   Core Event
          An event created from the core X server.

   Detectable Auto-Repeat
          Detectable auto-repeat allows a client to detect an
          auto-repeating key. If a client requests and the server
          supports detectable auto-repeat, Xkb generates
          KeyRelease events only when the key is physically
          released. Thus the client receives a number of KeyPress
          events for that key without intervening KeyRelease
          events until the key is finally released, when a
          KeyRelease event is received.

   Effective Group
          The effective group is the arithmetic sum of the locked,
          latched, and base groups. The effective keyboard group
          is always brought back into range depending on the value
          of the GroupsWrap control for the keyboard. If an event
          occurs with an effective group that is legal for the
          keyboard as a whole, but not for the key in question,
          the group for that event only is normalized using the
          algorithm specified by the group_info member of the key
          symbol map ( XkbSymMapRec ).

   Effective Mask
          An Xkb modifier definition consists of a set of bit
          masks corresponding to the eight real modifiers; a
          similar set of bitmasks corresponding to the 16 named
          virtual modifiers; and an effective mask. The effective
          mask represents the set of all real modifiers that can
          logically be set either by setting any of the real
          modifiers or by setting any of the virtual modifiers in
          the definition.

   Effective Modifier
          The effective modifiers are the bitwise union of the
          base, latched and locked modifiers.

   Extension Device
          Any keyboard or other input device recognized by the X
          input extension.

   Global Keyboard Controls
          Controls that affect the way Xkb generates key events.
          The controls affect all keys, as opposed to per-key
          controls that are for a single key. Global controls
          include

          + RepeatKeys Control
          + DetectableAuto-repeat
          + SlowKeys
          + BounceKeys
          + StickyKeys
          + MouseKeys
          + MouseKeysAccel
          + AccessXKeys
          + AccessXTimeout
          + AccessXFeedback
          + Overlay1
          + Overlay2
          + EnabledControls

   Grab State
          The grab state is the state used when matching events to
          passive grabs. It consists of the grab group and the
          grab modifiers.

   Group
          See Keysym Group

   Group Index
          A number used as the internal representation for a group
          number. Group1 through Group 4 have indices of 0 through
          3.

   Groups Wrap Control
          If a group index exceeds the maximum number of groups
          permitted for the specified keyboard, it is wrapped or
          truncated back into range as specified by the global
          GroupsWrap control. GroupsWrap can have the following
          values:

                    WrapIntoRange
                    ClampIntoRange
                    RedirectIntoRange


   Key Type
          An attribute of a key that identifies which modifiers
          affect the shift level of a key and the number of groups
          on the key.

   Key Width
          The maximum number of shift levels in any group for the
          key type associated with a key.

   Keysym Group
          A keysym group is a logical state of the keyboard
          providing access to a collection of characters. A group
          usually contains a set of characters that logically
          belong together and that may be arranged on several
          shift levels within that group. For example, Group1
          could be the English alphabet, and Group2 could be
          Greek. Xkb supports up to four different groups for an
          input device or keyboard. Groups are in the range 1-4
          (Group1 - Group4), and are often referred to as G1 - G4
          and indexed as 0 - 3.

   Indicator
          An indicator is a feedback mechanism such as an LED on
          an input device. Using Xkb, a client application can
          determine the names of the various indicators, determine
          and control the way that the individual indicators
          should be updated to reflect keyboard changes, and
          determine which of the 32 keyboard indicators reported
          by the protocol are actually present on the keyboard.

   Indicator Feedback
          An indicator feedback describes the state of a bank of
          up to 32 lights. It has a mask where each bit
          corresponds to a light and an associated value mask that
          specifies which lights are on or off.

   Indicator Map
          An indicator has its own set of attributes that specify
          whether clients can explicitly set its state and whether
          it tracks the keyboard state. The indicator map is the
          collection of these attributes for each indicator and is
          held in the maps array, which is an array of
          XkbIndicatorRec structures.

   Input Extension
          An extension to the core X protocol that allows an X
          server to support multiple keyboards, as well as other
          input devices, in addition to the core X keyboard and
          pointer. Other types of devices supported by the input
          extension include, but are not limited to: mice,
          tablets, touchscreens, barcode readers, button boxes,
          trackballs, identifier devices, data gloves, and eye
          trackers.

   Key Action
          A key action consists of an operator and some optional
          data. Once the server has applied the global controls
          and per-key behavior and has decided to process a key
          event, it applies key actions to determine the effects
          of the key on the internal state of the server. Xkb
          supports actions that do the following:

          + Change base, latched, or locked modifiers or group
          + Move the core pointer or simulate core pointer button
            events
          + Change most aspects of keyboard behavior
          + Terminate or suspend the server
          + Send a message to interested clients
          + Simulate events on other keys

   Key Alias
          A key alias is a symbolic name for a specific physical
          key. Key aliases allow the keyboard layout designer to
          assign multiple key names to a single key. This allows
          the keyboard layout designer to refer to keys using
          either their position or their "function." Key aliases
          can be specified both in the symbolic names component
          and in the keyboard geometry. Both sets of aliases are
          always valid, but key alias definitions in the keyboard
          geometry have priority; if both symbolic names and
          geometry include aliases, you should consider the
          definitions from the geometry before considering the
          definitions from the symbolic names section.

   Key Behavior
          The behaviors field of the server map is an array of
          XkbBehavior , indexed by keycode, and contains the
          behavior for each key. The X server uses key behavior to
          determine whether to process or filter out any given key
          event; key behavior is independent of keyboard modifier
          or group state. Each key has exactly one behavior.

          Key behaviors include:

          + XkbKB_Default
          + XkbKB_Lock
          + XkbKB_RadioGroup
          + XkbKB_Overlay1
          + XkbKB_Overlay2

   Key Symbol Map
          A key symbol map describes the symbols bound to a key
          and the rules to be used to interpret those symbols. It
          is an array of XkbSymMapRec structures indexed by
          keycode.

   Key Type
          Key types are used to determine the shift level of a key
          given the current state of the keyboard. There is one
          key type for each group for a key. Key types are defined
          using the XkbKeyTypeRec and XkbKTMapEntryRec structures.
          Xkb allows up to XkbMaxKeyTypes (255) key types to be
          defined, but requires at least XkbNumRequiredTypes (4)
          predefined types to be in a key map.

   Keyboard Bells
          The sound the default bell makes when rung is the system
          bell or the default keyboard bell. Some input devices
          may have more than one bell, identified by bell_class
          and bell_id.

   Keyboard Components
          There are five types of components stored in the X
          server database of keyboard components. They correspond
          to the symbols, geometry, keycodes, compat, and types
          symbolic names associated with a keyboard.

   Keyboard Feedback
          A keyboard feedback includes the following:

                Keyclick volume
                Bell volume
                Bell pitch
                Bell duration
                Global auto-repeat
                Per key auto-repeat
                32 LEDs

   Key Width, Key Type Width
          The maximum number of shift levels for a type is
          referred to as the width of a key type.

   Keyboard Geometry
          Keyboard geometry describes the physical appearance of
          the keyboard, including the shape, location, and color
          of all keyboard keys or other visible keyboard
          components such as indicators and is stored in a
          XkbGeometryRec structure. The information contained in a
          keyboard geometry is sufficient to allow a client
          program to draw an accurate two-dimensional image of the
          keyboard.

   Keyboard Geometry Name
          The keyboard geometry name describes the physical
          location, size, and shape of the various keys on the
          keyboard and is part of the XkbNamesRec structure.

   Keyboard State
          Keyboard state encompasses all of the transitory
          information necessary to map a physical key press or
          release to an appropriate event.

   Keycode
          A numeric value returned to the X server when a key on a
          keyboard is pressed or released, indicating which key is
          being modulated. Keycode numbers are in the range 1 <=
          keycode <= max, where max is the number of physical keys
          on the device.

   Keycode Name
          The keycode name describes the range and meaning of the
          keycodes returned by the keyboard and is part of the
          XkbNamesRec structure.

   Latched Group
          A latched group is a group index that is combined with
          the base and locked group to form the effective group.
          It applies only to the next key event that does not
          change the keyboard state. The latched group can be
          changed by keyboard activity or via Xkb extension
          library functions.

   Latched Modifier
          Latched modifiers are the set of modifiers that are
          combined with the base modifiers and the locked
          modifiers to form the effective modifiers. It applies
          only to the next key event that does not change the
          keyboard state.

   LED
          A light emitting diode. However, for the purposes of the
          X keyboard extension specification, a LED is any form of
          visual two-state indicator that is either on or off.

   Locked Group
          A locked group is a group index that is combined with
          the base and latched group to form the effective group.
          When a group is locked, it supersedes any previous
          locked group and remains the locked group for all future
          key events, until a new group is locked. The locked
          group can be changed by keyboard activity or via Xkb
          extension library functions.

   Locked Modifiers
          Locked modifiers are the set of modifiers that are
          combined with the base modifiers and the latched
          modifiers to form the effective modifiers. A locked
          modifier applies to all future key events until it is
          explicitly unlocked.

   Lookup State
          The lookup state is composed of the lookup group and the
          lookup modifiers, and it is the state an Xkb-capable or
          Xkb-aware client should use to map a keycode to a
          keysym.

   Modifier
          A modifier is a logical condition that is either set or
          unset. The modifiers control the Shift Level selected
          when a key event occurs. Xkb supports the core protocol
          eight modifiers ( Shift , Lock , Control , and Mod1
          through Mod5 ), called the real modifiers. In addition,
          Xkb extends modifier flexibility by providing a set of
          sixteen named virtual modifiers, each of which can be
          bound to any set of the eight real modifiers.

   Modifier Key
          A modifier key is a key whose operation has no immediate
          effect, but that, for as long as it is held down,
          modifies the effect of other keys. A modifier key may
          be, for example, a shift key or a control key.

   Modifier Definition
          An Xkb modifier definition, held in an XkbModsRec ,
          consists of a set of real modifiers, a set of virtual
          modifiers, and an effective mask. The mask is the union
          of the real modifiers and the set of real modifiers to
          which the virtual modifiers map; the mask cannot be
          explicitly changed.

   Nonkeyboard Extension Device
          An input extension device that is not a keyboard. Other
          types of devices supported by the input extension
          include, but are not limited to: mice, tablets,
          touchscreens, barcode readers, button boxes, trackballs,
          identifier devices, data gloves, and eye trackers.

   Outlines
          An outline is a list of one or more points that
          describes a single closed polygon, used in the geometry
          specification for a keyboard.

   Physical Indicator Mask
          The physical indicator mask is a field in the
          XkbIndicatorRec that indicates which indicators are
          bound to physical LEDs on the keyboard; if a bit is set
          in phys_indicators , then the associated indicator has a
          physical LED associated with it. This field is necessary
          because some indicators may not have corresponding
          physical LEDs on the keyboard.

   Physical Symbol Keyboard Name
          The symbols keyboard name identifies the symbols
          logically bound to the keys. The symbols name is a human
          or application-readable description of the intended
          locale or usage of the keyboard with these symbols. The
          phys_symbols keyboard name, on the other hand,
          identifies the symbols actually engraved on the
          keyboard.

   Preserved Modifier
          Xkb normally consumes modifiers in determining the
          appropriate symbol for an event, that is, the modifiers
          are not considered during any of the later stages of
          event processing. For those rare occasions when a
          modifier should be considered despite having been used
          to look up a symbol, key types include an optional
          preserve field. If a modifier is present in the preserve
          list, it is a preserved modifier.

   Radio Group
          A radio group is a set of keys whose behavior simulates
          a set of radio buttons. Once a key in a radio group is
          pressed, it stays logically depressed until another key
          in the group is pressed, at which point the previously
          depressed key is logically released. Consequently, at
          most one key in a radio group can be logically depressed
          at one time.

   Real Modifier
          Xkb supports the eight core protocol modifiers ( Shift ,
          Lock , Control , and Mod1 through Mod5 ); these are
          called the real modifiers, as opposed to the set of
          sixteen named virtual modifiers that can be bound to any
          set of the eight real modifiers.

   Server Internal Modifiers
          Modifiers that the server uses to determine the
          appropriate symbol for an event; internal modifiers are
          normally consumed by the server.

   Shift Level
          One of several states (normally 2 or 3) governing which
          graphic character is produced when a key is actuated.

   Symbol Keyboard Name
          The symbols keyboard name identifies the symbols
          logically bound to the keys. The symbols name is a human
          or application-readable description of the intended
          locale or usage of the keyboard with these symbols. The
          phys_symbols keyboard name, on the other hand,
          identifies the symbols actually engraved on the
          keyboard.

   Symbolic Name
          Xkb supports symbolic names for most components of the
          keyboard extension. Most of these symbolic names are
          grouped into the names component of the keyboard
          description.

   State Field
          The portion of a client-side core protocol event that
          holds the modifier, group, and button state information
          pertaining to the event.

   Types Name
          The types name provides some information about the set
          of key types that can be associated with the keyboard.
          In addition, each key type can have a name, and each
          shift level of a type can have a name.

   Valuator
          A valuator reports a range of values for some entity,
          like a mouse axis, a slider, or a dial.

   Virtual Modifier
          Xkb provides a set of sixteen named virtual modifiers
          that can be bound to any set of the eight real
          modifiers. Each virtual modifier can be bound to any set
          of the real modifiers ( Shift , Lock , Control, and Mod1
          - Mod5 ).

   Virtual Modifier Mapping
          Xkb maintains a virtual modifier mapping, which lists
          the virtual modifiers associated with each key.

   Xkb-aware Client
          A client application that initializes Xkb extension and
          is consequently bound to an Xlib that includes the Xkb
          extension.

   Xkb-capable Client
          A client application that makes no Xkb extension Xlib
          calls but is bound to an Xlib that includes the Xkb
          extension.

   Xkb-unaware Client
          A client application that makes no Xkb extension Xlib
          calls and is bound to an Xlib that does not include the
          Xkb extension.
